/src/libgit2/deps/pcre/pcre_compile.c
Line | Count | Source (jump to first uncovered line) |
1 | | /************************************************* |
2 | | * Perl-Compatible Regular Expressions * |
3 | | *************************************************/ |
4 | | |
5 | | /* PCRE is a library of functions to support regular expressions whose syntax |
6 | | and semantics are as close as possible to those of the Perl 5 language. |
7 | | |
8 | | Written by Philip Hazel |
9 | | Copyright (c) 1997-2021 University of Cambridge |
10 | | |
11 | | ----------------------------------------------------------------------------- |
12 | | Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without |
13 | | modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions are met: |
14 | | |
15 | | * Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright notice, |
16 | | this list of conditions and the following disclaimer. |
17 | | |
18 | | * Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright |
19 | | notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the |
20 | | documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution. |
21 | | |
22 | | * Neither the name of the University of Cambridge nor the names of its |
23 | | contributors may be used to endorse or promote products derived from |
24 | | this software without specific prior written permission. |
25 | | |
26 | | THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE COPYRIGHT HOLDERS AND CONTRIBUTORS "AS IS" |
27 | | AND ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE |
28 | | IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE |
29 | | ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE COPYRIGHT OWNER OR CONTRIBUTORS BE |
30 | | LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR |
31 | | CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF |
32 | | SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS |
33 | | INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN |
34 | | CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) |
35 | | ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE |
36 | | POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE. |
37 | | ----------------------------------------------------------------------------- |
38 | | */ |
39 | | |
40 | | |
41 | | /* This module contains the external function pcre_compile(), along with |
42 | | supporting internal functions that are not used by other modules. */ |
43 | | |
44 | | |
45 | | #ifdef HAVE_CONFIG_H |
46 | | #include "config.h" |
47 | | #endif |
48 | | |
49 | 0 | #define NLBLOCK cd /* Block containing newline information */ |
50 | | #define PSSTART start_pattern /* Field containing pattern start */ |
51 | 0 | #define PSEND end_pattern /* Field containing pattern end */ |
52 | | |
53 | | #include "pcre_internal.h" |
54 | | |
55 | | |
56 | | /* When PCRE_DEBUG is defined, we need the pcre(16|32)_printint() function, which |
57 | | is also used by pcretest. PCRE_DEBUG is not defined when building a production |
58 | | library. We do not need to select pcre16_printint.c specially, because the |
59 | | COMPILE_PCREx macro will already be appropriately set. */ |
60 | | |
61 | | #ifdef PCRE_DEBUG |
62 | | /* pcre_printint.c should not include any headers */ |
63 | | #define PCRE_INCLUDED |
64 | | #include "pcre_printint.c" |
65 | | #undef PCRE_INCLUDED |
66 | | #endif |
67 | | |
68 | | |
69 | | /* Macro for setting individual bits in class bitmaps. */ |
70 | | |
71 | 0 | #define SETBIT(a,b) a[(b)/8] |= (1U << ((b)&7)) |
72 | | |
73 | | /* Maximum length value to check against when making sure that the integer that |
74 | | holds the compiled pattern length does not overflow. We make it a bit less than |
75 | | INT_MAX to allow for adding in group terminating bytes, so that we don't have |
76 | | to check them every time. */ |
77 | | |
78 | 0 | #define OFLOW_MAX (INT_MAX - 20) |
79 | | |
80 | | /* Definitions to allow mutual recursion */ |
81 | | |
82 | | static int |
83 | | add_list_to_class(pcre_uint8 *, pcre_uchar **, int, compile_data *, |
84 | | const pcre_uint32 *, unsigned int); |
85 | | |
86 | | static BOOL |
87 | | compile_regex(int, pcre_uchar **, const pcre_uchar **, int *, BOOL, BOOL, int, int, |
88 | | pcre_uint32 *, pcre_int32 *, pcre_uint32 *, pcre_int32 *, branch_chain *, |
89 | | compile_data *, int *); |
90 | | |
91 | | |
92 | | |
93 | | /************************************************* |
94 | | * Code parameters and static tables * |
95 | | *************************************************/ |
96 | | |
97 | | /* This value specifies the size of stack workspace that is used during the |
98 | | first pre-compile phase that determines how much memory is required. The regex |
99 | | is partly compiled into this space, but the compiled parts are discarded as |
100 | | soon as they can be, so that hopefully there will never be an overrun. The code |
101 | | does, however, check for an overrun. The largest amount I've seen used is 218, |
102 | | so this number is very generous. |
103 | | |
104 | | The same workspace is used during the second, actual compile phase for |
105 | | remembering forward references to groups so that they can be filled in at the |
106 | | end. Each entry in this list occupies LINK_SIZE bytes, so even when LINK_SIZE |
107 | | is 4 there is plenty of room for most patterns. However, the memory can get |
108 | | filled up by repetitions of forward references, for example patterns like |
109 | | /(?1){0,1999}(b)/, and one user did hit the limit. The code has been changed so |
110 | | that the workspace is expanded using malloc() in this situation. The value |
111 | | below is therefore a minimum, and we put a maximum on it for safety. The |
112 | | minimum is now also defined in terms of LINK_SIZE so that the use of malloc() |
113 | | kicks in at the same number of forward references in all cases. */ |
114 | | |
115 | 0 | #define COMPILE_WORK_SIZE (2048*LINK_SIZE) |
116 | 0 | #define COMPILE_WORK_SIZE_MAX (100*COMPILE_WORK_SIZE) |
117 | | |
118 | | /* This value determines the size of the initial vector that is used for |
119 | | remembering named groups during the pre-compile. It is allocated on the stack, |
120 | | but if it is too small, it is expanded using malloc(), in a similar way to the |
121 | | workspace. The value is the number of slots in the list. */ |
122 | | |
123 | 0 | #define NAMED_GROUP_LIST_SIZE 20 |
124 | | |
125 | | /* The overrun tests check for a slightly smaller size so that they detect the |
126 | | overrun before it actually does run off the end of the data block. */ |
127 | | |
128 | 0 | #define WORK_SIZE_SAFETY_MARGIN (100) |
129 | | |
130 | | /* Private flags added to firstchar and reqchar. */ |
131 | | |
132 | 0 | #define REQ_CASELESS (1U << 0) /* Indicates caselessness */ |
133 | 0 | #define REQ_VARY (1U << 1) /* Reqchar followed non-literal item */ |
134 | | /* Negative values for the firstchar and reqchar flags */ |
135 | 0 | #define REQ_UNSET (-2) |
136 | 0 | #define REQ_NONE (-1) |
137 | | |
138 | | /* Repeated character flags. */ |
139 | | |
140 | | #define UTF_LENGTH 0x10000000l /* The char contains its length. */ |
141 | | |
142 | | /* Table for handling escaped characters in the range '0'-'z'. Positive returns |
143 | | are simple data values; negative values are for special things like \d and so |
144 | | on. Zero means further processing is needed (for things like \x), or the escape |
145 | | is invalid. */ |
146 | | |
147 | | #ifndef EBCDIC |
148 | | |
149 | | /* This is the "normal" table for ASCII systems or for EBCDIC systems running |
150 | | in UTF-8 mode. */ |
151 | | |
152 | | static const short int escapes[] = { |
153 | | 0, 0, |
154 | | 0, 0, |
155 | | 0, 0, |
156 | | 0, 0, |
157 | | 0, 0, |
158 | | CHAR_COLON, CHAR_SEMICOLON, |
159 | | CHAR_LESS_THAN_SIGN, CHAR_EQUALS_SIGN, |
160 | | CHAR_GREATER_THAN_SIGN, CHAR_QUESTION_MARK, |
161 | | CHAR_COMMERCIAL_AT, -ESC_A, |
162 | | -ESC_B, -ESC_C, |
163 | | -ESC_D, -ESC_E, |
164 | | 0, -ESC_G, |
165 | | -ESC_H, 0, |
166 | | 0, -ESC_K, |
167 | | 0, 0, |
168 | | -ESC_N, 0, |
169 | | -ESC_P, -ESC_Q, |
170 | | -ESC_R, -ESC_S, |
171 | | 0, 0, |
172 | | -ESC_V, -ESC_W, |
173 | | -ESC_X, 0, |
174 | | -ESC_Z, CHAR_LEFT_SQUARE_BRACKET, |
175 | | CHAR_BACKSLASH, CHAR_RIGHT_SQUARE_BRACKET, |
176 | | CHAR_CIRCUMFLEX_ACCENT, CHAR_UNDERSCORE, |
177 | | CHAR_GRAVE_ACCENT, ESC_a, |
178 | | -ESC_b, 0, |
179 | | -ESC_d, ESC_e, |
180 | | ESC_f, 0, |
181 | | -ESC_h, 0, |
182 | | 0, -ESC_k, |
183 | | 0, 0, |
184 | | ESC_n, 0, |
185 | | -ESC_p, 0, |
186 | | ESC_r, -ESC_s, |
187 | | ESC_tee, 0, |
188 | | -ESC_v, -ESC_w, |
189 | | 0, 0, |
190 | | -ESC_z |
191 | | }; |
192 | | |
193 | | #else |
194 | | |
195 | | /* This is the "abnormal" table for EBCDIC systems without UTF-8 support. */ |
196 | | |
197 | | static const short int escapes[] = { |
198 | | /* 48 */ 0, 0, 0, '.', '<', '(', '+', '|', |
199 | | /* 50 */ '&', 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, |
200 | | /* 58 */ 0, 0, '!', '$', '*', ')', ';', '~', |
201 | | /* 60 */ '-', '/', 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, |
202 | | /* 68 */ 0, 0, '|', ',', '%', '_', '>', '?', |
203 | | /* 70 */ 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, |
204 | | /* 78 */ 0, '`', ':', '#', '@', '\'', '=', '"', |
205 | | /* 80 */ 0, ESC_a, -ESC_b, 0, -ESC_d, ESC_e, ESC_f, 0, |
206 | | /* 88 */-ESC_h, 0, 0, '{', 0, 0, 0, 0, |
207 | | /* 90 */ 0, 0, -ESC_k, 0, 0, ESC_n, 0, -ESC_p, |
208 | | /* 98 */ 0, ESC_r, 0, '}', 0, 0, 0, 0, |
209 | | /* A0 */ 0, '~', -ESC_s, ESC_tee, 0,-ESC_v, -ESC_w, 0, |
210 | | /* A8 */ 0,-ESC_z, 0, 0, 0, '[', 0, 0, |
211 | | /* B0 */ 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, |
212 | | /* B8 */ 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, ']', '=', '-', |
213 | | /* C0 */ '{',-ESC_A, -ESC_B, -ESC_C, -ESC_D,-ESC_E, 0, -ESC_G, |
214 | | /* C8 */-ESC_H, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, |
215 | | /* D0 */ '}', 0, -ESC_K, 0, 0,-ESC_N, 0, -ESC_P, |
216 | | /* D8 */-ESC_Q,-ESC_R, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, |
217 | | /* E0 */ '\\', 0, -ESC_S, 0, 0,-ESC_V, -ESC_W, -ESC_X, |
218 | | /* E8 */ 0,-ESC_Z, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, |
219 | | /* F0 */ 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, |
220 | | /* F8 */ 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0 |
221 | | }; |
222 | | |
223 | | /* We also need a table of characters that may follow \c in an EBCDIC |
224 | | environment for characters 0-31. */ |
225 | | |
226 | | static unsigned char ebcdic_escape_c[] = "@ABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQRSTUVWXYZ[\\]^_"; |
227 | | |
228 | | #endif |
229 | | |
230 | | |
231 | | /* Table of special "verbs" like (*PRUNE). This is a short table, so it is |
232 | | searched linearly. Put all the names into a single string, in order to reduce |
233 | | the number of relocations when a shared library is dynamically linked. The |
234 | | string is built from string macros so that it works in UTF-8 mode on EBCDIC |
235 | | platforms. */ |
236 | | |
237 | | typedef struct verbitem { |
238 | | int len; /* Length of verb name */ |
239 | | int op; /* Op when no arg, or -1 if arg mandatory */ |
240 | | int op_arg; /* Op when arg present, or -1 if not allowed */ |
241 | | } verbitem; |
242 | | |
243 | | static const char verbnames[] = |
244 | | "\0" /* Empty name is a shorthand for MARK */ |
245 | | STRING_MARK0 |
246 | | STRING_ACCEPT0 |
247 | | STRING_COMMIT0 |
248 | | STRING_F0 |
249 | | STRING_FAIL0 |
250 | | STRING_PRUNE0 |
251 | | STRING_SKIP0 |
252 | | STRING_THEN; |
253 | | |
254 | | static const verbitem verbs[] = { |
255 | | { 0, -1, OP_MARK }, |
256 | | { 4, -1, OP_MARK }, |
257 | | { 6, OP_ACCEPT, -1 }, |
258 | | { 6, OP_COMMIT, -1 }, |
259 | | { 1, OP_FAIL, -1 }, |
260 | | { 4, OP_FAIL, -1 }, |
261 | | { 5, OP_PRUNE, OP_PRUNE_ARG }, |
262 | | { 4, OP_SKIP, OP_SKIP_ARG }, |
263 | | { 4, OP_THEN, OP_THEN_ARG } |
264 | | }; |
265 | | |
266 | | static const int verbcount = sizeof(verbs)/sizeof(verbitem); |
267 | | |
268 | | |
269 | | /* Substitutes for [[:<:]] and [[:>:]], which mean start and end of word in |
270 | | another regex library. */ |
271 | | |
272 | | static const pcre_uchar sub_start_of_word[] = { |
273 | | CHAR_BACKSLASH, CHAR_b, CHAR_LEFT_PARENTHESIS, CHAR_QUESTION_MARK, |
274 | | CHAR_EQUALS_SIGN, CHAR_BACKSLASH, CHAR_w, CHAR_RIGHT_PARENTHESIS, '\0' }; |
275 | | |
276 | | static const pcre_uchar sub_end_of_word[] = { |
277 | | CHAR_BACKSLASH, CHAR_b, CHAR_LEFT_PARENTHESIS, CHAR_QUESTION_MARK, |
278 | | CHAR_LESS_THAN_SIGN, CHAR_EQUALS_SIGN, CHAR_BACKSLASH, CHAR_w, |
279 | | CHAR_RIGHT_PARENTHESIS, '\0' }; |
280 | | |
281 | | |
282 | | /* Tables of names of POSIX character classes and their lengths. The names are |
283 | | now all in a single string, to reduce the number of relocations when a shared |
284 | | library is dynamically loaded. The list of lengths is terminated by a zero |
285 | | length entry. The first three must be alpha, lower, upper, as this is assumed |
286 | | for handling case independence. The indices for graph, print, and punct are |
287 | | needed, so identify them. */ |
288 | | |
289 | | static const char posix_names[] = |
290 | | STRING_alpha0 STRING_lower0 STRING_upper0 STRING_alnum0 |
291 | | STRING_ascii0 STRING_blank0 STRING_cntrl0 STRING_digit0 |
292 | | STRING_graph0 STRING_print0 STRING_punct0 STRING_space0 |
293 | | STRING_word0 STRING_xdigit; |
294 | | |
295 | | static const pcre_uint8 posix_name_lengths[] = { |
296 | | 5, 5, 5, 5, 5, 5, 5, 5, 5, 5, 5, 5, 4, 6, 0 }; |
297 | | |
298 | | #define PC_GRAPH 8 |
299 | | #define PC_PRINT 9 |
300 | | #define PC_PUNCT 10 |
301 | | |
302 | | |
303 | | /* Table of class bit maps for each POSIX class. Each class is formed from a |
304 | | base map, with an optional addition or removal of another map. Then, for some |
305 | | classes, there is some additional tweaking: for [:blank:] the vertical space |
306 | | characters are removed, and for [:alpha:] and [:alnum:] the underscore |
307 | | character is removed. The triples in the table consist of the base map offset, |
308 | | second map offset or -1 if no second map, and a non-negative value for map |
309 | | addition or a negative value for map subtraction (if there are two maps). The |
310 | | absolute value of the third field has these meanings: 0 => no tweaking, 1 => |
311 | | remove vertical space characters, 2 => remove underscore. */ |
312 | | |
313 | | static const int posix_class_maps[] = { |
314 | | cbit_word, cbit_digit, -2, /* alpha */ |
315 | | cbit_lower, -1, 0, /* lower */ |
316 | | cbit_upper, -1, 0, /* upper */ |
317 | | cbit_word, -1, 2, /* alnum - word without underscore */ |
318 | | cbit_print, cbit_cntrl, 0, /* ascii */ |
319 | | cbit_space, -1, 1, /* blank - a GNU extension */ |
320 | | cbit_cntrl, -1, 0, /* cntrl */ |
321 | | cbit_digit, -1, 0, /* digit */ |
322 | | cbit_graph, -1, 0, /* graph */ |
323 | | cbit_print, -1, 0, /* print */ |
324 | | cbit_punct, -1, 0, /* punct */ |
325 | | cbit_space, -1, 0, /* space */ |
326 | | cbit_word, -1, 0, /* word - a Perl extension */ |
327 | | cbit_xdigit,-1, 0 /* xdigit */ |
328 | | }; |
329 | | |
330 | | /* Table of substitutes for \d etc when PCRE_UCP is set. They are replaced by |
331 | | Unicode property escapes. */ |
332 | | |
333 | | #ifdef SUPPORT_UCP |
334 | | static const pcre_uchar string_PNd[] = { |
335 | | CHAR_BACKSLASH, CHAR_P, CHAR_LEFT_CURLY_BRACKET, |
336 | | CHAR_N, CHAR_d, CHAR_RIGHT_CURLY_BRACKET, '\0' }; |
337 | | static const pcre_uchar string_pNd[] = { |
338 | | CHAR_BACKSLASH, CHAR_p, CHAR_LEFT_CURLY_BRACKET, |
339 | | CHAR_N, CHAR_d, CHAR_RIGHT_CURLY_BRACKET, '\0' }; |
340 | | static const pcre_uchar string_PXsp[] = { |
341 | | CHAR_BACKSLASH, CHAR_P, CHAR_LEFT_CURLY_BRACKET, |
342 | | CHAR_X, CHAR_s, CHAR_p, CHAR_RIGHT_CURLY_BRACKET, '\0' }; |
343 | | static const pcre_uchar string_pXsp[] = { |
344 | | CHAR_BACKSLASH, CHAR_p, CHAR_LEFT_CURLY_BRACKET, |
345 | | CHAR_X, CHAR_s, CHAR_p, CHAR_RIGHT_CURLY_BRACKET, '\0' }; |
346 | | static const pcre_uchar string_PXwd[] = { |
347 | | CHAR_BACKSLASH, CHAR_P, CHAR_LEFT_CURLY_BRACKET, |
348 | | CHAR_X, CHAR_w, CHAR_d, CHAR_RIGHT_CURLY_BRACKET, '\0' }; |
349 | | static const pcre_uchar string_pXwd[] = { |
350 | | CHAR_BACKSLASH, CHAR_p, CHAR_LEFT_CURLY_BRACKET, |
351 | | CHAR_X, CHAR_w, CHAR_d, CHAR_RIGHT_CURLY_BRACKET, '\0' }; |
352 | | |
353 | | static const pcre_uchar *substitutes[] = { |
354 | | string_PNd, /* \D */ |
355 | | string_pNd, /* \d */ |
356 | | string_PXsp, /* \S */ /* Xsp is Perl space, but from 8.34, Perl */ |
357 | | string_pXsp, /* \s */ /* space and POSIX space are the same. */ |
358 | | string_PXwd, /* \W */ |
359 | | string_pXwd /* \w */ |
360 | | }; |
361 | | |
362 | | /* The POSIX class substitutes must be in the order of the POSIX class names, |
363 | | defined above, and there are both positive and negative cases. NULL means no |
364 | | general substitute of a Unicode property escape (\p or \P). However, for some |
365 | | POSIX classes (e.g. graph, print, punct) a special property code is compiled |
366 | | directly. */ |
367 | | |
368 | | static const pcre_uchar string_pL[] = { |
369 | | CHAR_BACKSLASH, CHAR_p, CHAR_LEFT_CURLY_BRACKET, |
370 | | CHAR_L, CHAR_RIGHT_CURLY_BRACKET, '\0' }; |
371 | | static const pcre_uchar string_pLl[] = { |
372 | | CHAR_BACKSLASH, CHAR_p, CHAR_LEFT_CURLY_BRACKET, |
373 | | CHAR_L, CHAR_l, CHAR_RIGHT_CURLY_BRACKET, '\0' }; |
374 | | static const pcre_uchar string_pLu[] = { |
375 | | CHAR_BACKSLASH, CHAR_p, CHAR_LEFT_CURLY_BRACKET, |
376 | | CHAR_L, CHAR_u, CHAR_RIGHT_CURLY_BRACKET, '\0' }; |
377 | | static const pcre_uchar string_pXan[] = { |
378 | | CHAR_BACKSLASH, CHAR_p, CHAR_LEFT_CURLY_BRACKET, |
379 | | CHAR_X, CHAR_a, CHAR_n, CHAR_RIGHT_CURLY_BRACKET, '\0' }; |
380 | | static const pcre_uchar string_h[] = { |
381 | | CHAR_BACKSLASH, CHAR_h, '\0' }; |
382 | | static const pcre_uchar string_pXps[] = { |
383 | | CHAR_BACKSLASH, CHAR_p, CHAR_LEFT_CURLY_BRACKET, |
384 | | CHAR_X, CHAR_p, CHAR_s, CHAR_RIGHT_CURLY_BRACKET, '\0' }; |
385 | | static const pcre_uchar string_PL[] = { |
386 | | CHAR_BACKSLASH, CHAR_P, CHAR_LEFT_CURLY_BRACKET, |
387 | | CHAR_L, CHAR_RIGHT_CURLY_BRACKET, '\0' }; |
388 | | static const pcre_uchar string_PLl[] = { |
389 | | CHAR_BACKSLASH, CHAR_P, CHAR_LEFT_CURLY_BRACKET, |
390 | | CHAR_L, CHAR_l, CHAR_RIGHT_CURLY_BRACKET, '\0' }; |
391 | | static const pcre_uchar string_PLu[] = { |
392 | | CHAR_BACKSLASH, CHAR_P, CHAR_LEFT_CURLY_BRACKET, |
393 | | CHAR_L, CHAR_u, CHAR_RIGHT_CURLY_BRACKET, '\0' }; |
394 | | static const pcre_uchar string_PXan[] = { |
395 | | CHAR_BACKSLASH, CHAR_P, CHAR_LEFT_CURLY_BRACKET, |
396 | | CHAR_X, CHAR_a, CHAR_n, CHAR_RIGHT_CURLY_BRACKET, '\0' }; |
397 | | static const pcre_uchar string_H[] = { |
398 | | CHAR_BACKSLASH, CHAR_H, '\0' }; |
399 | | static const pcre_uchar string_PXps[] = { |
400 | | CHAR_BACKSLASH, CHAR_P, CHAR_LEFT_CURLY_BRACKET, |
401 | | CHAR_X, CHAR_p, CHAR_s, CHAR_RIGHT_CURLY_BRACKET, '\0' }; |
402 | | |
403 | | static const pcre_uchar *posix_substitutes[] = { |
404 | | string_pL, /* alpha */ |
405 | | string_pLl, /* lower */ |
406 | | string_pLu, /* upper */ |
407 | | string_pXan, /* alnum */ |
408 | | NULL, /* ascii */ |
409 | | string_h, /* blank */ |
410 | | NULL, /* cntrl */ |
411 | | string_pNd, /* digit */ |
412 | | NULL, /* graph */ |
413 | | NULL, /* print */ |
414 | | NULL, /* punct */ |
415 | | string_pXps, /* space */ /* Xps is POSIX space, but from 8.34 */ |
416 | | string_pXwd, /* word */ /* Perl and POSIX space are the same */ |
417 | | NULL, /* xdigit */ |
418 | | /* Negated cases */ |
419 | | string_PL, /* ^alpha */ |
420 | | string_PLl, /* ^lower */ |
421 | | string_PLu, /* ^upper */ |
422 | | string_PXan, /* ^alnum */ |
423 | | NULL, /* ^ascii */ |
424 | | string_H, /* ^blank */ |
425 | | NULL, /* ^cntrl */ |
426 | | string_PNd, /* ^digit */ |
427 | | NULL, /* ^graph */ |
428 | | NULL, /* ^print */ |
429 | | NULL, /* ^punct */ |
430 | | string_PXps, /* ^space */ /* Xps is POSIX space, but from 8.34 */ |
431 | | string_PXwd, /* ^word */ /* Perl and POSIX space are the same */ |
432 | | NULL /* ^xdigit */ |
433 | | }; |
434 | | #define POSIX_SUBSIZE (sizeof(posix_substitutes) / sizeof(pcre_uchar *)) |
435 | | #endif |
436 | | |
437 | | #define STRING(a) # a |
438 | | #define XSTRING(s) STRING(s) |
439 | | |
440 | | /* The texts of compile-time error messages. These are "char *" because they |
441 | | are passed to the outside world. Do not ever re-use any error number, because |
442 | | they are documented. Always add a new error instead. Messages marked DEAD below |
443 | | are no longer used. This used to be a table of strings, but in order to reduce |
444 | | the number of relocations needed when a shared library is loaded dynamically, |
445 | | it is now one long string. We cannot use a table of offsets, because the |
446 | | lengths of inserts such as XSTRING(MAX_NAME_SIZE) are not known. Instead, we |
447 | | simply count through to the one we want - this isn't a performance issue |
448 | | because these strings are used only when there is a compilation error. |
449 | | |
450 | | Each substring ends with \0 to insert a null character. This includes the final |
451 | | substring, so that the whole string ends with \0\0, which can be detected when |
452 | | counting through. */ |
453 | | |
454 | | static const char error_texts[] = |
455 | | "no error\0" |
456 | | "\\ at end of pattern\0" |
457 | | "\\c at end of pattern\0" |
458 | | "unrecognized character follows \\\0" |
459 | | "numbers out of order in {} quantifier\0" |
460 | | /* 5 */ |
461 | | "number too big in {} quantifier\0" |
462 | | "missing terminating ] for character class\0" |
463 | | "invalid escape sequence in character class\0" |
464 | | "range out of order in character class\0" |
465 | | "nothing to repeat\0" |
466 | | /* 10 */ |
467 | | "internal error: invalid forward reference offset\0" |
468 | | "internal error: unexpected repeat\0" |
469 | | "unrecognized character after (? or (?-\0" |
470 | | "POSIX named classes are supported only within a class\0" |
471 | | "missing )\0" |
472 | | /* 15 */ |
473 | | "reference to non-existent subpattern\0" |
474 | | "erroffset passed as NULL\0" |
475 | | "unknown option bit(s) set\0" |
476 | | "missing ) after comment\0" |
477 | | "parentheses nested too deeply\0" /** DEAD **/ |
478 | | /* 20 */ |
479 | | "regular expression is too large\0" |
480 | | "failed to get memory\0" |
481 | | "unmatched parentheses\0" |
482 | | "internal error: code overflow\0" |
483 | | "unrecognized character after (?<\0" |
484 | | /* 25 */ |
485 | | "lookbehind assertion is not fixed length\0" |
486 | | "malformed number or name after (?(\0" |
487 | | "conditional group contains more than two branches\0" |
488 | | "assertion expected after (?( or (?(?C)\0" |
489 | | "(?R or (?[+-]digits must be followed by )\0" |
490 | | /* 30 */ |
491 | | "unknown POSIX class name\0" |
492 | | "POSIX collating elements are not supported\0" |
493 | | "this version of PCRE is compiled without UTF support\0" |
494 | | "spare error\0" /** DEAD **/ |
495 | | "character value in \\x{} or \\o{} is too large\0" |
496 | | /* 35 */ |
497 | | "invalid condition (?(0)\0" |
498 | | "\\C not allowed in lookbehind assertion\0" |
499 | | "PCRE does not support \\L, \\l, \\N{name}, \\U, or \\u\0" |
500 | | "number after (?C is > 255\0" |
501 | | "closing ) for (?C expected\0" |
502 | | /* 40 */ |
503 | | "recursive call could loop indefinitely\0" |
504 | | "unrecognized character after (?P\0" |
505 | | "syntax error in subpattern name (missing terminator)\0" |
506 | | "two named subpatterns have the same name\0" |
507 | | "invalid UTF-8 string\0" |
508 | | /* 45 */ |
509 | | "support for \\P, \\p, and \\X has not been compiled\0" |
510 | | "malformed \\P or \\p sequence\0" |
511 | | "unknown property name after \\P or \\p\0" |
512 | | "subpattern name is too long (maximum " XSTRING(MAX_NAME_SIZE) " characters)\0" |
513 | | "too many named subpatterns (maximum " XSTRING(MAX_NAME_COUNT) ")\0" |
514 | | /* 50 */ |
515 | | "repeated subpattern is too long\0" /** DEAD **/ |
516 | | "octal value is greater than \\377 in 8-bit non-UTF-8 mode\0" |
517 | | "internal error: overran compiling workspace\0" |
518 | | "internal error: previously-checked referenced subpattern not found\0" |
519 | | "DEFINE group contains more than one branch\0" |
520 | | /* 55 */ |
521 | | "repeating a DEFINE group is not allowed\0" /** DEAD **/ |
522 | | "inconsistent NEWLINE options\0" |
523 | | "\\g is not followed by a braced, angle-bracketed, or quoted name/number or by a plain number\0" |
524 | | "a numbered reference must not be zero\0" |
525 | | "an argument is not allowed for (*ACCEPT), (*FAIL), or (*COMMIT)\0" |
526 | | /* 60 */ |
527 | | "(*VERB) not recognized or malformed\0" |
528 | | "number is too big\0" |
529 | | "subpattern name expected\0" |
530 | | "digit expected after (?+\0" |
531 | | "] is an invalid data character in JavaScript compatibility mode\0" |
532 | | /* 65 */ |
533 | | "different names for subpatterns of the same number are not allowed\0" |
534 | | "(*MARK) must have an argument\0" |
535 | | "this version of PCRE is not compiled with Unicode property support\0" |
536 | | #ifndef EBCDIC |
537 | | "\\c must be followed by an ASCII character\0" |
538 | | #else |
539 | | "\\c must be followed by a letter or one of [\\]^_?\0" |
540 | | #endif |
541 | | "\\k is not followed by a braced, angle-bracketed, or quoted name\0" |
542 | | /* 70 */ |
543 | | "internal error: unknown opcode in find_fixedlength()\0" |
544 | | "\\N is not supported in a class\0" |
545 | | "too many forward references\0" |
546 | | "disallowed Unicode code point (>= 0xd800 && <= 0xdfff)\0" |
547 | | "invalid UTF-16 string\0" |
548 | | /* 75 */ |
549 | | "name is too long in (*MARK), (*PRUNE), (*SKIP), or (*THEN)\0" |
550 | | "character value in \\u.... sequence is too large\0" |
551 | | "invalid UTF-32 string\0" |
552 | | "setting UTF is disabled by the application\0" |
553 | | "non-hex character in \\x{} (closing brace missing?)\0" |
554 | | /* 80 */ |
555 | | "non-octal character in \\o{} (closing brace missing?)\0" |
556 | | "missing opening brace after \\o\0" |
557 | | "parentheses are too deeply nested\0" |
558 | | "invalid range in character class\0" |
559 | | "group name must start with a non-digit\0" |
560 | | /* 85 */ |
561 | | "parentheses are too deeply nested (stack check)\0" |
562 | | "digits missing in \\x{} or \\o{}\0" |
563 | | "regular expression is too complicated\0" |
564 | | ; |
565 | | |
566 | | /* Table to identify digits and hex digits. This is used when compiling |
567 | | patterns. Note that the tables in chartables are dependent on the locale, and |
568 | | may mark arbitrary characters as digits - but the PCRE compiling code expects |
569 | | to handle only 0-9, a-z, and A-Z as digits when compiling. That is why we have |
570 | | a private table here. It costs 256 bytes, but it is a lot faster than doing |
571 | | character value tests (at least in some simple cases I timed), and in some |
572 | | applications one wants PCRE to compile efficiently as well as match |
573 | | efficiently. |
574 | | |
575 | | For convenience, we use the same bit definitions as in chartables: |
576 | | |
577 | | 0x04 decimal digit |
578 | | 0x08 hexadecimal digit |
579 | | |
580 | | Then we can use ctype_digit and ctype_xdigit in the code. */ |
581 | | |
582 | | /* Using a simple comparison for decimal numbers rather than a memory read |
583 | | is much faster, and the resulting code is simpler (the compiler turns it |
584 | | into a subtraction and unsigned comparison). */ |
585 | | |
586 | 0 | #define IS_DIGIT(x) ((x) >= CHAR_0 && (x) <= CHAR_9) |
587 | | |
588 | | #ifndef EBCDIC |
589 | | |
590 | | /* This is the "normal" case, for ASCII systems, and EBCDIC systems running in |
591 | | UTF-8 mode. */ |
592 | | |
593 | | static const pcre_uint8 digitab[] = |
594 | | { |
595 | | 0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /* 0- 7 */ |
596 | | 0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /* 8- 15 */ |
597 | | 0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /* 16- 23 */ |
598 | | 0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /* 24- 31 */ |
599 | | 0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /* - ' */ |
600 | | 0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /* ( - / */ |
601 | | 0x0c,0x0c,0x0c,0x0c,0x0c,0x0c,0x0c,0x0c, /* 0 - 7 */ |
602 | | 0x0c,0x0c,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /* 8 - ? */ |
603 | | 0x00,0x08,0x08,0x08,0x08,0x08,0x08,0x00, /* @ - G */ |
604 | | 0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /* H - O */ |
605 | | 0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /* P - W */ |
606 | | 0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /* X - _ */ |
607 | | 0x00,0x08,0x08,0x08,0x08,0x08,0x08,0x00, /* ` - g */ |
608 | | 0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /* h - o */ |
609 | | 0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /* p - w */ |
610 | | 0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /* x -127 */ |
611 | | 0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /* 128-135 */ |
612 | | 0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /* 136-143 */ |
613 | | 0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /* 144-151 */ |
614 | | 0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /* 152-159 */ |
615 | | 0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /* 160-167 */ |
616 | | 0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /* 168-175 */ |
617 | | 0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /* 176-183 */ |
618 | | 0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /* 184-191 */ |
619 | | 0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /* 192-199 */ |
620 | | 0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /* 200-207 */ |
621 | | 0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /* 208-215 */ |
622 | | 0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /* 216-223 */ |
623 | | 0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /* 224-231 */ |
624 | | 0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /* 232-239 */ |
625 | | 0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /* 240-247 */ |
626 | | 0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00};/* 248-255 */ |
627 | | |
628 | | #else |
629 | | |
630 | | /* This is the "abnormal" case, for EBCDIC systems not running in UTF-8 mode. */ |
631 | | |
632 | | static const pcre_uint8 digitab[] = |
633 | | { |
634 | | 0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /* 0- 7 0 */ |
635 | | 0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /* 8- 15 */ |
636 | | 0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /* 16- 23 10 */ |
637 | | 0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /* 24- 31 */ |
638 | | 0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /* 32- 39 20 */ |
639 | | 0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /* 40- 47 */ |
640 | | 0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /* 48- 55 30 */ |
641 | | 0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /* 56- 63 */ |
642 | | 0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /* - 71 40 */ |
643 | | 0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /* 72- | */ |
644 | | 0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /* & - 87 50 */ |
645 | | 0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /* 88- 95 */ |
646 | | 0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /* - -103 60 */ |
647 | | 0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /* 104- ? */ |
648 | | 0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /* 112-119 70 */ |
649 | | 0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /* 120- " */ |
650 | | 0x00,0x08,0x08,0x08,0x08,0x08,0x08,0x00, /* 128- g 80 */ |
651 | | 0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /* h -143 */ |
652 | | 0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /* 144- p 90 */ |
653 | | 0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /* q -159 */ |
654 | | 0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /* 160- x A0 */ |
655 | | 0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /* y -175 */ |
656 | | 0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /* ^ -183 B0 */ |
657 | | 0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /* 184-191 */ |
658 | | 0x00,0x08,0x08,0x08,0x08,0x08,0x08,0x00, /* { - G C0 */ |
659 | | 0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /* H -207 */ |
660 | | 0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /* } - P D0 */ |
661 | | 0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /* Q -223 */ |
662 | | 0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /* \ - X E0 */ |
663 | | 0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /* Y -239 */ |
664 | | 0x0c,0x0c,0x0c,0x0c,0x0c,0x0c,0x0c,0x0c, /* 0 - 7 F0 */ |
665 | | 0x0c,0x0c,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00};/* 8 -255 */ |
666 | | |
667 | | static const pcre_uint8 ebcdic_chartab[] = { /* chartable partial dup */ |
668 | | 0x80,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x01,0x00,0x00, /* 0- 7 */ |
669 | | 0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x01,0x01,0x00,0x00, /* 8- 15 */ |
670 | | 0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x01,0x00,0x00, /* 16- 23 */ |
671 | | 0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /* 24- 31 */ |
672 | | 0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x01,0x00,0x00, /* 32- 39 */ |
673 | | 0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /* 40- 47 */ |
674 | | 0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /* 48- 55 */ |
675 | | 0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /* 56- 63 */ |
676 | | 0x01,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /* - 71 */ |
677 | | 0x00,0x00,0x00,0x80,0x00,0x80,0x80,0x80, /* 72- | */ |
678 | | 0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /* & - 87 */ |
679 | | 0x00,0x00,0x00,0x80,0x80,0x80,0x00,0x00, /* 88- 95 */ |
680 | | 0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /* - -103 */ |
681 | | 0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x10,0x00,0x80, /* 104- ? */ |
682 | | 0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /* 112-119 */ |
683 | | 0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /* 120- " */ |
684 | | 0x00,0x1a,0x1a,0x1a,0x1a,0x1a,0x1a,0x12, /* 128- g */ |
685 | | 0x12,0x12,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /* h -143 */ |
686 | | 0x00,0x12,0x12,0x12,0x12,0x12,0x12,0x12, /* 144- p */ |
687 | | 0x12,0x12,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /* q -159 */ |
688 | | 0x00,0x00,0x12,0x12,0x12,0x12,0x12,0x12, /* 160- x */ |
689 | | 0x12,0x12,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /* y -175 */ |
690 | | 0x80,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /* ^ -183 */ |
691 | | 0x00,0x00,0x80,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /* 184-191 */ |
692 | | 0x80,0x1a,0x1a,0x1a,0x1a,0x1a,0x1a,0x12, /* { - G */ |
693 | | 0x12,0x12,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /* H -207 */ |
694 | | 0x00,0x12,0x12,0x12,0x12,0x12,0x12,0x12, /* } - P */ |
695 | | 0x12,0x12,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /* Q -223 */ |
696 | | 0x00,0x00,0x12,0x12,0x12,0x12,0x12,0x12, /* \ - X */ |
697 | | 0x12,0x12,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /* Y -239 */ |
698 | | 0x1c,0x1c,0x1c,0x1c,0x1c,0x1c,0x1c,0x1c, /* 0 - 7 */ |
699 | | 0x1c,0x1c,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00};/* 8 -255 */ |
700 | | #endif |
701 | | |
702 | | |
703 | | /* This table is used to check whether auto-possessification is possible |
704 | | between adjacent character-type opcodes. The left-hand (repeated) opcode is |
705 | | used to select the row, and the right-hand opcode is use to select the column. |
706 | | A value of 1 means that auto-possessification is OK. For example, the second |
707 | | value in the first row means that \D+\d can be turned into \D++\d. |
708 | | |
709 | | The Unicode property types (\P and \p) have to be present to fill out the table |
710 | | because of what their opcode values are, but the table values should always be |
711 | | zero because property types are handled separately in the code. The last four |
712 | | columns apply to items that cannot be repeated, so there is no need to have |
713 | | rows for them. Note that OP_DIGIT etc. are generated only when PCRE_UCP is |
714 | | *not* set. When it is set, \d etc. are converted into OP_(NOT_)PROP codes. */ |
715 | | |
716 | | #define APTROWS (LAST_AUTOTAB_LEFT_OP - FIRST_AUTOTAB_OP + 1) |
717 | | #define APTCOLS (LAST_AUTOTAB_RIGHT_OP - FIRST_AUTOTAB_OP + 1) |
718 | | |
719 | | static const pcre_uint8 autoposstab[APTROWS][APTCOLS] = { |
720 | | /* \D \d \S \s \W \w . .+ \C \P \p \R \H \h \V \v \X \Z \z $ $M */ |
721 | | { 0, 1, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 1, 0, 0 }, /* \D */ |
722 | | { 1, 0, 0, 1, 1, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 1, 0, 1, 0, 1, 0, 1, 1, 1, 1 }, /* \d */ |
723 | | { 0, 0, 0, 1, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 1, 0, 1, 0, 1, 0, 1, 1, 1, 1 }, /* \S */ |
724 | | { 0, 1, 1, 0, 0, 1, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 1, 0, 0 }, /* \s */ |
725 | | { 0, 1, 0, 0, 0, 1, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 1, 0, 0 }, /* \W */ |
726 | | { 0, 0, 0, 1, 1, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 1, 0, 1, 0, 1, 0, 1, 1, 1, 1 }, /* \w */ |
727 | | { 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 1, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 1, 0, 0 }, /* . */ |
728 | | { 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 1, 0, 0 }, /* .+ */ |
729 | | { 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 1, 0, 0 }, /* \C */ |
730 | | { 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0 }, /* \P */ |
731 | | { 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0 }, /* \p */ |
732 | | { 0, 1, 0, 1, 0, 1, 1, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 1, 0, 0, 0, 0, 1, 0, 0 }, /* \R */ |
733 | | { 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 1, 0, 0, 0, 0, 1, 0, 0 }, /* \H */ |
734 | | { 0, 1, 1, 0, 0, 1, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 1, 1, 0, 0, 1, 0, 0, 1, 0, 0 }, /* \h */ |
735 | | { 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 1, 0, 0, 0, 1, 0, 0, 1, 0, 0 }, /* \V */ |
736 | | { 0, 1, 1, 0, 0, 1, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 1, 1, 0, 0, 0, 1, 0, 0 }, /* \v */ |
737 | | { 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 1, 0, 0 } /* \X */ |
738 | | }; |
739 | | |
740 | | |
741 | | /* This table is used to check whether auto-possessification is possible |
742 | | between adjacent Unicode property opcodes (OP_PROP and OP_NOTPROP). The |
743 | | left-hand (repeated) opcode is used to select the row, and the right-hand |
744 | | opcode is used to select the column. The values are as follows: |
745 | | |
746 | | 0 Always return FALSE (never auto-possessify) |
747 | | 1 Character groups are distinct (possessify if both are OP_PROP) |
748 | | 2 Check character categories in the same group (general or particular) |
749 | | 3 TRUE if the two opcodes are not the same (PROP vs NOTPROP) |
750 | | |
751 | | 4 Check left general category vs right particular category |
752 | | 5 Check right general category vs left particular category |
753 | | |
754 | | 6 Left alphanum vs right general category |
755 | | 7 Left space vs right general category |
756 | | 8 Left word vs right general category |
757 | | |
758 | | 9 Right alphanum vs left general category |
759 | | 10 Right space vs left general category |
760 | | 11 Right word vs left general category |
761 | | |
762 | | 12 Left alphanum vs right particular category |
763 | | 13 Left space vs right particular category |
764 | | 14 Left word vs right particular category |
765 | | |
766 | | 15 Right alphanum vs left particular category |
767 | | 16 Right space vs left particular category |
768 | | 17 Right word vs left particular category |
769 | | */ |
770 | | |
771 | | static const pcre_uint8 propposstab[PT_TABSIZE][PT_TABSIZE] = { |
772 | | /* ANY LAMP GC PC SC ALNUM SPACE PXSPACE WORD CLIST UCNC */ |
773 | | { 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0 }, /* PT_ANY */ |
774 | | { 0, 3, 0, 0, 0, 3, 1, 1, 0, 0, 0 }, /* PT_LAMP */ |
775 | | { 0, 0, 2, 4, 0, 9, 10, 10, 11, 0, 0 }, /* PT_GC */ |
776 | | { 0, 0, 5, 2, 0, 15, 16, 16, 17, 0, 0 }, /* PT_PC */ |
777 | | { 0, 0, 0, 0, 2, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0 }, /* PT_SC */ |
778 | | { 0, 3, 6, 12, 0, 3, 1, 1, 0, 0, 0 }, /* PT_ALNUM */ |
779 | | { 0, 1, 7, 13, 0, 1, 3, 3, 1, 0, 0 }, /* PT_SPACE */ |
780 | | { 0, 1, 7, 13, 0, 1, 3, 3, 1, 0, 0 }, /* PT_PXSPACE */ |
781 | | { 0, 0, 8, 14, 0, 0, 1, 1, 3, 0, 0 }, /* PT_WORD */ |
782 | | { 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0 }, /* PT_CLIST */ |
783 | | { 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 3 } /* PT_UCNC */ |
784 | | }; |
785 | | |
786 | | /* This table is used to check whether auto-possessification is possible |
787 | | between adjacent Unicode property opcodes (OP_PROP and OP_NOTPROP) when one |
788 | | specifies a general category and the other specifies a particular category. The |
789 | | row is selected by the general category and the column by the particular |
790 | | category. The value is 1 if the particular category is not part of the general |
791 | | category. */ |
792 | | |
793 | | static const pcre_uint8 catposstab[7][30] = { |
794 | | /* Cc Cf Cn Co Cs Ll Lm Lo Lt Lu Mc Me Mn Nd Nl No Pc Pd Pe Pf Pi Po Ps Sc Sk Sm So Zl Zp Zs */ |
795 | | { 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1 }, /* C */ |
796 | | { 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1 }, /* L */ |
797 | | { 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 0, 0, 0, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1 }, /* M */ |
798 | | { 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 0, 0, 0, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1 }, /* N */ |
799 | | { 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1 }, /* P */ |
800 | | { 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 0, 0, 0, 0, 1, 1, 1 }, /* S */ |
801 | | { 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 0, 0, 0 } /* Z */ |
802 | | }; |
803 | | |
804 | | /* This table is used when checking ALNUM, (PX)SPACE, SPACE, and WORD against |
805 | | a general or particular category. The properties in each row are those |
806 | | that apply to the character set in question. Duplication means that a little |
807 | | unnecessary work is done when checking, but this keeps things much simpler |
808 | | because they can all use the same code. For more details see the comment where |
809 | | this table is used. |
810 | | |
811 | | Note: SPACE and PXSPACE used to be different because Perl excluded VT from |
812 | | "space", but from Perl 5.18 it's included, so both categories are treated the |
813 | | same here. */ |
814 | | |
815 | | static const pcre_uint8 posspropstab[3][4] = { |
816 | | { ucp_L, ucp_N, ucp_N, ucp_Nl }, /* ALNUM, 3rd and 4th values redundant */ |
817 | | { ucp_Z, ucp_Z, ucp_C, ucp_Cc }, /* SPACE and PXSPACE, 2nd value redundant */ |
818 | | { ucp_L, ucp_N, ucp_P, ucp_Po } /* WORD */ |
819 | | }; |
820 | | |
821 | | /* This table is used when converting repeating opcodes into possessified |
822 | | versions as a result of an explicit possessive quantifier such as ++. A zero |
823 | | value means there is no possessified version - in those cases the item in |
824 | | question must be wrapped in ONCE brackets. The table is truncated at OP_CALLOUT |
825 | | because all relevant opcodes are less than that. */ |
826 | | |
827 | | static const pcre_uint8 opcode_possessify[] = { |
828 | | 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, /* 0 - 15 */ |
829 | | 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, /* 16 - 31 */ |
830 | | |
831 | | 0, /* NOTI */ |
832 | | OP_POSSTAR, 0, /* STAR, MINSTAR */ |
833 | | OP_POSPLUS, 0, /* PLUS, MINPLUS */ |
834 | | OP_POSQUERY, 0, /* QUERY, MINQUERY */ |
835 | | OP_POSUPTO, 0, /* UPTO, MINUPTO */ |
836 | | 0, /* EXACT */ |
837 | | 0, 0, 0, 0, /* POS{STAR,PLUS,QUERY,UPTO} */ |
838 | | |
839 | | OP_POSSTARI, 0, /* STARI, MINSTARI */ |
840 | | OP_POSPLUSI, 0, /* PLUSI, MINPLUSI */ |
841 | | OP_POSQUERYI, 0, /* QUERYI, MINQUERYI */ |
842 | | OP_POSUPTOI, 0, /* UPTOI, MINUPTOI */ |
843 | | 0, /* EXACTI */ |
844 | | 0, 0, 0, 0, /* POS{STARI,PLUSI,QUERYI,UPTOI} */ |
845 | | |
846 | | OP_NOTPOSSTAR, 0, /* NOTSTAR, NOTMINSTAR */ |
847 | | OP_NOTPOSPLUS, 0, /* NOTPLUS, NOTMINPLUS */ |
848 | | OP_NOTPOSQUERY, 0, /* NOTQUERY, NOTMINQUERY */ |
849 | | OP_NOTPOSUPTO, 0, /* NOTUPTO, NOTMINUPTO */ |
850 | | 0, /* NOTEXACT */ |
851 | | 0, 0, 0, 0, /* NOTPOS{STAR,PLUS,QUERY,UPTO} */ |
852 | | |
853 | | OP_NOTPOSSTARI, 0, /* NOTSTARI, NOTMINSTARI */ |
854 | | OP_NOTPOSPLUSI, 0, /* NOTPLUSI, NOTMINPLUSI */ |
855 | | OP_NOTPOSQUERYI, 0, /* NOTQUERYI, NOTMINQUERYI */ |
856 | | OP_NOTPOSUPTOI, 0, /* NOTUPTOI, NOTMINUPTOI */ |
857 | | 0, /* NOTEXACTI */ |
858 | | 0, 0, 0, 0, /* NOTPOS{STARI,PLUSI,QUERYI,UPTOI} */ |
859 | | |
860 | | OP_TYPEPOSSTAR, 0, /* TYPESTAR, TYPEMINSTAR */ |
861 | | OP_TYPEPOSPLUS, 0, /* TYPEPLUS, TYPEMINPLUS */ |
862 | | OP_TYPEPOSQUERY, 0, /* TYPEQUERY, TYPEMINQUERY */ |
863 | | OP_TYPEPOSUPTO, 0, /* TYPEUPTO, TYPEMINUPTO */ |
864 | | 0, /* TYPEEXACT */ |
865 | | 0, 0, 0, 0, /* TYPEPOS{STAR,PLUS,QUERY,UPTO} */ |
866 | | |
867 | | OP_CRPOSSTAR, 0, /* CRSTAR, CRMINSTAR */ |
868 | | OP_CRPOSPLUS, 0, /* CRPLUS, CRMINPLUS */ |
869 | | OP_CRPOSQUERY, 0, /* CRQUERY, CRMINQUERY */ |
870 | | OP_CRPOSRANGE, 0, /* CRRANGE, CRMINRANGE */ |
871 | | 0, 0, 0, 0, /* CRPOS{STAR,PLUS,QUERY,RANGE} */ |
872 | | |
873 | | 0, 0, 0, /* CLASS, NCLASS, XCLASS */ |
874 | | 0, 0, /* REF, REFI */ |
875 | | 0, 0, /* DNREF, DNREFI */ |
876 | | 0, 0 /* RECURSE, CALLOUT */ |
877 | | }; |
878 | | |
879 | | |
880 | | |
881 | | /************************************************* |
882 | | * Find an error text * |
883 | | *************************************************/ |
884 | | |
885 | | /* The error texts are now all in one long string, to save on relocations. As |
886 | | some of the text is of unknown length, we can't use a table of offsets. |
887 | | Instead, just count through the strings. This is not a performance issue |
888 | | because it happens only when there has been a compilation error. |
889 | | |
890 | | Argument: the error number |
891 | | Returns: pointer to the error string |
892 | | */ |
893 | | |
894 | | static const char * |
895 | | find_error_text(int n) |
896 | 0 | { |
897 | 0 | const char *s = error_texts; |
898 | 0 | for (; n > 0; n--) |
899 | 0 | { |
900 | 0 | while (*s++ != CHAR_NULL) {}; |
901 | 0 | if (*s == CHAR_NULL) return "Error text not found (please report)"; |
902 | 0 | } |
903 | 0 | return s; |
904 | 0 | } |
905 | | |
906 | | |
907 | | |
908 | | /************************************************* |
909 | | * Expand the workspace * |
910 | | *************************************************/ |
911 | | |
912 | | /* This function is called during the second compiling phase, if the number of |
913 | | forward references fills the existing workspace, which is originally a block on |
914 | | the stack. A larger block is obtained from malloc() unless the ultimate limit |
915 | | has been reached or the increase will be rather small. |
916 | | |
917 | | Argument: pointer to the compile data block |
918 | | Returns: 0 if all went well, else an error number |
919 | | */ |
920 | | |
921 | | static int |
922 | | expand_workspace(compile_data *cd) |
923 | 0 | { |
924 | 0 | pcre_uchar *newspace; |
925 | 0 | int newsize = cd->workspace_size * 2; |
926 | |
|
927 | 0 | if (newsize > COMPILE_WORK_SIZE_MAX) newsize = COMPILE_WORK_SIZE_MAX; |
928 | 0 | if (cd->workspace_size >= COMPILE_WORK_SIZE_MAX || |
929 | 0 | newsize - cd->workspace_size < WORK_SIZE_SAFETY_MARGIN) |
930 | 0 | return ERR72; |
931 | | |
932 | 0 | newspace = (PUBL(malloc))(IN_UCHARS(newsize)); |
933 | 0 | if (newspace == NULL) return ERR21; |
934 | 0 | memcpy(newspace, cd->start_workspace, cd->workspace_size * sizeof(pcre_uchar)); |
935 | 0 | cd->hwm = (pcre_uchar *)newspace + (cd->hwm - cd->start_workspace); |
936 | 0 | if (cd->workspace_size > COMPILE_WORK_SIZE) |
937 | 0 | (PUBL(free))((void *)cd->start_workspace); |
938 | 0 | cd->start_workspace = newspace; |
939 | 0 | cd->workspace_size = newsize; |
940 | 0 | return 0; |
941 | 0 | } |
942 | | |
943 | | |
944 | | |
945 | | /************************************************* |
946 | | * Check for counted repeat * |
947 | | *************************************************/ |
948 | | |
949 | | /* This function is called when a '{' is encountered in a place where it might |
950 | | start a quantifier. It looks ahead to see if it really is a quantifier or not. |
951 | | It is only a quantifier if it is one of the forms {ddd} {ddd,} or {ddd,ddd} |
952 | | where the ddds are digits. |
953 | | |
954 | | Arguments: |
955 | | p pointer to the first char after '{' |
956 | | |
957 | | Returns: TRUE or FALSE |
958 | | */ |
959 | | |
960 | | static BOOL |
961 | | is_counted_repeat(const pcre_uchar *p) |
962 | 0 | { |
963 | 0 | if (!IS_DIGIT(*p)) return FALSE; |
964 | 0 | p++; |
965 | 0 | while (IS_DIGIT(*p)) p++; |
966 | 0 | if (*p == CHAR_RIGHT_CURLY_BRACKET) return TRUE; |
967 | | |
968 | 0 | if (*p++ != CHAR_COMMA) return FALSE; |
969 | 0 | if (*p == CHAR_RIGHT_CURLY_BRACKET) return TRUE; |
970 | | |
971 | 0 | if (!IS_DIGIT(*p)) return FALSE; |
972 | 0 | p++; |
973 | 0 | while (IS_DIGIT(*p)) p++; |
974 | |
|
975 | 0 | return (*p == CHAR_RIGHT_CURLY_BRACKET); |
976 | 0 | } |
977 | | |
978 | | |
979 | | |
980 | | /************************************************* |
981 | | * Handle escapes * |
982 | | *************************************************/ |
983 | | |
984 | | /* This function is called when a \ has been encountered. It either returns a |
985 | | positive value for a simple escape such as \n, or 0 for a data character which |
986 | | will be placed in chptr. A backreference to group n is returned as negative n. |
987 | | When UTF-8 is enabled, a positive value greater than 255 may be returned in |
988 | | chptr. On entry, ptr is pointing at the \. On exit, it is on the final |
989 | | character of the escape sequence. |
990 | | |
991 | | Arguments: |
992 | | ptrptr points to the pattern position pointer |
993 | | chptr points to a returned data character |
994 | | errorcodeptr points to the errorcode variable |
995 | | bracount number of previous extracting brackets |
996 | | options the options bits |
997 | | isclass TRUE if inside a character class |
998 | | |
999 | | Returns: zero => a data character |
1000 | | positive => a special escape sequence |
1001 | | negative => a back reference |
1002 | | on error, errorcodeptr is set |
1003 | | */ |
1004 | | |
1005 | | static int |
1006 | | check_escape(const pcre_uchar **ptrptr, pcre_uint32 *chptr, int *errorcodeptr, |
1007 | | int bracount, int options, BOOL isclass) |
1008 | 0 | { |
1009 | | /* PCRE_UTF16 has the same value as PCRE_UTF8. */ |
1010 | 0 | BOOL utf = (options & PCRE_UTF8) != 0; |
1011 | 0 | const pcre_uchar *ptr = *ptrptr + 1; |
1012 | 0 | pcre_uint32 c; |
1013 | 0 | int escape = 0; |
1014 | 0 | int i; |
1015 | |
|
1016 | 0 | GETCHARINCTEST(c, ptr); /* Get character value, increment pointer */ |
1017 | 0 | ptr--; /* Set pointer back to the last byte */ |
1018 | | |
1019 | | /* If backslash is at the end of the pattern, it's an error. */ |
1020 | |
|
1021 | 0 | if (c == CHAR_NULL) *errorcodeptr = ERR1; |
1022 | | |
1023 | | /* Non-alphanumerics are literals. For digits or letters, do an initial lookup |
1024 | | in a table. A non-zero result is something that can be returned immediately. |
1025 | | Otherwise further processing may be required. */ |
1026 | | |
1027 | 0 | #ifndef EBCDIC /* ASCII/UTF-8 coding */ |
1028 | | /* Not alphanumeric */ |
1029 | 0 | else if (c < CHAR_0 || c > CHAR_z) {} |
1030 | 0 | else if ((i = escapes[c - CHAR_0]) != 0) |
1031 | 0 | { if (i > 0) c = (pcre_uint32)i; else escape = -i; } |
1032 | | |
1033 | | #else /* EBCDIC coding */ |
1034 | | /* Not alphanumeric */ |
1035 | | else if (c < CHAR_a || (!MAX_255(c) || (ebcdic_chartab[c] & 0x0E) == 0)) {} |
1036 | | else if ((i = escapes[c - 0x48]) != 0) { if (i > 0) c = (pcre_uint32)i; else escape = -i; } |
1037 | | #endif |
1038 | | |
1039 | | /* Escapes that need further processing, or are illegal. */ |
1040 | | |
1041 | 0 | else |
1042 | 0 | { |
1043 | 0 | const pcre_uchar *oldptr; |
1044 | 0 | BOOL braced, negated, overflow; |
1045 | 0 | int s; |
1046 | |
|
1047 | 0 | switch (c) |
1048 | 0 | { |
1049 | | /* A number of Perl escapes are not handled by PCRE. We give an explicit |
1050 | | error. */ |
1051 | | |
1052 | 0 | case CHAR_l: |
1053 | 0 | case CHAR_L: |
1054 | 0 | *errorcodeptr = ERR37; |
1055 | 0 | break; |
1056 | | |
1057 | 0 | case CHAR_u: |
1058 | 0 | if ((options & PCRE_JAVASCRIPT_COMPAT) != 0) |
1059 | 0 | { |
1060 | | /* In JavaScript, \u must be followed by four hexadecimal numbers. |
1061 | | Otherwise it is a lowercase u letter. */ |
1062 | 0 | if (MAX_255(ptr[1]) && (digitab[ptr[1]] & ctype_xdigit) != 0 |
1063 | 0 | && MAX_255(ptr[2]) && (digitab[ptr[2]] & ctype_xdigit) != 0 |
1064 | 0 | && MAX_255(ptr[3]) && (digitab[ptr[3]] & ctype_xdigit) != 0 |
1065 | 0 | && MAX_255(ptr[4]) && (digitab[ptr[4]] & ctype_xdigit) != 0) |
1066 | 0 | { |
1067 | 0 | c = 0; |
1068 | 0 | for (i = 0; i < 4; ++i) |
1069 | 0 | { |
1070 | 0 | register pcre_uint32 cc = *(++ptr); |
1071 | 0 | #ifndef EBCDIC /* ASCII/UTF-8 coding */ |
1072 | 0 | if (cc >= CHAR_a) cc -= 32; /* Convert to upper case */ |
1073 | 0 | c = (c << 4) + cc - ((cc < CHAR_A)? CHAR_0 : (CHAR_A - 10)); |
1074 | | #else /* EBCDIC coding */ |
1075 | | if (cc >= CHAR_a && cc <= CHAR_z) cc += 64; /* Convert to upper case */ |
1076 | | c = (c << 4) + cc - ((cc >= CHAR_0)? CHAR_0 : (CHAR_A - 10)); |
1077 | | #endif |
1078 | 0 | } |
1079 | |
|
1080 | 0 | #if defined COMPILE_PCRE8 |
1081 | 0 | if (c > (utf ? 0x10ffffU : 0xffU)) |
1082 | | #elif defined COMPILE_PCRE16 |
1083 | | if (c > (utf ? 0x10ffffU : 0xffffU)) |
1084 | | #elif defined COMPILE_PCRE32 |
1085 | | if (utf && c > 0x10ffffU) |
1086 | | #endif |
1087 | 0 | { |
1088 | 0 | *errorcodeptr = ERR76; |
1089 | 0 | } |
1090 | 0 | else if (utf && c >= 0xd800 && c <= 0xdfff) *errorcodeptr = ERR73; |
1091 | 0 | } |
1092 | 0 | } |
1093 | 0 | else |
1094 | 0 | *errorcodeptr = ERR37; |
1095 | 0 | break; |
1096 | | |
1097 | 0 | case CHAR_U: |
1098 | | /* In JavaScript, \U is an uppercase U letter. */ |
1099 | 0 | if ((options & PCRE_JAVASCRIPT_COMPAT) == 0) *errorcodeptr = ERR37; |
1100 | 0 | break; |
1101 | | |
1102 | | /* In a character class, \g is just a literal "g". Outside a character |
1103 | | class, \g must be followed by one of a number of specific things: |
1104 | | |
1105 | | (1) A number, either plain or braced. If positive, it is an absolute |
1106 | | backreference. If negative, it is a relative backreference. This is a Perl |
1107 | | 5.10 feature. |
1108 | | |
1109 | | (2) Perl 5.10 also supports \g{name} as a reference to a named group. This |
1110 | | is part of Perl's movement towards a unified syntax for back references. As |
1111 | | this is synonymous with \k{name}, we fudge it up by pretending it really |
1112 | | was \k. |
1113 | | |
1114 | | (3) For Oniguruma compatibility we also support \g followed by a name or a |
1115 | | number either in angle brackets or in single quotes. However, these are |
1116 | | (possibly recursive) subroutine calls, _not_ backreferences. Just return |
1117 | | the ESC_g code (cf \k). */ |
1118 | | |
1119 | 0 | case CHAR_g: |
1120 | 0 | if (isclass) break; |
1121 | 0 | if (ptr[1] == CHAR_LESS_THAN_SIGN || ptr[1] == CHAR_APOSTROPHE) |
1122 | 0 | { |
1123 | 0 | escape = ESC_g; |
1124 | 0 | break; |
1125 | 0 | } |
1126 | | |
1127 | | /* Handle the Perl-compatible cases */ |
1128 | | |
1129 | 0 | if (ptr[1] == CHAR_LEFT_CURLY_BRACKET) |
1130 | 0 | { |
1131 | 0 | const pcre_uchar *p; |
1132 | 0 | for (p = ptr+2; *p != CHAR_NULL && *p != CHAR_RIGHT_CURLY_BRACKET; p++) |
1133 | 0 | if (*p != CHAR_MINUS && !IS_DIGIT(*p)) break; |
1134 | 0 | if (*p != CHAR_NULL && *p != CHAR_RIGHT_CURLY_BRACKET) |
1135 | 0 | { |
1136 | 0 | escape = ESC_k; |
1137 | 0 | break; |
1138 | 0 | } |
1139 | 0 | braced = TRUE; |
1140 | 0 | ptr++; |
1141 | 0 | } |
1142 | 0 | else braced = FALSE; |
1143 | | |
1144 | 0 | if (ptr[1] == CHAR_MINUS) |
1145 | 0 | { |
1146 | 0 | negated = TRUE; |
1147 | 0 | ptr++; |
1148 | 0 | } |
1149 | 0 | else negated = FALSE; |
1150 | | |
1151 | | /* The integer range is limited by the machine's int representation. */ |
1152 | 0 | s = 0; |
1153 | 0 | overflow = FALSE; |
1154 | 0 | while (IS_DIGIT(ptr[1])) |
1155 | 0 | { |
1156 | 0 | if (s > INT_MAX / 10 - 1) /* Integer overflow */ |
1157 | 0 | { |
1158 | 0 | overflow = TRUE; |
1159 | 0 | break; |
1160 | 0 | } |
1161 | 0 | s = s * 10 + (int)(*(++ptr) - CHAR_0); |
1162 | 0 | } |
1163 | 0 | if (overflow) /* Integer overflow */ |
1164 | 0 | { |
1165 | 0 | while (IS_DIGIT(ptr[1])) |
1166 | 0 | ptr++; |
1167 | 0 | *errorcodeptr = ERR61; |
1168 | 0 | break; |
1169 | 0 | } |
1170 | | |
1171 | 0 | if (braced && *(++ptr) != CHAR_RIGHT_CURLY_BRACKET) |
1172 | 0 | { |
1173 | 0 | *errorcodeptr = ERR57; |
1174 | 0 | break; |
1175 | 0 | } |
1176 | | |
1177 | 0 | if (s == 0) |
1178 | 0 | { |
1179 | 0 | *errorcodeptr = ERR58; |
1180 | 0 | break; |
1181 | 0 | } |
1182 | | |
1183 | 0 | if (negated) |
1184 | 0 | { |
1185 | 0 | if (s > bracount) |
1186 | 0 | { |
1187 | 0 | *errorcodeptr = ERR15; |
1188 | 0 | break; |
1189 | 0 | } |
1190 | 0 | s = bracount - (s - 1); |
1191 | 0 | } |
1192 | | |
1193 | 0 | escape = -s; |
1194 | 0 | break; |
1195 | | |
1196 | | /* The handling of escape sequences consisting of a string of digits |
1197 | | starting with one that is not zero is not straightforward. Perl has changed |
1198 | | over the years. Nowadays \g{} for backreferences and \o{} for octal are |
1199 | | recommended to avoid the ambiguities in the old syntax. |
1200 | | |
1201 | | Outside a character class, the digits are read as a decimal number. If the |
1202 | | number is less than 8 (used to be 10), or if there are that many previous |
1203 | | extracting left brackets, then it is a back reference. Otherwise, up to |
1204 | | three octal digits are read to form an escaped byte. Thus \123 is likely to |
1205 | | be octal 123 (cf \0123, which is octal 012 followed by the literal 3). If |
1206 | | the octal value is greater than 377, the least significant 8 bits are |
1207 | | taken. \8 and \9 are treated as the literal characters 8 and 9. |
1208 | | |
1209 | | Inside a character class, \ followed by a digit is always either a literal |
1210 | | 8 or 9 or an octal number. */ |
1211 | | |
1212 | 0 | case CHAR_1: case CHAR_2: case CHAR_3: case CHAR_4: case CHAR_5: |
1213 | 0 | case CHAR_6: case CHAR_7: case CHAR_8: case CHAR_9: |
1214 | |
|
1215 | 0 | if (!isclass) |
1216 | 0 | { |
1217 | 0 | oldptr = ptr; |
1218 | | /* The integer range is limited by the machine's int representation. */ |
1219 | 0 | s = (int)(c -CHAR_0); |
1220 | 0 | overflow = FALSE; |
1221 | 0 | while (IS_DIGIT(ptr[1])) |
1222 | 0 | { |
1223 | 0 | if (s > INT_MAX / 10 - 1) /* Integer overflow */ |
1224 | 0 | { |
1225 | 0 | overflow = TRUE; |
1226 | 0 | break; |
1227 | 0 | } |
1228 | 0 | s = s * 10 + (int)(*(++ptr) - CHAR_0); |
1229 | 0 | } |
1230 | 0 | if (overflow) /* Integer overflow */ |
1231 | 0 | { |
1232 | 0 | while (IS_DIGIT(ptr[1])) |
1233 | 0 | ptr++; |
1234 | 0 | *errorcodeptr = ERR61; |
1235 | 0 | break; |
1236 | 0 | } |
1237 | 0 | if (s < 8 || s <= bracount) /* Check for back reference */ |
1238 | 0 | { |
1239 | 0 | escape = -s; |
1240 | 0 | break; |
1241 | 0 | } |
1242 | 0 | ptr = oldptr; /* Put the pointer back and fall through */ |
1243 | 0 | } |
1244 | | |
1245 | | /* Handle a digit following \ when the number is not a back reference. If |
1246 | | the first digit is 8 or 9, Perl used to generate a binary zero byte and |
1247 | | then treat the digit as a following literal. At least by Perl 5.18 this |
1248 | | changed so as not to insert the binary zero. */ |
1249 | | |
1250 | 0 | if ((c = *ptr) >= CHAR_8) break; |
1251 | | |
1252 | | /* Fall through with a digit less than 8 */ |
1253 | | |
1254 | | /* \0 always starts an octal number, but we may drop through to here with a |
1255 | | larger first octal digit. The original code used just to take the least |
1256 | | significant 8 bits of octal numbers (I think this is what early Perls used |
1257 | | to do). Nowadays we allow for larger numbers in UTF-8 mode and 16-bit mode, |
1258 | | but no more than 3 octal digits. */ |
1259 | | |
1260 | 0 | case CHAR_0: |
1261 | 0 | c -= CHAR_0; |
1262 | 0 | while(i++ < 2 && ptr[1] >= CHAR_0 && ptr[1] <= CHAR_7) |
1263 | 0 | c = c * 8 + *(++ptr) - CHAR_0; |
1264 | 0 | #ifdef COMPILE_PCRE8 |
1265 | 0 | if (!utf && c > 0xff) *errorcodeptr = ERR51; |
1266 | 0 | #endif |
1267 | 0 | break; |
1268 | | |
1269 | | /* \o is a relatively new Perl feature, supporting a more general way of |
1270 | | specifying character codes in octal. The only supported form is \o{ddd}. */ |
1271 | | |
1272 | 0 | case CHAR_o: |
1273 | 0 | if (ptr[1] != CHAR_LEFT_CURLY_BRACKET) *errorcodeptr = ERR81; else |
1274 | 0 | if (ptr[2] == CHAR_RIGHT_CURLY_BRACKET) *errorcodeptr = ERR86; else |
1275 | 0 | { |
1276 | 0 | ptr += 2; |
1277 | 0 | c = 0; |
1278 | 0 | overflow = FALSE; |
1279 | 0 | while (*ptr >= CHAR_0 && *ptr <= CHAR_7) |
1280 | 0 | { |
1281 | 0 | register pcre_uint32 cc = *ptr++; |
1282 | 0 | if (c == 0 && cc == CHAR_0) continue; /* Leading zeroes */ |
1283 | | #ifdef COMPILE_PCRE32 |
1284 | | if (c >= 0x20000000l) { overflow = TRUE; break; } |
1285 | | #endif |
1286 | 0 | c = (c << 3) + cc - CHAR_0 ; |
1287 | 0 | #if defined COMPILE_PCRE8 |
1288 | 0 | if (c > (utf ? 0x10ffffU : 0xffU)) { overflow = TRUE; break; } |
1289 | | #elif defined COMPILE_PCRE16 |
1290 | | if (c > (utf ? 0x10ffffU : 0xffffU)) { overflow = TRUE; break; } |
1291 | | #elif defined COMPILE_PCRE32 |
1292 | | if (utf && c > 0x10ffffU) { overflow = TRUE; break; } |
1293 | | #endif |
1294 | 0 | } |
1295 | 0 | if (overflow) |
1296 | 0 | { |
1297 | 0 | while (*ptr >= CHAR_0 && *ptr <= CHAR_7) ptr++; |
1298 | 0 | *errorcodeptr = ERR34; |
1299 | 0 | } |
1300 | 0 | else if (*ptr == CHAR_RIGHT_CURLY_BRACKET) |
1301 | 0 | { |
1302 | 0 | if (utf && c >= 0xd800 && c <= 0xdfff) *errorcodeptr = ERR73; |
1303 | 0 | } |
1304 | 0 | else *errorcodeptr = ERR80; |
1305 | 0 | } |
1306 | 0 | break; |
1307 | | |
1308 | | /* \x is complicated. In JavaScript, \x must be followed by two hexadecimal |
1309 | | numbers. Otherwise it is a lowercase x letter. */ |
1310 | | |
1311 | 0 | case CHAR_x: |
1312 | 0 | if ((options & PCRE_JAVASCRIPT_COMPAT) != 0) |
1313 | 0 | { |
1314 | 0 | if (MAX_255(ptr[1]) && (digitab[ptr[1]] & ctype_xdigit) != 0 |
1315 | 0 | && MAX_255(ptr[2]) && (digitab[ptr[2]] & ctype_xdigit) != 0) |
1316 | 0 | { |
1317 | 0 | c = 0; |
1318 | 0 | for (i = 0; i < 2; ++i) |
1319 | 0 | { |
1320 | 0 | register pcre_uint32 cc = *(++ptr); |
1321 | 0 | #ifndef EBCDIC /* ASCII/UTF-8 coding */ |
1322 | 0 | if (cc >= CHAR_a) cc -= 32; /* Convert to upper case */ |
1323 | 0 | c = (c << 4) + cc - ((cc < CHAR_A)? CHAR_0 : (CHAR_A - 10)); |
1324 | | #else /* EBCDIC coding */ |
1325 | | if (cc >= CHAR_a && cc <= CHAR_z) cc += 64; /* Convert to upper case */ |
1326 | | c = (c << 4) + cc - ((cc >= CHAR_0)? CHAR_0 : (CHAR_A - 10)); |
1327 | | #endif |
1328 | 0 | } |
1329 | 0 | } |
1330 | 0 | } /* End JavaScript handling */ |
1331 | | |
1332 | | /* Handle \x in Perl's style. \x{ddd} is a character number which can be |
1333 | | greater than 0xff in utf or non-8bit mode, but only if the ddd are hex |
1334 | | digits. If not, { used to be treated as a data character. However, Perl |
1335 | | seems to read hex digits up to the first non-such, and ignore the rest, so |
1336 | | that, for example \x{zz} matches a binary zero. This seems crazy, so PCRE |
1337 | | now gives an error. */ |
1338 | | |
1339 | 0 | else |
1340 | 0 | { |
1341 | 0 | if (ptr[1] == CHAR_LEFT_CURLY_BRACKET) |
1342 | 0 | { |
1343 | 0 | ptr += 2; |
1344 | 0 | if (*ptr == CHAR_RIGHT_CURLY_BRACKET) |
1345 | 0 | { |
1346 | 0 | *errorcodeptr = ERR86; |
1347 | 0 | break; |
1348 | 0 | } |
1349 | 0 | c = 0; |
1350 | 0 | overflow = FALSE; |
1351 | 0 | while (MAX_255(*ptr) && (digitab[*ptr] & ctype_xdigit) != 0) |
1352 | 0 | { |
1353 | 0 | register pcre_uint32 cc = *ptr++; |
1354 | 0 | if (c == 0 && cc == CHAR_0) continue; /* Leading zeroes */ |
1355 | | |
1356 | | #ifdef COMPILE_PCRE32 |
1357 | | if (c >= 0x10000000l) { overflow = TRUE; break; } |
1358 | | #endif |
1359 | | |
1360 | 0 | #ifndef EBCDIC /* ASCII/UTF-8 coding */ |
1361 | 0 | if (cc >= CHAR_a) cc -= 32; /* Convert to upper case */ |
1362 | 0 | c = (c << 4) + cc - ((cc < CHAR_A)? CHAR_0 : (CHAR_A - 10)); |
1363 | | #else /* EBCDIC coding */ |
1364 | | if (cc >= CHAR_a && cc <= CHAR_z) cc += 64; /* Convert to upper case */ |
1365 | | c = (c << 4) + cc - ((cc >= CHAR_0)? CHAR_0 : (CHAR_A - 10)); |
1366 | | #endif |
1367 | |
|
1368 | 0 | #if defined COMPILE_PCRE8 |
1369 | 0 | if (c > (utf ? 0x10ffffU : 0xffU)) { overflow = TRUE; break; } |
1370 | | #elif defined COMPILE_PCRE16 |
1371 | | if (c > (utf ? 0x10ffffU : 0xffffU)) { overflow = TRUE; break; } |
1372 | | #elif defined COMPILE_PCRE32 |
1373 | | if (utf && c > 0x10ffffU) { overflow = TRUE; break; } |
1374 | | #endif |
1375 | 0 | } |
1376 | |
|
1377 | 0 | if (overflow) |
1378 | 0 | { |
1379 | 0 | while (MAX_255(*ptr) && (digitab[*ptr] & ctype_xdigit) != 0) ptr++; |
1380 | 0 | *errorcodeptr = ERR34; |
1381 | 0 | } |
1382 | | |
1383 | 0 | else if (*ptr == CHAR_RIGHT_CURLY_BRACKET) |
1384 | 0 | { |
1385 | 0 | if (utf && c >= 0xd800 && c <= 0xdfff) *errorcodeptr = ERR73; |
1386 | 0 | } |
1387 | | |
1388 | | /* If the sequence of hex digits does not end with '}', give an error. |
1389 | | We used just to recognize this construct and fall through to the normal |
1390 | | \x handling, but nowadays Perl gives an error, which seems much more |
1391 | | sensible, so we do too. */ |
1392 | | |
1393 | 0 | else *errorcodeptr = ERR79; |
1394 | 0 | } /* End of \x{} processing */ |
1395 | | |
1396 | | /* Read a single-byte hex-defined char (up to two hex digits after \x) */ |
1397 | | |
1398 | 0 | else |
1399 | 0 | { |
1400 | 0 | c = 0; |
1401 | 0 | while (i++ < 2 && MAX_255(ptr[1]) && (digitab[ptr[1]] & ctype_xdigit) != 0) |
1402 | 0 | { |
1403 | 0 | pcre_uint32 cc; /* Some compilers don't like */ |
1404 | 0 | cc = *(++ptr); /* ++ in initializers */ |
1405 | 0 | #ifndef EBCDIC /* ASCII/UTF-8 coding */ |
1406 | 0 | if (cc >= CHAR_a) cc -= 32; /* Convert to upper case */ |
1407 | 0 | c = c * 16 + cc - ((cc < CHAR_A)? CHAR_0 : (CHAR_A - 10)); |
1408 | | #else /* EBCDIC coding */ |
1409 | | if (cc <= CHAR_z) cc += 64; /* Convert to upper case */ |
1410 | | c = c * 16 + cc - ((cc >= CHAR_0)? CHAR_0 : (CHAR_A - 10)); |
1411 | | #endif |
1412 | 0 | } |
1413 | 0 | } /* End of \xdd handling */ |
1414 | 0 | } /* End of Perl-style \x handling */ |
1415 | 0 | break; |
1416 | | |
1417 | | /* For \c, a following letter is upper-cased; then the 0x40 bit is flipped. |
1418 | | An error is given if the byte following \c is not an ASCII character. This |
1419 | | coding is ASCII-specific, but then the whole concept of \cx is |
1420 | | ASCII-specific. (However, an EBCDIC equivalent has now been added.) */ |
1421 | | |
1422 | 0 | case CHAR_c: |
1423 | 0 | c = *(++ptr); |
1424 | 0 | if (c == CHAR_NULL) |
1425 | 0 | { |
1426 | 0 | *errorcodeptr = ERR2; |
1427 | 0 | break; |
1428 | 0 | } |
1429 | 0 | #ifndef EBCDIC /* ASCII/UTF-8 coding */ |
1430 | 0 | if (c > 127) /* Excludes all non-ASCII in either mode */ |
1431 | 0 | { |
1432 | 0 | *errorcodeptr = ERR68; |
1433 | 0 | break; |
1434 | 0 | } |
1435 | 0 | if (c >= CHAR_a && c <= CHAR_z) c -= 32; |
1436 | 0 | c ^= 0x40; |
1437 | | #else /* EBCDIC coding */ |
1438 | | if (c >= CHAR_a && c <= CHAR_z) c += 64; |
1439 | | if (c == CHAR_QUESTION_MARK) |
1440 | | c = ('\\' == 188 && '`' == 74)? 0x5f : 0xff; |
1441 | | else |
1442 | | { |
1443 | | for (i = 0; i < 32; i++) |
1444 | | { |
1445 | | if (c == ebcdic_escape_c[i]) break; |
1446 | | } |
1447 | | if (i < 32) c = i; else *errorcodeptr = ERR68; |
1448 | | } |
1449 | | #endif |
1450 | 0 | break; |
1451 | | |
1452 | | /* PCRE_EXTRA enables extensions to Perl in the matter of escapes. Any |
1453 | | other alphanumeric following \ is an error if PCRE_EXTRA was set; |
1454 | | otherwise, for Perl compatibility, it is a literal. This code looks a bit |
1455 | | odd, but there used to be some cases other than the default, and there may |
1456 | | be again in future, so I haven't "optimized" it. */ |
1457 | | |
1458 | 0 | default: |
1459 | 0 | if ((options & PCRE_EXTRA) != 0) switch(c) |
1460 | 0 | { |
1461 | 0 | default: |
1462 | 0 | *errorcodeptr = ERR3; |
1463 | 0 | break; |
1464 | 0 | } |
1465 | 0 | break; |
1466 | 0 | } |
1467 | 0 | } |
1468 | | |
1469 | | /* Perl supports \N{name} for character names, as well as plain \N for "not |
1470 | | newline". PCRE does not support \N{name}. However, it does support |
1471 | | quantification such as \N{2,3}. */ |
1472 | | |
1473 | 0 | if (escape == ESC_N && ptr[1] == CHAR_LEFT_CURLY_BRACKET && |
1474 | 0 | !is_counted_repeat(ptr+2)) |
1475 | 0 | *errorcodeptr = ERR37; |
1476 | | |
1477 | | /* If PCRE_UCP is set, we change the values for \d etc. */ |
1478 | |
|
1479 | 0 | if ((options & PCRE_UCP) != 0 && escape >= ESC_D && escape <= ESC_w) |
1480 | 0 | escape += (ESC_DU - ESC_D); |
1481 | | |
1482 | | /* Set the pointer to the final character before returning. */ |
1483 | |
|
1484 | 0 | *ptrptr = ptr; |
1485 | 0 | *chptr = c; |
1486 | 0 | return escape; |
1487 | 0 | } |
1488 | | |
1489 | | |
1490 | | |
1491 | | #ifdef SUPPORT_UCP |
1492 | | /************************************************* |
1493 | | * Handle \P and \p * |
1494 | | *************************************************/ |
1495 | | |
1496 | | /* This function is called after \P or \p has been encountered, provided that |
1497 | | PCRE is compiled with support for Unicode properties. On entry, ptrptr is |
1498 | | pointing at the P or p. On exit, it is pointing at the final character of the |
1499 | | escape sequence. |
1500 | | |
1501 | | Argument: |
1502 | | ptrptr points to the pattern position pointer |
1503 | | negptr points to a boolean that is set TRUE for negation else FALSE |
1504 | | ptypeptr points to an unsigned int that is set to the type value |
1505 | | pdataptr points to an unsigned int that is set to the detailed property value |
1506 | | errorcodeptr points to the error code variable |
1507 | | |
1508 | | Returns: TRUE if the type value was found, or FALSE for an invalid type |
1509 | | */ |
1510 | | |
1511 | | static BOOL |
1512 | | get_ucp(const pcre_uchar **ptrptr, BOOL *negptr, unsigned int *ptypeptr, |
1513 | | unsigned int *pdataptr, int *errorcodeptr) |
1514 | | { |
1515 | | pcre_uchar c; |
1516 | | int i, bot, top; |
1517 | | const pcre_uchar *ptr = *ptrptr; |
1518 | | pcre_uchar name[32]; |
1519 | | |
1520 | | c = *(++ptr); |
1521 | | if (c == CHAR_NULL) goto ERROR_RETURN; |
1522 | | |
1523 | | *negptr = FALSE; |
1524 | | |
1525 | | /* \P or \p can be followed by a name in {}, optionally preceded by ^ for |
1526 | | negation. */ |
1527 | | |
1528 | | if (c == CHAR_LEFT_CURLY_BRACKET) |
1529 | | { |
1530 | | if (ptr[1] == CHAR_CIRCUMFLEX_ACCENT) |
1531 | | { |
1532 | | *negptr = TRUE; |
1533 | | ptr++; |
1534 | | } |
1535 | | for (i = 0; i < (int)(sizeof(name) / sizeof(pcre_uchar)) - 1; i++) |
1536 | | { |
1537 | | c = *(++ptr); |
1538 | | if (c == CHAR_NULL) goto ERROR_RETURN; |
1539 | | if (c == CHAR_RIGHT_CURLY_BRACKET) break; |
1540 | | name[i] = c; |
1541 | | } |
1542 | | if (c != CHAR_RIGHT_CURLY_BRACKET) goto ERROR_RETURN; |
1543 | | name[i] = 0; |
1544 | | } |
1545 | | |
1546 | | /* Otherwise there is just one following character */ |
1547 | | |
1548 | | else |
1549 | | { |
1550 | | name[0] = c; |
1551 | | name[1] = 0; |
1552 | | } |
1553 | | |
1554 | | *ptrptr = ptr; |
1555 | | |
1556 | | /* Search for a recognized property name using binary chop */ |
1557 | | |
1558 | | bot = 0; |
1559 | | top = PRIV(utt_size); |
1560 | | |
1561 | | while (bot < top) |
1562 | | { |
1563 | | int r; |
1564 | | i = (bot + top) >> 1; |
1565 | | r = STRCMP_UC_C8(name, PRIV(utt_names) + PRIV(utt)[i].name_offset); |
1566 | | if (r == 0) |
1567 | | { |
1568 | | *ptypeptr = PRIV(utt)[i].type; |
1569 | | *pdataptr = PRIV(utt)[i].value; |
1570 | | return TRUE; |
1571 | | } |
1572 | | if (r > 0) bot = i + 1; else top = i; |
1573 | | } |
1574 | | |
1575 | | *errorcodeptr = ERR47; |
1576 | | *ptrptr = ptr; |
1577 | | return FALSE; |
1578 | | |
1579 | | ERROR_RETURN: |
1580 | | *errorcodeptr = ERR46; |
1581 | | *ptrptr = ptr; |
1582 | | return FALSE; |
1583 | | } |
1584 | | #endif |
1585 | | |
1586 | | |
1587 | | |
1588 | | /************************************************* |
1589 | | * Read repeat counts * |
1590 | | *************************************************/ |
1591 | | |
1592 | | /* Read an item of the form {n,m} and return the values. This is called only |
1593 | | after is_counted_repeat() has confirmed that a repeat-count quantifier exists, |
1594 | | so the syntax is guaranteed to be correct, but we need to check the values. |
1595 | | |
1596 | | Arguments: |
1597 | | p pointer to first char after '{' |
1598 | | minp pointer to int for min |
1599 | | maxp pointer to int for max |
1600 | | returned as -1 if no max |
1601 | | errorcodeptr points to error code variable |
1602 | | |
1603 | | Returns: pointer to '}' on success; |
1604 | | current ptr on error, with errorcodeptr set non-zero |
1605 | | */ |
1606 | | |
1607 | | static const pcre_uchar * |
1608 | | read_repeat_counts(const pcre_uchar *p, int *minp, int *maxp, int *errorcodeptr) |
1609 | 0 | { |
1610 | 0 | int min = 0; |
1611 | 0 | int max = -1; |
1612 | |
|
1613 | 0 | while (IS_DIGIT(*p)) |
1614 | 0 | { |
1615 | 0 | min = min * 10 + (int)(*p++ - CHAR_0); |
1616 | 0 | if (min > 65535) |
1617 | 0 | { |
1618 | 0 | *errorcodeptr = ERR5; |
1619 | 0 | return p; |
1620 | 0 | } |
1621 | 0 | } |
1622 | | |
1623 | 0 | if (*p == CHAR_RIGHT_CURLY_BRACKET) max = min; else |
1624 | 0 | { |
1625 | 0 | if (*(++p) != CHAR_RIGHT_CURLY_BRACKET) |
1626 | 0 | { |
1627 | 0 | max = 0; |
1628 | 0 | while(IS_DIGIT(*p)) |
1629 | 0 | { |
1630 | 0 | max = max * 10 + (int)(*p++ - CHAR_0); |
1631 | 0 | if (max > 65535) |
1632 | 0 | { |
1633 | 0 | *errorcodeptr = ERR5; |
1634 | 0 | return p; |
1635 | 0 | } |
1636 | 0 | } |
1637 | 0 | if (max < min) |
1638 | 0 | { |
1639 | 0 | *errorcodeptr = ERR4; |
1640 | 0 | return p; |
1641 | 0 | } |
1642 | 0 | } |
1643 | 0 | } |
1644 | | |
1645 | 0 | *minp = min; |
1646 | 0 | *maxp = max; |
1647 | 0 | return p; |
1648 | 0 | } |
1649 | | |
1650 | | |
1651 | | |
1652 | | /************************************************* |
1653 | | * Find first significant op code * |
1654 | | *************************************************/ |
1655 | | |
1656 | | /* This is called by several functions that scan a compiled expression looking |
1657 | | for a fixed first character, or an anchoring op code etc. It skips over things |
1658 | | that do not influence this. For some calls, it makes sense to skip negative |
1659 | | forward and all backward assertions, and also the \b assertion; for others it |
1660 | | does not. |
1661 | | |
1662 | | Arguments: |
1663 | | code pointer to the start of the group |
1664 | | skipassert TRUE if certain assertions are to be skipped |
1665 | | |
1666 | | Returns: pointer to the first significant opcode |
1667 | | */ |
1668 | | |
1669 | | static const pcre_uchar* |
1670 | | first_significant_code(const pcre_uchar *code, BOOL skipassert) |
1671 | 0 | { |
1672 | 0 | for (;;) |
1673 | 0 | { |
1674 | 0 | switch ((int)*code) |
1675 | 0 | { |
1676 | 0 | case OP_ASSERT_NOT: |
1677 | 0 | case OP_ASSERTBACK: |
1678 | 0 | case OP_ASSERTBACK_NOT: |
1679 | 0 | if (!skipassert) return code; |
1680 | 0 | do code += GET(code, 1); while (*code == OP_ALT); |
1681 | 0 | code += PRIV(OP_lengths)[*code]; |
1682 | 0 | break; |
1683 | | |
1684 | 0 | case OP_WORD_BOUNDARY: |
1685 | 0 | case OP_NOT_WORD_BOUNDARY: |
1686 | 0 | if (!skipassert) return code; |
1687 | | /* Fall through */ |
1688 | | |
1689 | 0 | case OP_CALLOUT: |
1690 | 0 | case OP_CREF: |
1691 | 0 | case OP_DNCREF: |
1692 | 0 | case OP_RREF: |
1693 | 0 | case OP_DNRREF: |
1694 | 0 | case OP_DEF: |
1695 | 0 | code += PRIV(OP_lengths)[*code]; |
1696 | 0 | break; |
1697 | | |
1698 | 0 | default: |
1699 | 0 | return code; |
1700 | 0 | } |
1701 | 0 | } |
1702 | | /* Control never reaches here */ |
1703 | 0 | } |
1704 | | |
1705 | | |
1706 | | |
1707 | | /************************************************* |
1708 | | * Find the fixed length of a branch * |
1709 | | *************************************************/ |
1710 | | |
1711 | | /* Scan a branch and compute the fixed length of subject that will match it, |
1712 | | if the length is fixed. This is needed for dealing with backward assertions. |
1713 | | In UTF8 mode, the result is in characters rather than bytes. The branch is |
1714 | | temporarily terminated with OP_END when this function is called. |
1715 | | |
1716 | | This function is called when a backward assertion is encountered, so that if it |
1717 | | fails, the error message can point to the correct place in the pattern. |
1718 | | However, we cannot do this when the assertion contains subroutine calls, |
1719 | | because they can be forward references. We solve this by remembering this case |
1720 | | and doing the check at the end; a flag specifies which mode we are running in. |
1721 | | |
1722 | | Arguments: |
1723 | | code points to the start of the pattern (the bracket) |
1724 | | utf TRUE in UTF-8 / UTF-16 / UTF-32 mode |
1725 | | atend TRUE if called when the pattern is complete |
1726 | | cd the "compile data" structure |
1727 | | recurses chain of recurse_check to catch mutual recursion |
1728 | | |
1729 | | Returns: the fixed length, |
1730 | | or -1 if there is no fixed length, |
1731 | | or -2 if \C was encountered (in UTF-8 mode only) |
1732 | | or -3 if an OP_RECURSE item was encountered and atend is FALSE |
1733 | | or -4 if an unknown opcode was encountered (internal error) |
1734 | | */ |
1735 | | |
1736 | | static int |
1737 | | find_fixedlength(pcre_uchar *code, BOOL utf, BOOL atend, compile_data *cd, |
1738 | | recurse_check *recurses) |
1739 | 0 | { |
1740 | 0 | int length = -1; |
1741 | 0 | recurse_check this_recurse; |
1742 | 0 | register int branchlength = 0; |
1743 | 0 | register pcre_uchar *cc = code + 1 + LINK_SIZE; |
1744 | | |
1745 | | /* Scan along the opcodes for this branch. If we get to the end of the |
1746 | | branch, check the length against that of the other branches. */ |
1747 | |
|
1748 | 0 | for (;;) |
1749 | 0 | { |
1750 | 0 | int d; |
1751 | 0 | pcre_uchar *ce, *cs; |
1752 | 0 | register pcre_uchar op = *cc; |
1753 | |
|
1754 | 0 | switch (op) |
1755 | 0 | { |
1756 | | /* We only need to continue for OP_CBRA (normal capturing bracket) and |
1757 | | OP_BRA (normal non-capturing bracket) because the other variants of these |
1758 | | opcodes are all concerned with unlimited repeated groups, which of course |
1759 | | are not of fixed length. */ |
1760 | | |
1761 | 0 | case OP_CBRA: |
1762 | 0 | case OP_BRA: |
1763 | 0 | case OP_ONCE: |
1764 | 0 | case OP_ONCE_NC: |
1765 | 0 | case OP_COND: |
1766 | 0 | d = find_fixedlength(cc + ((op == OP_CBRA)? IMM2_SIZE : 0), utf, atend, cd, |
1767 | 0 | recurses); |
1768 | 0 | if (d < 0) return d; |
1769 | 0 | branchlength += d; |
1770 | 0 | do cc += GET(cc, 1); while (*cc == OP_ALT); |
1771 | 0 | cc += 1 + LINK_SIZE; |
1772 | 0 | break; |
1773 | | |
1774 | | /* Reached end of a branch; if it's a ket it is the end of a nested call. |
1775 | | If it's ALT it is an alternation in a nested call. An ACCEPT is effectively |
1776 | | an ALT. If it is END it's the end of the outer call. All can be handled by |
1777 | | the same code. Note that we must not include the OP_KETRxxx opcodes here, |
1778 | | because they all imply an unlimited repeat. */ |
1779 | | |
1780 | 0 | case OP_ALT: |
1781 | 0 | case OP_KET: |
1782 | 0 | case OP_END: |
1783 | 0 | case OP_ACCEPT: |
1784 | 0 | case OP_ASSERT_ACCEPT: |
1785 | 0 | if (length < 0) length = branchlength; |
1786 | 0 | else if (length != branchlength) return -1; |
1787 | 0 | if (*cc != OP_ALT) return length; |
1788 | 0 | cc += 1 + LINK_SIZE; |
1789 | 0 | branchlength = 0; |
1790 | 0 | break; |
1791 | | |
1792 | | /* A true recursion implies not fixed length, but a subroutine call may |
1793 | | be OK. If the subroutine is a forward reference, we can't deal with |
1794 | | it until the end of the pattern, so return -3. */ |
1795 | | |
1796 | 0 | case OP_RECURSE: |
1797 | 0 | if (!atend) return -3; |
1798 | 0 | cs = ce = (pcre_uchar *)cd->start_code + GET(cc, 1); /* Start subpattern */ |
1799 | 0 | do ce += GET(ce, 1); while (*ce == OP_ALT); /* End subpattern */ |
1800 | 0 | if (cc > cs && cc < ce) return -1; /* Recursion */ |
1801 | 0 | else /* Check for mutual recursion */ |
1802 | 0 | { |
1803 | 0 | recurse_check *r = recurses; |
1804 | 0 | for (r = recurses; r != NULL; r = r->prev) if (r->group == cs) break; |
1805 | 0 | if (r != NULL) return -1; /* Mutual recursion */ |
1806 | 0 | } |
1807 | 0 | this_recurse.prev = recurses; |
1808 | 0 | this_recurse.group = cs; |
1809 | 0 | d = find_fixedlength(cs + IMM2_SIZE, utf, atend, cd, &this_recurse); |
1810 | 0 | if (d < 0) return d; |
1811 | 0 | branchlength += d; |
1812 | 0 | cc += 1 + LINK_SIZE; |
1813 | 0 | break; |
1814 | | |
1815 | | /* Skip over assertive subpatterns */ |
1816 | | |
1817 | 0 | case OP_ASSERT: |
1818 | 0 | case OP_ASSERT_NOT: |
1819 | 0 | case OP_ASSERTBACK: |
1820 | 0 | case OP_ASSERTBACK_NOT: |
1821 | 0 | do cc += GET(cc, 1); while (*cc == OP_ALT); |
1822 | 0 | cc += 1 + LINK_SIZE; |
1823 | 0 | break; |
1824 | | |
1825 | | /* Skip over things that don't match chars */ |
1826 | | |
1827 | 0 | case OP_MARK: |
1828 | 0 | case OP_PRUNE_ARG: |
1829 | 0 | case OP_SKIP_ARG: |
1830 | 0 | case OP_THEN_ARG: |
1831 | 0 | cc += cc[1] + PRIV(OP_lengths)[*cc]; |
1832 | 0 | break; |
1833 | | |
1834 | 0 | case OP_CALLOUT: |
1835 | 0 | case OP_CIRC: |
1836 | 0 | case OP_CIRCM: |
1837 | 0 | case OP_CLOSE: |
1838 | 0 | case OP_COMMIT: |
1839 | 0 | case OP_CREF: |
1840 | 0 | case OP_DEF: |
1841 | 0 | case OP_DNCREF: |
1842 | 0 | case OP_DNRREF: |
1843 | 0 | case OP_DOLL: |
1844 | 0 | case OP_DOLLM: |
1845 | 0 | case OP_EOD: |
1846 | 0 | case OP_EODN: |
1847 | 0 | case OP_FAIL: |
1848 | 0 | case OP_NOT_WORD_BOUNDARY: |
1849 | 0 | case OP_PRUNE: |
1850 | 0 | case OP_REVERSE: |
1851 | 0 | case OP_RREF: |
1852 | 0 | case OP_SET_SOM: |
1853 | 0 | case OP_SKIP: |
1854 | 0 | case OP_SOD: |
1855 | 0 | case OP_SOM: |
1856 | 0 | case OP_THEN: |
1857 | 0 | case OP_WORD_BOUNDARY: |
1858 | 0 | cc += PRIV(OP_lengths)[*cc]; |
1859 | 0 | break; |
1860 | | |
1861 | | /* Handle literal characters */ |
1862 | | |
1863 | 0 | case OP_CHAR: |
1864 | 0 | case OP_CHARI: |
1865 | 0 | case OP_NOT: |
1866 | 0 | case OP_NOTI: |
1867 | 0 | branchlength++; |
1868 | 0 | cc += 2; |
1869 | | #ifdef SUPPORT_UTF |
1870 | | if (utf && HAS_EXTRALEN(cc[-1])) cc += GET_EXTRALEN(cc[-1]); |
1871 | | #endif |
1872 | 0 | break; |
1873 | | |
1874 | | /* Handle exact repetitions. The count is already in characters, but we |
1875 | | need to skip over a multibyte character in UTF8 mode. */ |
1876 | | |
1877 | 0 | case OP_EXACT: |
1878 | 0 | case OP_EXACTI: |
1879 | 0 | case OP_NOTEXACT: |
1880 | 0 | case OP_NOTEXACTI: |
1881 | 0 | branchlength += (int)GET2(cc,1); |
1882 | 0 | cc += 2 + IMM2_SIZE; |
1883 | | #ifdef SUPPORT_UTF |
1884 | | if (utf && HAS_EXTRALEN(cc[-1])) cc += GET_EXTRALEN(cc[-1]); |
1885 | | #endif |
1886 | 0 | break; |
1887 | | |
1888 | 0 | case OP_TYPEEXACT: |
1889 | 0 | branchlength += GET2(cc,1); |
1890 | 0 | if (cc[1 + IMM2_SIZE] == OP_PROP || cc[1 + IMM2_SIZE] == OP_NOTPROP) |
1891 | 0 | cc += 2; |
1892 | 0 | cc += 1 + IMM2_SIZE + 1; |
1893 | 0 | break; |
1894 | | |
1895 | | /* Handle single-char matchers */ |
1896 | | |
1897 | 0 | case OP_PROP: |
1898 | 0 | case OP_NOTPROP: |
1899 | 0 | cc += 2; |
1900 | | /* Fall through */ |
1901 | |
|
1902 | 0 | case OP_HSPACE: |
1903 | 0 | case OP_VSPACE: |
1904 | 0 | case OP_NOT_HSPACE: |
1905 | 0 | case OP_NOT_VSPACE: |
1906 | 0 | case OP_NOT_DIGIT: |
1907 | 0 | case OP_DIGIT: |
1908 | 0 | case OP_NOT_WHITESPACE: |
1909 | 0 | case OP_WHITESPACE: |
1910 | 0 | case OP_NOT_WORDCHAR: |
1911 | 0 | case OP_WORDCHAR: |
1912 | 0 | case OP_ANY: |
1913 | 0 | case OP_ALLANY: |
1914 | 0 | branchlength++; |
1915 | 0 | cc++; |
1916 | 0 | break; |
1917 | | |
1918 | | /* The single-byte matcher isn't allowed. This only happens in UTF-8 mode; |
1919 | | otherwise \C is coded as OP_ALLANY. */ |
1920 | | |
1921 | 0 | case OP_ANYBYTE: |
1922 | 0 | return -2; |
1923 | | |
1924 | | /* Check a class for variable quantification */ |
1925 | | |
1926 | 0 | case OP_CLASS: |
1927 | 0 | case OP_NCLASS: |
1928 | | #if defined SUPPORT_UTF || defined COMPILE_PCRE16 || defined COMPILE_PCRE32 |
1929 | | case OP_XCLASS: |
1930 | | /* The original code caused an unsigned overflow in 64 bit systems, |
1931 | | so now we use a conditional statement. */ |
1932 | | if (op == OP_XCLASS) |
1933 | | cc += GET(cc, 1); |
1934 | | else |
1935 | | cc += PRIV(OP_lengths)[OP_CLASS]; |
1936 | | #else |
1937 | 0 | cc += PRIV(OP_lengths)[OP_CLASS]; |
1938 | 0 | #endif |
1939 | |
|
1940 | 0 | switch (*cc) |
1941 | 0 | { |
1942 | 0 | case OP_CRSTAR: |
1943 | 0 | case OP_CRMINSTAR: |
1944 | 0 | case OP_CRPLUS: |
1945 | 0 | case OP_CRMINPLUS: |
1946 | 0 | case OP_CRQUERY: |
1947 | 0 | case OP_CRMINQUERY: |
1948 | 0 | case OP_CRPOSSTAR: |
1949 | 0 | case OP_CRPOSPLUS: |
1950 | 0 | case OP_CRPOSQUERY: |
1951 | 0 | return -1; |
1952 | | |
1953 | 0 | case OP_CRRANGE: |
1954 | 0 | case OP_CRMINRANGE: |
1955 | 0 | case OP_CRPOSRANGE: |
1956 | 0 | if (GET2(cc,1) != GET2(cc,1+IMM2_SIZE)) return -1; |
1957 | 0 | branchlength += (int)GET2(cc,1); |
1958 | 0 | cc += 1 + 2 * IMM2_SIZE; |
1959 | 0 | break; |
1960 | | |
1961 | 0 | default: |
1962 | 0 | branchlength++; |
1963 | 0 | } |
1964 | 0 | break; |
1965 | | |
1966 | | /* Anything else is variable length */ |
1967 | | |
1968 | 0 | case OP_ANYNL: |
1969 | 0 | case OP_BRAMINZERO: |
1970 | 0 | case OP_BRAPOS: |
1971 | 0 | case OP_BRAPOSZERO: |
1972 | 0 | case OP_BRAZERO: |
1973 | 0 | case OP_CBRAPOS: |
1974 | 0 | case OP_EXTUNI: |
1975 | 0 | case OP_KETRMAX: |
1976 | 0 | case OP_KETRMIN: |
1977 | 0 | case OP_KETRPOS: |
1978 | 0 | case OP_MINPLUS: |
1979 | 0 | case OP_MINPLUSI: |
1980 | 0 | case OP_MINQUERY: |
1981 | 0 | case OP_MINQUERYI: |
1982 | 0 | case OP_MINSTAR: |
1983 | 0 | case OP_MINSTARI: |
1984 | 0 | case OP_MINUPTO: |
1985 | 0 | case OP_MINUPTOI: |
1986 | 0 | case OP_NOTMINPLUS: |
1987 | 0 | case OP_NOTMINPLUSI: |
1988 | 0 | case OP_NOTMINQUERY: |
1989 | 0 | case OP_NOTMINQUERYI: |
1990 | 0 | case OP_NOTMINSTAR: |
1991 | 0 | case OP_NOTMINSTARI: |
1992 | 0 | case OP_NOTMINUPTO: |
1993 | 0 | case OP_NOTMINUPTOI: |
1994 | 0 | case OP_NOTPLUS: |
1995 | 0 | case OP_NOTPLUSI: |
1996 | 0 | case OP_NOTPOSPLUS: |
1997 | 0 | case OP_NOTPOSPLUSI: |
1998 | 0 | case OP_NOTPOSQUERY: |
1999 | 0 | case OP_NOTPOSQUERYI: |
2000 | 0 | case OP_NOTPOSSTAR: |
2001 | 0 | case OP_NOTPOSSTARI: |
2002 | 0 | case OP_NOTPOSUPTO: |
2003 | 0 | case OP_NOTPOSUPTOI: |
2004 | 0 | case OP_NOTQUERY: |
2005 | 0 | case OP_NOTQUERYI: |
2006 | 0 | case OP_NOTSTAR: |
2007 | 0 | case OP_NOTSTARI: |
2008 | 0 | case OP_NOTUPTO: |
2009 | 0 | case OP_NOTUPTOI: |
2010 | 0 | case OP_PLUS: |
2011 | 0 | case OP_PLUSI: |
2012 | 0 | case OP_POSPLUS: |
2013 | 0 | case OP_POSPLUSI: |
2014 | 0 | case OP_POSQUERY: |
2015 | 0 | case OP_POSQUERYI: |
2016 | 0 | case OP_POSSTAR: |
2017 | 0 | case OP_POSSTARI: |
2018 | 0 | case OP_POSUPTO: |
2019 | 0 | case OP_POSUPTOI: |
2020 | 0 | case OP_QUERY: |
2021 | 0 | case OP_QUERYI: |
2022 | 0 | case OP_REF: |
2023 | 0 | case OP_REFI: |
2024 | 0 | case OP_DNREF: |
2025 | 0 | case OP_DNREFI: |
2026 | 0 | case OP_SBRA: |
2027 | 0 | case OP_SBRAPOS: |
2028 | 0 | case OP_SCBRA: |
2029 | 0 | case OP_SCBRAPOS: |
2030 | 0 | case OP_SCOND: |
2031 | 0 | case OP_SKIPZERO: |
2032 | 0 | case OP_STAR: |
2033 | 0 | case OP_STARI: |
2034 | 0 | case OP_TYPEMINPLUS: |
2035 | 0 | case OP_TYPEMINQUERY: |
2036 | 0 | case OP_TYPEMINSTAR: |
2037 | 0 | case OP_TYPEMINUPTO: |
2038 | 0 | case OP_TYPEPLUS: |
2039 | 0 | case OP_TYPEPOSPLUS: |
2040 | 0 | case OP_TYPEPOSQUERY: |
2041 | 0 | case OP_TYPEPOSSTAR: |
2042 | 0 | case OP_TYPEPOSUPTO: |
2043 | 0 | case OP_TYPEQUERY: |
2044 | 0 | case OP_TYPESTAR: |
2045 | 0 | case OP_TYPEUPTO: |
2046 | 0 | case OP_UPTO: |
2047 | 0 | case OP_UPTOI: |
2048 | 0 | return -1; |
2049 | | |
2050 | | /* Catch unrecognized opcodes so that when new ones are added they |
2051 | | are not forgotten, as has happened in the past. */ |
2052 | | |
2053 | 0 | default: |
2054 | 0 | return -4; |
2055 | 0 | } |
2056 | 0 | } |
2057 | | /* Control never gets here */ |
2058 | 0 | } |
2059 | | |
2060 | | |
2061 | | |
2062 | | /************************************************* |
2063 | | * Scan compiled regex for specific bracket * |
2064 | | *************************************************/ |
2065 | | |
2066 | | /* This little function scans through a compiled pattern until it finds a |
2067 | | capturing bracket with the given number, or, if the number is negative, an |
2068 | | instance of OP_REVERSE for a lookbehind. The function is global in the C sense |
2069 | | so that it can be called from pcre_study() when finding the minimum matching |
2070 | | length. |
2071 | | |
2072 | | Arguments: |
2073 | | code points to start of expression |
2074 | | utf TRUE in UTF-8 / UTF-16 / UTF-32 mode |
2075 | | number the required bracket number or negative to find a lookbehind |
2076 | | |
2077 | | Returns: pointer to the opcode for the bracket, or NULL if not found |
2078 | | */ |
2079 | | |
2080 | | const pcre_uchar * |
2081 | | PRIV(find_bracket)(const pcre_uchar *code, BOOL utf, int number) |
2082 | 0 | { |
2083 | 0 | for (;;) |
2084 | 0 | { |
2085 | 0 | register pcre_uchar c = *code; |
2086 | |
|
2087 | 0 | if (c == OP_END) return NULL; |
2088 | | |
2089 | | /* XCLASS is used for classes that cannot be represented just by a bit |
2090 | | map. This includes negated single high-valued characters. The length in |
2091 | | the table is zero; the actual length is stored in the compiled code. */ |
2092 | | |
2093 | 0 | if (c == OP_XCLASS) code += GET(code, 1); |
2094 | | |
2095 | | /* Handle recursion */ |
2096 | | |
2097 | 0 | else if (c == OP_REVERSE) |
2098 | 0 | { |
2099 | 0 | if (number < 0) return (pcre_uchar *)code; |
2100 | 0 | code += PRIV(OP_lengths)[c]; |
2101 | 0 | } |
2102 | | |
2103 | | /* Handle capturing bracket */ |
2104 | | |
2105 | 0 | else if (c == OP_CBRA || c == OP_SCBRA || |
2106 | 0 | c == OP_CBRAPOS || c == OP_SCBRAPOS) |
2107 | 0 | { |
2108 | 0 | int n = (int)GET2(code, 1+LINK_SIZE); |
2109 | 0 | if (n == number) return (pcre_uchar *)code; |
2110 | 0 | code += PRIV(OP_lengths)[c]; |
2111 | 0 | } |
2112 | | |
2113 | | /* Otherwise, we can get the item's length from the table, except that for |
2114 | | repeated character types, we have to test for \p and \P, which have an extra |
2115 | | two bytes of parameters, and for MARK/PRUNE/SKIP/THEN with an argument, we |
2116 | | must add in its length. */ |
2117 | | |
2118 | 0 | else |
2119 | 0 | { |
2120 | 0 | switch(c) |
2121 | 0 | { |
2122 | 0 | case OP_TYPESTAR: |
2123 | 0 | case OP_TYPEMINSTAR: |
2124 | 0 | case OP_TYPEPLUS: |
2125 | 0 | case OP_TYPEMINPLUS: |
2126 | 0 | case OP_TYPEQUERY: |
2127 | 0 | case OP_TYPEMINQUERY: |
2128 | 0 | case OP_TYPEPOSSTAR: |
2129 | 0 | case OP_TYPEPOSPLUS: |
2130 | 0 | case OP_TYPEPOSQUERY: |
2131 | 0 | if (code[1] == OP_PROP || code[1] == OP_NOTPROP) code += 2; |
2132 | 0 | break; |
2133 | | |
2134 | 0 | case OP_TYPEUPTO: |
2135 | 0 | case OP_TYPEMINUPTO: |
2136 | 0 | case OP_TYPEEXACT: |
2137 | 0 | case OP_TYPEPOSUPTO: |
2138 | 0 | if (code[1 + IMM2_SIZE] == OP_PROP || code[1 + IMM2_SIZE] == OP_NOTPROP) |
2139 | 0 | code += 2; |
2140 | 0 | break; |
2141 | | |
2142 | 0 | case OP_MARK: |
2143 | 0 | case OP_PRUNE_ARG: |
2144 | 0 | case OP_SKIP_ARG: |
2145 | 0 | case OP_THEN_ARG: |
2146 | 0 | code += code[1]; |
2147 | 0 | break; |
2148 | 0 | } |
2149 | | |
2150 | | /* Add in the fixed length from the table */ |
2151 | | |
2152 | 0 | code += PRIV(OP_lengths)[c]; |
2153 | | |
2154 | | /* In UTF-8 mode, opcodes that are followed by a character may be followed by |
2155 | | a multi-byte character. The length in the table is a minimum, so we have to |
2156 | | arrange to skip the extra bytes. */ |
2157 | |
|
2158 | | #if defined SUPPORT_UTF && !defined COMPILE_PCRE32 |
2159 | | if (utf) switch(c) |
2160 | | { |
2161 | | case OP_CHAR: |
2162 | | case OP_CHARI: |
2163 | | case OP_NOT: |
2164 | | case OP_NOTI: |
2165 | | case OP_EXACT: |
2166 | | case OP_EXACTI: |
2167 | | case OP_NOTEXACT: |
2168 | | case OP_NOTEXACTI: |
2169 | | case OP_UPTO: |
2170 | | case OP_UPTOI: |
2171 | | case OP_NOTUPTO: |
2172 | | case OP_NOTUPTOI: |
2173 | | case OP_MINUPTO: |
2174 | | case OP_MINUPTOI: |
2175 | | case OP_NOTMINUPTO: |
2176 | | case OP_NOTMINUPTOI: |
2177 | | case OP_POSUPTO: |
2178 | | case OP_POSUPTOI: |
2179 | | case OP_NOTPOSUPTO: |
2180 | | case OP_NOTPOSUPTOI: |
2181 | | case OP_STAR: |
2182 | | case OP_STARI: |
2183 | | case OP_NOTSTAR: |
2184 | | case OP_NOTSTARI: |
2185 | | case OP_MINSTAR: |
2186 | | case OP_MINSTARI: |
2187 | | case OP_NOTMINSTAR: |
2188 | | case OP_NOTMINSTARI: |
2189 | | case OP_POSSTAR: |
2190 | | case OP_POSSTARI: |
2191 | | case OP_NOTPOSSTAR: |
2192 | | case OP_NOTPOSSTARI: |
2193 | | case OP_PLUS: |
2194 | | case OP_PLUSI: |
2195 | | case OP_NOTPLUS: |
2196 | | case OP_NOTPLUSI: |
2197 | | case OP_MINPLUS: |
2198 | | case OP_MINPLUSI: |
2199 | | case OP_NOTMINPLUS: |
2200 | | case OP_NOTMINPLUSI: |
2201 | | case OP_POSPLUS: |
2202 | | case OP_POSPLUSI: |
2203 | | case OP_NOTPOSPLUS: |
2204 | | case OP_NOTPOSPLUSI: |
2205 | | case OP_QUERY: |
2206 | | case OP_QUERYI: |
2207 | | case OP_NOTQUERY: |
2208 | | case OP_NOTQUERYI: |
2209 | | case OP_MINQUERY: |
2210 | | case OP_MINQUERYI: |
2211 | | case OP_NOTMINQUERY: |
2212 | | case OP_NOTMINQUERYI: |
2213 | | case OP_POSQUERY: |
2214 | | case OP_POSQUERYI: |
2215 | | case OP_NOTPOSQUERY: |
2216 | | case OP_NOTPOSQUERYI: |
2217 | | if (HAS_EXTRALEN(code[-1])) code += GET_EXTRALEN(code[-1]); |
2218 | | break; |
2219 | | } |
2220 | | #else |
2221 | 0 | (void)(utf); /* Keep compiler happy by referencing function argument */ |
2222 | 0 | #endif |
2223 | 0 | } |
2224 | 0 | } |
2225 | 0 | } |
2226 | | |
2227 | | |
2228 | | |
2229 | | /************************************************* |
2230 | | * Scan compiled regex for recursion reference * |
2231 | | *************************************************/ |
2232 | | |
2233 | | /* This little function scans through a compiled pattern until it finds an |
2234 | | instance of OP_RECURSE. |
2235 | | |
2236 | | Arguments: |
2237 | | code points to start of expression |
2238 | | utf TRUE in UTF-8 / UTF-16 / UTF-32 mode |
2239 | | |
2240 | | Returns: pointer to the opcode for OP_RECURSE, or NULL if not found |
2241 | | */ |
2242 | | |
2243 | | static const pcre_uchar * |
2244 | | find_recurse(const pcre_uchar *code, BOOL utf) |
2245 | 0 | { |
2246 | 0 | for (;;) |
2247 | 0 | { |
2248 | 0 | register pcre_uchar c = *code; |
2249 | 0 | if (c == OP_END) return NULL; |
2250 | 0 | if (c == OP_RECURSE) return code; |
2251 | | |
2252 | | /* XCLASS is used for classes that cannot be represented just by a bit |
2253 | | map. This includes negated single high-valued characters. The length in |
2254 | | the table is zero; the actual length is stored in the compiled code. */ |
2255 | | |
2256 | 0 | if (c == OP_XCLASS) code += GET(code, 1); |
2257 | | |
2258 | | /* Otherwise, we can get the item's length from the table, except that for |
2259 | | repeated character types, we have to test for \p and \P, which have an extra |
2260 | | two bytes of parameters, and for MARK/PRUNE/SKIP/THEN with an argument, we |
2261 | | must add in its length. */ |
2262 | | |
2263 | 0 | else |
2264 | 0 | { |
2265 | 0 | switch(c) |
2266 | 0 | { |
2267 | 0 | case OP_TYPESTAR: |
2268 | 0 | case OP_TYPEMINSTAR: |
2269 | 0 | case OP_TYPEPLUS: |
2270 | 0 | case OP_TYPEMINPLUS: |
2271 | 0 | case OP_TYPEQUERY: |
2272 | 0 | case OP_TYPEMINQUERY: |
2273 | 0 | case OP_TYPEPOSSTAR: |
2274 | 0 | case OP_TYPEPOSPLUS: |
2275 | 0 | case OP_TYPEPOSQUERY: |
2276 | 0 | if (code[1] == OP_PROP || code[1] == OP_NOTPROP) code += 2; |
2277 | 0 | break; |
2278 | | |
2279 | 0 | case OP_TYPEPOSUPTO: |
2280 | 0 | case OP_TYPEUPTO: |
2281 | 0 | case OP_TYPEMINUPTO: |
2282 | 0 | case OP_TYPEEXACT: |
2283 | 0 | if (code[1 + IMM2_SIZE] == OP_PROP || code[1 + IMM2_SIZE] == OP_NOTPROP) |
2284 | 0 | code += 2; |
2285 | 0 | break; |
2286 | | |
2287 | 0 | case OP_MARK: |
2288 | 0 | case OP_PRUNE_ARG: |
2289 | 0 | case OP_SKIP_ARG: |
2290 | 0 | case OP_THEN_ARG: |
2291 | 0 | code += code[1]; |
2292 | 0 | break; |
2293 | 0 | } |
2294 | | |
2295 | | /* Add in the fixed length from the table */ |
2296 | | |
2297 | 0 | code += PRIV(OP_lengths)[c]; |
2298 | | |
2299 | | /* In UTF-8 mode, opcodes that are followed by a character may be followed |
2300 | | by a multi-byte character. The length in the table is a minimum, so we have |
2301 | | to arrange to skip the extra bytes. */ |
2302 | |
|
2303 | | #if defined SUPPORT_UTF && !defined COMPILE_PCRE32 |
2304 | | if (utf) switch(c) |
2305 | | { |
2306 | | case OP_CHAR: |
2307 | | case OP_CHARI: |
2308 | | case OP_NOT: |
2309 | | case OP_NOTI: |
2310 | | case OP_EXACT: |
2311 | | case OP_EXACTI: |
2312 | | case OP_NOTEXACT: |
2313 | | case OP_NOTEXACTI: |
2314 | | case OP_UPTO: |
2315 | | case OP_UPTOI: |
2316 | | case OP_NOTUPTO: |
2317 | | case OP_NOTUPTOI: |
2318 | | case OP_MINUPTO: |
2319 | | case OP_MINUPTOI: |
2320 | | case OP_NOTMINUPTO: |
2321 | | case OP_NOTMINUPTOI: |
2322 | | case OP_POSUPTO: |
2323 | | case OP_POSUPTOI: |
2324 | | case OP_NOTPOSUPTO: |
2325 | | case OP_NOTPOSUPTOI: |
2326 | | case OP_STAR: |
2327 | | case OP_STARI: |
2328 | | case OP_NOTSTAR: |
2329 | | case OP_NOTSTARI: |
2330 | | case OP_MINSTAR: |
2331 | | case OP_MINSTARI: |
2332 | | case OP_NOTMINSTAR: |
2333 | | case OP_NOTMINSTARI: |
2334 | | case OP_POSSTAR: |
2335 | | case OP_POSSTARI: |
2336 | | case OP_NOTPOSSTAR: |
2337 | | case OP_NOTPOSSTARI: |
2338 | | case OP_PLUS: |
2339 | | case OP_PLUSI: |
2340 | | case OP_NOTPLUS: |
2341 | | case OP_NOTPLUSI: |
2342 | | case OP_MINPLUS: |
2343 | | case OP_MINPLUSI: |
2344 | | case OP_NOTMINPLUS: |
2345 | | case OP_NOTMINPLUSI: |
2346 | | case OP_POSPLUS: |
2347 | | case OP_POSPLUSI: |
2348 | | case OP_NOTPOSPLUS: |
2349 | | case OP_NOTPOSPLUSI: |
2350 | | case OP_QUERY: |
2351 | | case OP_QUERYI: |
2352 | | case OP_NOTQUERY: |
2353 | | case OP_NOTQUERYI: |
2354 | | case OP_MINQUERY: |
2355 | | case OP_MINQUERYI: |
2356 | | case OP_NOTMINQUERY: |
2357 | | case OP_NOTMINQUERYI: |
2358 | | case OP_POSQUERY: |
2359 | | case OP_POSQUERYI: |
2360 | | case OP_NOTPOSQUERY: |
2361 | | case OP_NOTPOSQUERYI: |
2362 | | if (HAS_EXTRALEN(code[-1])) code += GET_EXTRALEN(code[-1]); |
2363 | | break; |
2364 | | } |
2365 | | #else |
2366 | 0 | (void)(utf); /* Keep compiler happy by referencing function argument */ |
2367 | 0 | #endif |
2368 | 0 | } |
2369 | 0 | } |
2370 | 0 | } |
2371 | | |
2372 | | |
2373 | | |
2374 | | /************************************************* |
2375 | | * Scan compiled branch for non-emptiness * |
2376 | | *************************************************/ |
2377 | | |
2378 | | /* This function scans through a branch of a compiled pattern to see whether it |
2379 | | can match the empty string or not. It is called from could_be_empty() |
2380 | | below and from compile_branch() when checking for an unlimited repeat of a |
2381 | | group that can match nothing. Note that first_significant_code() skips over |
2382 | | backward and negative forward assertions when its final argument is TRUE. If we |
2383 | | hit an unclosed bracket, we return "empty" - this means we've struck an inner |
2384 | | bracket whose current branch will already have been scanned. |
2385 | | |
2386 | | Arguments: |
2387 | | code points to start of search |
2388 | | endcode points to where to stop |
2389 | | utf TRUE if in UTF-8 / UTF-16 / UTF-32 mode |
2390 | | cd contains pointers to tables etc. |
2391 | | recurses chain of recurse_check to catch mutual recursion |
2392 | | |
2393 | | Returns: TRUE if what is matched could be empty |
2394 | | */ |
2395 | | |
2396 | | static BOOL |
2397 | | could_be_empty_branch(const pcre_uchar *code, const pcre_uchar *endcode, |
2398 | | BOOL utf, compile_data *cd, recurse_check *recurses) |
2399 | 0 | { |
2400 | 0 | register pcre_uchar c; |
2401 | 0 | recurse_check this_recurse; |
2402 | |
|
2403 | 0 | for (code = first_significant_code(code + PRIV(OP_lengths)[*code], TRUE); |
2404 | 0 | code < endcode; |
2405 | 0 | code = first_significant_code(code + PRIV(OP_lengths)[c], TRUE)) |
2406 | 0 | { |
2407 | 0 | const pcre_uchar *ccode; |
2408 | |
|
2409 | 0 | c = *code; |
2410 | | |
2411 | | /* Skip over forward assertions; the other assertions are skipped by |
2412 | | first_significant_code() with a TRUE final argument. */ |
2413 | |
|
2414 | 0 | if (c == OP_ASSERT) |
2415 | 0 | { |
2416 | 0 | do code += GET(code, 1); while (*code == OP_ALT); |
2417 | 0 | c = *code; |
2418 | 0 | continue; |
2419 | 0 | } |
2420 | | |
2421 | | /* For a recursion/subroutine call, if its end has been reached, which |
2422 | | implies a backward reference subroutine call, we can scan it. If it's a |
2423 | | forward reference subroutine call, we can't. To detect forward reference |
2424 | | we have to scan up the list that is kept in the workspace. This function is |
2425 | | called only when doing the real compile, not during the pre-compile that |
2426 | | measures the size of the compiled pattern. */ |
2427 | | |
2428 | 0 | if (c == OP_RECURSE) |
2429 | 0 | { |
2430 | 0 | const pcre_uchar *scode = cd->start_code + GET(code, 1); |
2431 | 0 | const pcre_uchar *endgroup = scode; |
2432 | 0 | BOOL empty_branch; |
2433 | | |
2434 | | /* Test for forward reference or uncompleted reference. This is disabled |
2435 | | when called to scan a completed pattern by setting cd->start_workspace to |
2436 | | NULL. */ |
2437 | |
|
2438 | 0 | if (cd->start_workspace != NULL) |
2439 | 0 | { |
2440 | 0 | const pcre_uchar *tcode; |
2441 | 0 | for (tcode = cd->start_workspace; tcode < cd->hwm; tcode += LINK_SIZE) |
2442 | 0 | if ((int)GET(tcode, 0) == (int)(code + 1 - cd->start_code)) return TRUE; |
2443 | 0 | if (GET(scode, 1) == 0) return TRUE; /* Unclosed */ |
2444 | 0 | } |
2445 | | |
2446 | | /* If the reference is to a completed group, we need to detect whether this |
2447 | | is a recursive call, as otherwise there will be an infinite loop. If it is |
2448 | | a recursion, just skip over it. Simple recursions are easily detected. For |
2449 | | mutual recursions we keep a chain on the stack. */ |
2450 | | |
2451 | 0 | do endgroup += GET(endgroup, 1); while (*endgroup == OP_ALT); |
2452 | 0 | if (code >= scode && code <= endgroup) continue; /* Simple recursion */ |
2453 | 0 | else |
2454 | 0 | { |
2455 | 0 | recurse_check *r = recurses; |
2456 | 0 | for (r = recurses; r != NULL; r = r->prev) |
2457 | 0 | if (r->group == scode) break; |
2458 | 0 | if (r != NULL) continue; /* Mutual recursion */ |
2459 | 0 | } |
2460 | | |
2461 | | /* Completed reference; scan the referenced group, remembering it on the |
2462 | | stack chain to detect mutual recursions. */ |
2463 | | |
2464 | 0 | empty_branch = FALSE; |
2465 | 0 | this_recurse.prev = recurses; |
2466 | 0 | this_recurse.group = scode; |
2467 | |
|
2468 | 0 | do |
2469 | 0 | { |
2470 | 0 | if (could_be_empty_branch(scode, endcode, utf, cd, &this_recurse)) |
2471 | 0 | { |
2472 | 0 | empty_branch = TRUE; |
2473 | 0 | break; |
2474 | 0 | } |
2475 | 0 | scode += GET(scode, 1); |
2476 | 0 | } |
2477 | 0 | while (*scode == OP_ALT); |
2478 | | |
2479 | 0 | if (!empty_branch) return FALSE; /* All branches are non-empty */ |
2480 | 0 | continue; |
2481 | 0 | } |
2482 | | |
2483 | | /* Groups with zero repeats can of course be empty; skip them. */ |
2484 | | |
2485 | 0 | if (c == OP_BRAZERO || c == OP_BRAMINZERO || c == OP_SKIPZERO || |
2486 | 0 | c == OP_BRAPOSZERO) |
2487 | 0 | { |
2488 | 0 | code += PRIV(OP_lengths)[c]; |
2489 | 0 | do code += GET(code, 1); while (*code == OP_ALT); |
2490 | 0 | c = *code; |
2491 | 0 | continue; |
2492 | 0 | } |
2493 | | |
2494 | | /* A nested group that is already marked as "could be empty" can just be |
2495 | | skipped. */ |
2496 | | |
2497 | 0 | if (c == OP_SBRA || c == OP_SBRAPOS || |
2498 | 0 | c == OP_SCBRA || c == OP_SCBRAPOS) |
2499 | 0 | { |
2500 | 0 | do code += GET(code, 1); while (*code == OP_ALT); |
2501 | 0 | c = *code; |
2502 | 0 | continue; |
2503 | 0 | } |
2504 | | |
2505 | | /* For other groups, scan the branches. */ |
2506 | | |
2507 | 0 | if (c == OP_BRA || c == OP_BRAPOS || |
2508 | 0 | c == OP_CBRA || c == OP_CBRAPOS || |
2509 | 0 | c == OP_ONCE || c == OP_ONCE_NC || |
2510 | 0 | c == OP_COND || c == OP_SCOND) |
2511 | 0 | { |
2512 | 0 | BOOL empty_branch; |
2513 | 0 | if (GET(code, 1) == 0) return TRUE; /* Hit unclosed bracket */ |
2514 | | |
2515 | | /* If a conditional group has only one branch, there is a second, implied, |
2516 | | empty branch, so just skip over the conditional, because it could be empty. |
2517 | | Otherwise, scan the individual branches of the group. */ |
2518 | | |
2519 | 0 | if (c == OP_COND && code[GET(code, 1)] != OP_ALT) |
2520 | 0 | code += GET(code, 1); |
2521 | 0 | else |
2522 | 0 | { |
2523 | 0 | empty_branch = FALSE; |
2524 | 0 | do |
2525 | 0 | { |
2526 | 0 | if (!empty_branch && could_be_empty_branch(code, endcode, utf, cd, |
2527 | 0 | recurses)) empty_branch = TRUE; |
2528 | 0 | code += GET(code, 1); |
2529 | 0 | } |
2530 | 0 | while (*code == OP_ALT); |
2531 | 0 | if (!empty_branch) return FALSE; /* All branches are non-empty */ |
2532 | 0 | } |
2533 | | |
2534 | 0 | c = *code; |
2535 | 0 | continue; |
2536 | 0 | } |
2537 | | |
2538 | | /* Handle the other opcodes */ |
2539 | | |
2540 | 0 | switch (c) |
2541 | 0 | { |
2542 | | /* Check for quantifiers after a class. XCLASS is used for classes that |
2543 | | cannot be represented just by a bit map. This includes negated single |
2544 | | high-valued characters. The length in PRIV(OP_lengths)[] is zero; the |
2545 | | actual length is stored in the compiled code, so we must update "code" |
2546 | | here. */ |
2547 | | |
2548 | | #if defined SUPPORT_UTF || !defined COMPILE_PCRE8 |
2549 | | case OP_XCLASS: |
2550 | | ccode = code += GET(code, 1); |
2551 | | goto CHECK_CLASS_REPEAT; |
2552 | | #endif |
2553 | | |
2554 | 0 | case OP_CLASS: |
2555 | 0 | case OP_NCLASS: |
2556 | 0 | ccode = code + PRIV(OP_lengths)[OP_CLASS]; |
2557 | |
|
2558 | | #if defined SUPPORT_UTF || !defined COMPILE_PCRE8 |
2559 | | CHECK_CLASS_REPEAT: |
2560 | | #endif |
2561 | |
|
2562 | 0 | switch (*ccode) |
2563 | 0 | { |
2564 | 0 | case OP_CRSTAR: /* These could be empty; continue */ |
2565 | 0 | case OP_CRMINSTAR: |
2566 | 0 | case OP_CRQUERY: |
2567 | 0 | case OP_CRMINQUERY: |
2568 | 0 | case OP_CRPOSSTAR: |
2569 | 0 | case OP_CRPOSQUERY: |
2570 | 0 | break; |
2571 | | |
2572 | 0 | default: /* Non-repeat => class must match */ |
2573 | 0 | case OP_CRPLUS: /* These repeats aren't empty */ |
2574 | 0 | case OP_CRMINPLUS: |
2575 | 0 | case OP_CRPOSPLUS: |
2576 | 0 | return FALSE; |
2577 | | |
2578 | 0 | case OP_CRRANGE: |
2579 | 0 | case OP_CRMINRANGE: |
2580 | 0 | case OP_CRPOSRANGE: |
2581 | 0 | if (GET2(ccode, 1) > 0) return FALSE; /* Minimum > 0 */ |
2582 | 0 | break; |
2583 | 0 | } |
2584 | 0 | break; |
2585 | | |
2586 | | /* Opcodes that must match a character */ |
2587 | | |
2588 | 0 | case OP_ANY: |
2589 | 0 | case OP_ALLANY: |
2590 | 0 | case OP_ANYBYTE: |
2591 | |
|
2592 | 0 | case OP_PROP: |
2593 | 0 | case OP_NOTPROP: |
2594 | 0 | case OP_ANYNL: |
2595 | |
|
2596 | 0 | case OP_NOT_HSPACE: |
2597 | 0 | case OP_HSPACE: |
2598 | 0 | case OP_NOT_VSPACE: |
2599 | 0 | case OP_VSPACE: |
2600 | 0 | case OP_EXTUNI: |
2601 | |
|
2602 | 0 | case OP_NOT_DIGIT: |
2603 | 0 | case OP_DIGIT: |
2604 | 0 | case OP_NOT_WHITESPACE: |
2605 | 0 | case OP_WHITESPACE: |
2606 | 0 | case OP_NOT_WORDCHAR: |
2607 | 0 | case OP_WORDCHAR: |
2608 | |
|
2609 | 0 | case OP_CHAR: |
2610 | 0 | case OP_CHARI: |
2611 | 0 | case OP_NOT: |
2612 | 0 | case OP_NOTI: |
2613 | |
|
2614 | 0 | case OP_PLUS: |
2615 | 0 | case OP_PLUSI: |
2616 | 0 | case OP_MINPLUS: |
2617 | 0 | case OP_MINPLUSI: |
2618 | |
|
2619 | 0 | case OP_NOTPLUS: |
2620 | 0 | case OP_NOTPLUSI: |
2621 | 0 | case OP_NOTMINPLUS: |
2622 | 0 | case OP_NOTMINPLUSI: |
2623 | |
|
2624 | 0 | case OP_POSPLUS: |
2625 | 0 | case OP_POSPLUSI: |
2626 | 0 | case OP_NOTPOSPLUS: |
2627 | 0 | case OP_NOTPOSPLUSI: |
2628 | |
|
2629 | 0 | case OP_EXACT: |
2630 | 0 | case OP_EXACTI: |
2631 | 0 | case OP_NOTEXACT: |
2632 | 0 | case OP_NOTEXACTI: |
2633 | |
|
2634 | 0 | case OP_TYPEPLUS: |
2635 | 0 | case OP_TYPEMINPLUS: |
2636 | 0 | case OP_TYPEPOSPLUS: |
2637 | 0 | case OP_TYPEEXACT: |
2638 | |
|
2639 | 0 | return FALSE; |
2640 | | |
2641 | | /* These are going to continue, as they may be empty, but we have to |
2642 | | fudge the length for the \p and \P cases. */ |
2643 | | |
2644 | 0 | case OP_TYPESTAR: |
2645 | 0 | case OP_TYPEMINSTAR: |
2646 | 0 | case OP_TYPEPOSSTAR: |
2647 | 0 | case OP_TYPEQUERY: |
2648 | 0 | case OP_TYPEMINQUERY: |
2649 | 0 | case OP_TYPEPOSQUERY: |
2650 | 0 | if (code[1] == OP_PROP || code[1] == OP_NOTPROP) code += 2; |
2651 | 0 | break; |
2652 | | |
2653 | | /* Same for these */ |
2654 | | |
2655 | 0 | case OP_TYPEUPTO: |
2656 | 0 | case OP_TYPEMINUPTO: |
2657 | 0 | case OP_TYPEPOSUPTO: |
2658 | 0 | if (code[1 + IMM2_SIZE] == OP_PROP || code[1 + IMM2_SIZE] == OP_NOTPROP) |
2659 | 0 | code += 2; |
2660 | 0 | break; |
2661 | | |
2662 | | /* End of branch */ |
2663 | | |
2664 | 0 | case OP_KET: |
2665 | 0 | case OP_KETRMAX: |
2666 | 0 | case OP_KETRMIN: |
2667 | 0 | case OP_KETRPOS: |
2668 | 0 | case OP_ALT: |
2669 | 0 | return TRUE; |
2670 | | |
2671 | | /* In UTF-8 mode, STAR, MINSTAR, POSSTAR, QUERY, MINQUERY, POSQUERY, UPTO, |
2672 | | MINUPTO, and POSUPTO and their caseless and negative versions may be |
2673 | | followed by a multibyte character. */ |
2674 | | |
2675 | | #if defined SUPPORT_UTF && !defined COMPILE_PCRE32 |
2676 | | case OP_STAR: |
2677 | | case OP_STARI: |
2678 | | case OP_NOTSTAR: |
2679 | | case OP_NOTSTARI: |
2680 | | |
2681 | | case OP_MINSTAR: |
2682 | | case OP_MINSTARI: |
2683 | | case OP_NOTMINSTAR: |
2684 | | case OP_NOTMINSTARI: |
2685 | | |
2686 | | case OP_POSSTAR: |
2687 | | case OP_POSSTARI: |
2688 | | case OP_NOTPOSSTAR: |
2689 | | case OP_NOTPOSSTARI: |
2690 | | |
2691 | | case OP_QUERY: |
2692 | | case OP_QUERYI: |
2693 | | case OP_NOTQUERY: |
2694 | | case OP_NOTQUERYI: |
2695 | | |
2696 | | case OP_MINQUERY: |
2697 | | case OP_MINQUERYI: |
2698 | | case OP_NOTMINQUERY: |
2699 | | case OP_NOTMINQUERYI: |
2700 | | |
2701 | | case OP_POSQUERY: |
2702 | | case OP_POSQUERYI: |
2703 | | case OP_NOTPOSQUERY: |
2704 | | case OP_NOTPOSQUERYI: |
2705 | | |
2706 | | if (utf && HAS_EXTRALEN(code[1])) code += GET_EXTRALEN(code[1]); |
2707 | | break; |
2708 | | |
2709 | | case OP_UPTO: |
2710 | | case OP_UPTOI: |
2711 | | case OP_NOTUPTO: |
2712 | | case OP_NOTUPTOI: |
2713 | | |
2714 | | case OP_MINUPTO: |
2715 | | case OP_MINUPTOI: |
2716 | | case OP_NOTMINUPTO: |
2717 | | case OP_NOTMINUPTOI: |
2718 | | |
2719 | | case OP_POSUPTO: |
2720 | | case OP_POSUPTOI: |
2721 | | case OP_NOTPOSUPTO: |
2722 | | case OP_NOTPOSUPTOI: |
2723 | | |
2724 | | if (utf && HAS_EXTRALEN(code[1 + IMM2_SIZE])) code += GET_EXTRALEN(code[1 + IMM2_SIZE]); |
2725 | | break; |
2726 | | #endif |
2727 | | |
2728 | | /* MARK, and PRUNE/SKIP/THEN with an argument must skip over the argument |
2729 | | string. */ |
2730 | | |
2731 | 0 | case OP_MARK: |
2732 | 0 | case OP_PRUNE_ARG: |
2733 | 0 | case OP_SKIP_ARG: |
2734 | 0 | case OP_THEN_ARG: |
2735 | 0 | code += code[1]; |
2736 | 0 | break; |
2737 | | |
2738 | | /* None of the remaining opcodes are required to match a character. */ |
2739 | | |
2740 | 0 | default: |
2741 | 0 | break; |
2742 | 0 | } |
2743 | 0 | } |
2744 | | |
2745 | 0 | return TRUE; |
2746 | 0 | } |
2747 | | |
2748 | | |
2749 | | |
2750 | | /************************************************* |
2751 | | * Scan compiled regex for non-emptiness * |
2752 | | *************************************************/ |
2753 | | |
2754 | | /* This function is called to check for left recursive calls. We want to check |
2755 | | the current branch of the current pattern to see if it could match the empty |
2756 | | string. If it could, we must look outwards for branches at other levels, |
2757 | | stopping when we pass beyond the bracket which is the subject of the recursion. |
2758 | | This function is called only during the real compile, not during the |
2759 | | pre-compile. |
2760 | | |
2761 | | Arguments: |
2762 | | code points to start of the recursion |
2763 | | endcode points to where to stop (current RECURSE item) |
2764 | | bcptr points to the chain of current (unclosed) branch starts |
2765 | | utf TRUE if in UTF-8 / UTF-16 / UTF-32 mode |
2766 | | cd pointers to tables etc |
2767 | | |
2768 | | Returns: TRUE if what is matched could be empty |
2769 | | */ |
2770 | | |
2771 | | static BOOL |
2772 | | could_be_empty(const pcre_uchar *code, const pcre_uchar *endcode, |
2773 | | branch_chain *bcptr, BOOL utf, compile_data *cd) |
2774 | 0 | { |
2775 | 0 | while (bcptr != NULL && bcptr->current_branch >= code) |
2776 | 0 | { |
2777 | 0 | if (!could_be_empty_branch(bcptr->current_branch, endcode, utf, cd, NULL)) |
2778 | 0 | return FALSE; |
2779 | 0 | bcptr = bcptr->outer; |
2780 | 0 | } |
2781 | 0 | return TRUE; |
2782 | 0 | } |
2783 | | |
2784 | | |
2785 | | |
2786 | | /************************************************* |
2787 | | * Base opcode of repeated opcodes * |
2788 | | *************************************************/ |
2789 | | |
2790 | | /* Returns the base opcode for repeated single character type opcodes. If the |
2791 | | opcode is not a repeated character type, it returns with the original value. |
2792 | | |
2793 | | Arguments: c opcode |
2794 | | Returns: base opcode for the type |
2795 | | */ |
2796 | | |
2797 | | static pcre_uchar |
2798 | | get_repeat_base(pcre_uchar c) |
2799 | 0 | { |
2800 | 0 | return (c > OP_TYPEPOSUPTO)? c : |
2801 | 0 | (c >= OP_TYPESTAR)? OP_TYPESTAR : |
2802 | 0 | (c >= OP_NOTSTARI)? OP_NOTSTARI : |
2803 | 0 | (c >= OP_NOTSTAR)? OP_NOTSTAR : |
2804 | 0 | (c >= OP_STARI)? OP_STARI : |
2805 | 0 | OP_STAR; |
2806 | 0 | } |
2807 | | |
2808 | | |
2809 | | |
2810 | | #ifdef SUPPORT_UCP |
2811 | | /************************************************* |
2812 | | * Check a character and a property * |
2813 | | *************************************************/ |
2814 | | |
2815 | | /* This function is called by check_auto_possessive() when a property item |
2816 | | is adjacent to a fixed character. |
2817 | | |
2818 | | Arguments: |
2819 | | c the character |
2820 | | ptype the property type |
2821 | | pdata the data for the type |
2822 | | negated TRUE if it's a negated property (\P or \p{^) |
2823 | | |
2824 | | Returns: TRUE if auto-possessifying is OK |
2825 | | */ |
2826 | | |
2827 | | static BOOL |
2828 | | check_char_prop(pcre_uint32 c, unsigned int ptype, unsigned int pdata, |
2829 | | BOOL negated) |
2830 | | { |
2831 | | const pcre_uint32 *p; |
2832 | | const ucd_record *prop = GET_UCD(c); |
2833 | | |
2834 | | switch(ptype) |
2835 | | { |
2836 | | case PT_LAMP: |
2837 | | return (prop->chartype == ucp_Lu || |
2838 | | prop->chartype == ucp_Ll || |
2839 | | prop->chartype == ucp_Lt) == negated; |
2840 | | |
2841 | | case PT_GC: |
2842 | | return (pdata == PRIV(ucp_gentype)[prop->chartype]) == negated; |
2843 | | |
2844 | | case PT_PC: |
2845 | | return (pdata == prop->chartype) == negated; |
2846 | | |
2847 | | case PT_SC: |
2848 | | return (pdata == prop->script) == negated; |
2849 | | |
2850 | | /* These are specials */ |
2851 | | |
2852 | | case PT_ALNUM: |
2853 | | return (PRIV(ucp_gentype)[prop->chartype] == ucp_L || |
2854 | | PRIV(ucp_gentype)[prop->chartype] == ucp_N) == negated; |
2855 | | |
2856 | | /* Perl space used to exclude VT, but from Perl 5.18 it is included, which |
2857 | | means that Perl space and POSIX space are now identical. PCRE was changed |
2858 | | at release 8.34. */ |
2859 | | |
2860 | | case PT_SPACE: /* Perl space */ |
2861 | | case PT_PXSPACE: /* POSIX space */ |
2862 | | switch(c) |
2863 | | { |
2864 | | HSPACE_CASES: |
2865 | | VSPACE_CASES: |
2866 | | return negated; |
2867 | | |
2868 | | default: |
2869 | | return (PRIV(ucp_gentype)[prop->chartype] == ucp_Z) == negated; |
2870 | | } |
2871 | | break; /* Control never reaches here */ |
2872 | | |
2873 | | case PT_WORD: |
2874 | | return (PRIV(ucp_gentype)[prop->chartype] == ucp_L || |
2875 | | PRIV(ucp_gentype)[prop->chartype] == ucp_N || |
2876 | | c == CHAR_UNDERSCORE) == negated; |
2877 | | |
2878 | | case PT_CLIST: |
2879 | | p = PRIV(ucd_caseless_sets) + prop->caseset; |
2880 | | for (;;) |
2881 | | { |
2882 | | if (c < *p) return !negated; |
2883 | | if (c == *p++) return negated; |
2884 | | } |
2885 | | break; /* Control never reaches here */ |
2886 | | } |
2887 | | |
2888 | | return FALSE; |
2889 | | } |
2890 | | #endif /* SUPPORT_UCP */ |
2891 | | |
2892 | | |
2893 | | |
2894 | | /************************************************* |
2895 | | * Fill the character property list * |
2896 | | *************************************************/ |
2897 | | |
2898 | | /* Checks whether the code points to an opcode that can take part in auto- |
2899 | | possessification, and if so, fills a list with its properties. |
2900 | | |
2901 | | Arguments: |
2902 | | code points to start of expression |
2903 | | utf TRUE if in UTF-8 / UTF-16 / UTF-32 mode |
2904 | | fcc points to case-flipping table |
2905 | | list points to output list |
2906 | | list[0] will be filled with the opcode |
2907 | | list[1] will be non-zero if this opcode |
2908 | | can match an empty character string |
2909 | | list[2..7] depends on the opcode |
2910 | | |
2911 | | Returns: points to the start of the next opcode if *code is accepted |
2912 | | NULL if *code is not accepted |
2913 | | */ |
2914 | | |
2915 | | static const pcre_uchar * |
2916 | | get_chr_property_list(const pcre_uchar *code, BOOL utf, |
2917 | | const pcre_uint8 *fcc, pcre_uint32 *list) |
2918 | 0 | { |
2919 | 0 | pcre_uchar c = *code; |
2920 | 0 | pcre_uchar base; |
2921 | 0 | const pcre_uchar *end; |
2922 | 0 | pcre_uint32 chr; |
2923 | |
|
2924 | | #ifdef SUPPORT_UCP |
2925 | | pcre_uint32 *clist_dest; |
2926 | | const pcre_uint32 *clist_src; |
2927 | | #else |
2928 | 0 | ((void)utf); /* Suppress "unused parameter" compiler warning */ |
2929 | 0 | #endif |
2930 | |
|
2931 | 0 | list[0] = c; |
2932 | 0 | list[1] = FALSE; |
2933 | 0 | code++; |
2934 | |
|
2935 | 0 | if (c >= OP_STAR && c <= OP_TYPEPOSUPTO) |
2936 | 0 | { |
2937 | 0 | base = get_repeat_base(c); |
2938 | 0 | c -= (base - OP_STAR); |
2939 | |
|
2940 | 0 | if (c == OP_UPTO || c == OP_MINUPTO || c == OP_EXACT || c == OP_POSUPTO) |
2941 | 0 | code += IMM2_SIZE; |
2942 | |
|
2943 | 0 | list[1] = (c != OP_PLUS && c != OP_MINPLUS && c != OP_EXACT && c != OP_POSPLUS); |
2944 | |
|
2945 | 0 | switch(base) |
2946 | 0 | { |
2947 | 0 | case OP_STAR: |
2948 | 0 | list[0] = OP_CHAR; |
2949 | 0 | break; |
2950 | | |
2951 | 0 | case OP_STARI: |
2952 | 0 | list[0] = OP_CHARI; |
2953 | 0 | break; |
2954 | | |
2955 | 0 | case OP_NOTSTAR: |
2956 | 0 | list[0] = OP_NOT; |
2957 | 0 | break; |
2958 | | |
2959 | 0 | case OP_NOTSTARI: |
2960 | 0 | list[0] = OP_NOTI; |
2961 | 0 | break; |
2962 | | |
2963 | 0 | case OP_TYPESTAR: |
2964 | 0 | list[0] = *code; |
2965 | 0 | code++; |
2966 | 0 | break; |
2967 | 0 | } |
2968 | 0 | c = list[0]; |
2969 | 0 | } |
2970 | | |
2971 | 0 | switch(c) |
2972 | 0 | { |
2973 | 0 | case OP_NOT_DIGIT: |
2974 | 0 | case OP_DIGIT: |
2975 | 0 | case OP_NOT_WHITESPACE: |
2976 | 0 | case OP_WHITESPACE: |
2977 | 0 | case OP_NOT_WORDCHAR: |
2978 | 0 | case OP_WORDCHAR: |
2979 | 0 | case OP_ANY: |
2980 | 0 | case OP_ALLANY: |
2981 | 0 | case OP_ANYNL: |
2982 | 0 | case OP_NOT_HSPACE: |
2983 | 0 | case OP_HSPACE: |
2984 | 0 | case OP_NOT_VSPACE: |
2985 | 0 | case OP_VSPACE: |
2986 | 0 | case OP_EXTUNI: |
2987 | 0 | case OP_EODN: |
2988 | 0 | case OP_EOD: |
2989 | 0 | case OP_DOLL: |
2990 | 0 | case OP_DOLLM: |
2991 | 0 | return code; |
2992 | | |
2993 | 0 | case OP_CHAR: |
2994 | 0 | case OP_NOT: |
2995 | 0 | GETCHARINCTEST(chr, code); |
2996 | 0 | list[2] = chr; |
2997 | 0 | list[3] = NOTACHAR; |
2998 | 0 | return code; |
2999 | | |
3000 | 0 | case OP_CHARI: |
3001 | 0 | case OP_NOTI: |
3002 | 0 | list[0] = (c == OP_CHARI) ? OP_CHAR : OP_NOT; |
3003 | 0 | GETCHARINCTEST(chr, code); |
3004 | 0 | list[2] = chr; |
3005 | |
|
3006 | | #ifdef SUPPORT_UCP |
3007 | | if (chr < 128 || (chr < 256 && !utf)) |
3008 | | list[3] = fcc[chr]; |
3009 | | else |
3010 | | list[3] = UCD_OTHERCASE(chr); |
3011 | | #elif defined SUPPORT_UTF || !defined COMPILE_PCRE8 |
3012 | | list[3] = (chr < 256) ? fcc[chr] : chr; |
3013 | | #else |
3014 | 0 | list[3] = fcc[chr]; |
3015 | 0 | #endif |
3016 | | |
3017 | | /* The othercase might be the same value. */ |
3018 | |
|
3019 | 0 | if (chr == list[3]) |
3020 | 0 | list[3] = NOTACHAR; |
3021 | 0 | else |
3022 | 0 | list[4] = NOTACHAR; |
3023 | 0 | return code; |
3024 | | |
3025 | | #ifdef SUPPORT_UCP |
3026 | | case OP_PROP: |
3027 | | case OP_NOTPROP: |
3028 | | if (code[0] != PT_CLIST) |
3029 | | { |
3030 | | list[2] = code[0]; |
3031 | | list[3] = code[1]; |
3032 | | return code + 2; |
3033 | | } |
3034 | | |
3035 | | /* Convert only if we have enough space. */ |
3036 | | |
3037 | | clist_src = PRIV(ucd_caseless_sets) + code[1]; |
3038 | | clist_dest = list + 2; |
3039 | | code += 2; |
3040 | | |
3041 | | do { |
3042 | | if (clist_dest >= list + 8) |
3043 | | { |
3044 | | /* Early return if there is not enough space. This should never |
3045 | | happen, since all clists are shorter than 5 character now. */ |
3046 | | list[2] = code[0]; |
3047 | | list[3] = code[1]; |
3048 | | return code; |
3049 | | } |
3050 | | *clist_dest++ = *clist_src; |
3051 | | } |
3052 | | while(*clist_src++ != NOTACHAR); |
3053 | | |
3054 | | /* All characters are stored. The terminating NOTACHAR |
3055 | | is copied form the clist itself. */ |
3056 | | |
3057 | | list[0] = (c == OP_PROP) ? OP_CHAR : OP_NOT; |
3058 | | return code; |
3059 | | #endif |
3060 | | |
3061 | 0 | case OP_NCLASS: |
3062 | 0 | case OP_CLASS: |
3063 | | #if defined SUPPORT_UTF || !defined COMPILE_PCRE8 |
3064 | | case OP_XCLASS: |
3065 | | if (c == OP_XCLASS) |
3066 | | end = code + GET(code, 0) - 1; |
3067 | | else |
3068 | | #endif |
3069 | 0 | end = code + 32 / sizeof(pcre_uchar); |
3070 | |
|
3071 | 0 | switch(*end) |
3072 | 0 | { |
3073 | 0 | case OP_CRSTAR: |
3074 | 0 | case OP_CRMINSTAR: |
3075 | 0 | case OP_CRQUERY: |
3076 | 0 | case OP_CRMINQUERY: |
3077 | 0 | case OP_CRPOSSTAR: |
3078 | 0 | case OP_CRPOSQUERY: |
3079 | 0 | list[1] = TRUE; |
3080 | 0 | end++; |
3081 | 0 | break; |
3082 | | |
3083 | 0 | case OP_CRPLUS: |
3084 | 0 | case OP_CRMINPLUS: |
3085 | 0 | case OP_CRPOSPLUS: |
3086 | 0 | end++; |
3087 | 0 | break; |
3088 | | |
3089 | 0 | case OP_CRRANGE: |
3090 | 0 | case OP_CRMINRANGE: |
3091 | 0 | case OP_CRPOSRANGE: |
3092 | 0 | list[1] = (GET2(end, 1) == 0); |
3093 | 0 | end += 1 + 2 * IMM2_SIZE; |
3094 | 0 | break; |
3095 | 0 | } |
3096 | 0 | list[2] = (pcre_uint32)(end - code); |
3097 | 0 | return end; |
3098 | 0 | } |
3099 | 0 | return NULL; /* Opcode not accepted */ |
3100 | 0 | } |
3101 | | |
3102 | | |
3103 | | |
3104 | | /************************************************* |
3105 | | * Scan further character sets for match * |
3106 | | *************************************************/ |
3107 | | |
3108 | | /* Checks whether the base and the current opcode have a common character, in |
3109 | | which case the base cannot be possessified. |
3110 | | |
3111 | | Arguments: |
3112 | | code points to the byte code |
3113 | | utf TRUE in UTF-8 / UTF-16 / UTF-32 mode |
3114 | | cd static compile data |
3115 | | base_list the data list of the base opcode |
3116 | | |
3117 | | Returns: TRUE if the auto-possessification is possible |
3118 | | */ |
3119 | | |
3120 | | static BOOL |
3121 | | compare_opcodes(const pcre_uchar *code, BOOL utf, const compile_data *cd, |
3122 | | const pcre_uint32 *base_list, const pcre_uchar *base_end, int *rec_limit) |
3123 | 0 | { |
3124 | 0 | pcre_uchar c; |
3125 | 0 | pcre_uint32 list[8]; |
3126 | 0 | const pcre_uint32 *chr_ptr; |
3127 | 0 | const pcre_uint32 *ochr_ptr; |
3128 | 0 | const pcre_uint32 *list_ptr; |
3129 | 0 | const pcre_uchar *next_code; |
3130 | | #if defined SUPPORT_UTF || !defined COMPILE_PCRE8 |
3131 | | const pcre_uchar *xclass_flags; |
3132 | | #endif |
3133 | 0 | const pcre_uint8 *class_bitset; |
3134 | 0 | const pcre_uint8 *set1, *set2, *set_end; |
3135 | 0 | pcre_uint32 chr; |
3136 | 0 | BOOL accepted, invert_bits; |
3137 | 0 | BOOL entered_a_group = FALSE; |
3138 | |
|
3139 | 0 | if (*rec_limit == 0) return FALSE; |
3140 | 0 | --(*rec_limit); |
3141 | | |
3142 | | /* Note: the base_list[1] contains whether the current opcode has greedy |
3143 | | (represented by a non-zero value) quantifier. This is a different from |
3144 | | other character type lists, which stores here that the character iterator |
3145 | | matches to an empty string (also represented by a non-zero value). */ |
3146 | |
|
3147 | 0 | for(;;) |
3148 | 0 | { |
3149 | | /* All operations move the code pointer forward. |
3150 | | Therefore infinite recursions are not possible. */ |
3151 | |
|
3152 | 0 | c = *code; |
3153 | | |
3154 | | /* Skip over callouts */ |
3155 | |
|
3156 | 0 | if (c == OP_CALLOUT) |
3157 | 0 | { |
3158 | 0 | code += PRIV(OP_lengths)[c]; |
3159 | 0 | continue; |
3160 | 0 | } |
3161 | | |
3162 | 0 | if (c == OP_ALT) |
3163 | 0 | { |
3164 | 0 | do code += GET(code, 1); while (*code == OP_ALT); |
3165 | 0 | c = *code; |
3166 | 0 | } |
3167 | |
|
3168 | 0 | switch(c) |
3169 | 0 | { |
3170 | 0 | case OP_END: |
3171 | 0 | case OP_KETRPOS: |
3172 | | /* TRUE only in greedy case. The non-greedy case could be replaced by |
3173 | | an OP_EXACT, but it is probably not worth it. (And note that OP_EXACT |
3174 | | uses more memory, which we cannot get at this stage.) */ |
3175 | |
|
3176 | 0 | return base_list[1] != 0; |
3177 | | |
3178 | 0 | case OP_KET: |
3179 | | /* If the bracket is capturing, and referenced by an OP_RECURSE, or |
3180 | | it is an atomic sub-pattern (assert, once, etc.) the non-greedy case |
3181 | | cannot be converted to a possessive form. */ |
3182 | |
|
3183 | 0 | if (base_list[1] == 0) return FALSE; |
3184 | | |
3185 | 0 | switch(*(code - GET(code, 1))) |
3186 | 0 | { |
3187 | 0 | case OP_ASSERT: |
3188 | 0 | case OP_ASSERT_NOT: |
3189 | 0 | case OP_ASSERTBACK: |
3190 | 0 | case OP_ASSERTBACK_NOT: |
3191 | 0 | case OP_ONCE: |
3192 | 0 | case OP_ONCE_NC: |
3193 | | /* Atomic sub-patterns and assertions can always auto-possessify their |
3194 | | last iterator. However, if the group was entered as a result of checking |
3195 | | a previous iterator, this is not possible. */ |
3196 | |
|
3197 | 0 | return !entered_a_group; |
3198 | 0 | } |
3199 | | |
3200 | 0 | code += PRIV(OP_lengths)[c]; |
3201 | 0 | continue; |
3202 | | |
3203 | 0 | case OP_ONCE: |
3204 | 0 | case OP_ONCE_NC: |
3205 | 0 | case OP_BRA: |
3206 | 0 | case OP_CBRA: |
3207 | 0 | next_code = code + GET(code, 1); |
3208 | 0 | code += PRIV(OP_lengths)[c]; |
3209 | |
|
3210 | 0 | while (*next_code == OP_ALT) |
3211 | 0 | { |
3212 | 0 | if (!compare_opcodes(code, utf, cd, base_list, base_end, rec_limit)) |
3213 | 0 | return FALSE; |
3214 | 0 | code = next_code + 1 + LINK_SIZE; |
3215 | 0 | next_code += GET(next_code, 1); |
3216 | 0 | } |
3217 | | |
3218 | 0 | entered_a_group = TRUE; |
3219 | 0 | continue; |
3220 | | |
3221 | 0 | case OP_BRAZERO: |
3222 | 0 | case OP_BRAMINZERO: |
3223 | |
|
3224 | 0 | next_code = code + 1; |
3225 | 0 | if (*next_code != OP_BRA && *next_code != OP_CBRA |
3226 | 0 | && *next_code != OP_ONCE && *next_code != OP_ONCE_NC) return FALSE; |
3227 | | |
3228 | 0 | do next_code += GET(next_code, 1); while (*next_code == OP_ALT); |
3229 | | |
3230 | | /* The bracket content will be checked by the |
3231 | | OP_BRA/OP_CBRA case above. */ |
3232 | 0 | next_code += 1 + LINK_SIZE; |
3233 | 0 | if (!compare_opcodes(next_code, utf, cd, base_list, base_end, rec_limit)) |
3234 | 0 | return FALSE; |
3235 | | |
3236 | 0 | code += PRIV(OP_lengths)[c]; |
3237 | 0 | continue; |
3238 | | |
3239 | 0 | default: |
3240 | 0 | break; |
3241 | 0 | } |
3242 | | |
3243 | | /* Check for a supported opcode, and load its properties. */ |
3244 | | |
3245 | 0 | code = get_chr_property_list(code, utf, cd->fcc, list); |
3246 | 0 | if (code == NULL) return FALSE; /* Unsupported */ |
3247 | | |
3248 | | /* If either opcode is a small character list, set pointers for comparing |
3249 | | characters from that list with another list, or with a property. */ |
3250 | | |
3251 | 0 | if (base_list[0] == OP_CHAR) |
3252 | 0 | { |
3253 | 0 | chr_ptr = base_list + 2; |
3254 | 0 | list_ptr = list; |
3255 | 0 | } |
3256 | 0 | else if (list[0] == OP_CHAR) |
3257 | 0 | { |
3258 | 0 | chr_ptr = list + 2; |
3259 | 0 | list_ptr = base_list; |
3260 | 0 | } |
3261 | | |
3262 | | /* Character bitsets can also be compared to certain opcodes. */ |
3263 | | |
3264 | 0 | else if (base_list[0] == OP_CLASS || list[0] == OP_CLASS |
3265 | 0 | #ifdef COMPILE_PCRE8 |
3266 | | /* In 8 bit, non-UTF mode, OP_CLASS and OP_NCLASS are the same. */ |
3267 | 0 | || (!utf && (base_list[0] == OP_NCLASS || list[0] == OP_NCLASS)) |
3268 | 0 | #endif |
3269 | 0 | ) |
3270 | 0 | { |
3271 | 0 | #ifdef COMPILE_PCRE8 |
3272 | 0 | if (base_list[0] == OP_CLASS || (!utf && base_list[0] == OP_NCLASS)) |
3273 | | #else |
3274 | | if (base_list[0] == OP_CLASS) |
3275 | | #endif |
3276 | 0 | { |
3277 | 0 | set1 = (pcre_uint8 *)(base_end - base_list[2]); |
3278 | 0 | list_ptr = list; |
3279 | 0 | } |
3280 | 0 | else |
3281 | 0 | { |
3282 | 0 | set1 = (pcre_uint8 *)(code - list[2]); |
3283 | 0 | list_ptr = base_list; |
3284 | 0 | } |
3285 | |
|
3286 | 0 | invert_bits = FALSE; |
3287 | 0 | switch(list_ptr[0]) |
3288 | 0 | { |
3289 | 0 | case OP_CLASS: |
3290 | 0 | case OP_NCLASS: |
3291 | 0 | set2 = (pcre_uint8 *) |
3292 | 0 | ((list_ptr == list ? code : base_end) - list_ptr[2]); |
3293 | 0 | break; |
3294 | | |
3295 | | #if defined SUPPORT_UTF || !defined COMPILE_PCRE8 |
3296 | | case OP_XCLASS: |
3297 | | xclass_flags = (list_ptr == list ? code : base_end) - list_ptr[2] + LINK_SIZE; |
3298 | | if ((*xclass_flags & XCL_HASPROP) != 0) return FALSE; |
3299 | | if ((*xclass_flags & XCL_MAP) == 0) |
3300 | | { |
3301 | | /* No bits are set for characters < 256. */ |
3302 | | if (list[1] == 0) return (*xclass_flags & XCL_NOT) == 0; |
3303 | | /* Might be an empty repeat. */ |
3304 | | continue; |
3305 | | } |
3306 | | set2 = (pcre_uint8 *)(xclass_flags + 1); |
3307 | | break; |
3308 | | #endif |
3309 | | |
3310 | 0 | case OP_NOT_DIGIT: |
3311 | 0 | invert_bits = TRUE; |
3312 | | /* Fall through */ |
3313 | 0 | case OP_DIGIT: |
3314 | 0 | set2 = (pcre_uint8 *)(cd->cbits + cbit_digit); |
3315 | 0 | break; |
3316 | | |
3317 | 0 | case OP_NOT_WHITESPACE: |
3318 | 0 | invert_bits = TRUE; |
3319 | | /* Fall through */ |
3320 | 0 | case OP_WHITESPACE: |
3321 | 0 | set2 = (pcre_uint8 *)(cd->cbits + cbit_space); |
3322 | 0 | break; |
3323 | | |
3324 | 0 | case OP_NOT_WORDCHAR: |
3325 | 0 | invert_bits = TRUE; |
3326 | | /* Fall through */ |
3327 | 0 | case OP_WORDCHAR: |
3328 | 0 | set2 = (pcre_uint8 *)(cd->cbits + cbit_word); |
3329 | 0 | break; |
3330 | | |
3331 | 0 | default: |
3332 | 0 | return FALSE; |
3333 | 0 | } |
3334 | | |
3335 | | /* Because the sets are unaligned, we need |
3336 | | to perform byte comparison here. */ |
3337 | 0 | set_end = set1 + 32; |
3338 | 0 | if (invert_bits) |
3339 | 0 | { |
3340 | 0 | do |
3341 | 0 | { |
3342 | 0 | if ((*set1++ & ~(*set2++)) != 0) return FALSE; |
3343 | 0 | } |
3344 | 0 | while (set1 < set_end); |
3345 | 0 | } |
3346 | 0 | else |
3347 | 0 | { |
3348 | 0 | do |
3349 | 0 | { |
3350 | 0 | if ((*set1++ & *set2++) != 0) return FALSE; |
3351 | 0 | } |
3352 | 0 | while (set1 < set_end); |
3353 | 0 | } |
3354 | | |
3355 | 0 | if (list[1] == 0) return TRUE; |
3356 | | /* Might be an empty repeat. */ |
3357 | 0 | continue; |
3358 | 0 | } |
3359 | | |
3360 | | /* Some property combinations also acceptable. Unicode property opcodes are |
3361 | | processed specially; the rest can be handled with a lookup table. */ |
3362 | | |
3363 | 0 | else |
3364 | 0 | { |
3365 | 0 | pcre_uint32 leftop, rightop; |
3366 | |
|
3367 | 0 | leftop = base_list[0]; |
3368 | 0 | rightop = list[0]; |
3369 | |
|
3370 | | #ifdef SUPPORT_UCP |
3371 | | accepted = FALSE; /* Always set in non-unicode case. */ |
3372 | | if (leftop == OP_PROP || leftop == OP_NOTPROP) |
3373 | | { |
3374 | | if (rightop == OP_EOD) |
3375 | | accepted = TRUE; |
3376 | | else if (rightop == OP_PROP || rightop == OP_NOTPROP) |
3377 | | { |
3378 | | int n; |
3379 | | const pcre_uint8 *p; |
3380 | | BOOL same = leftop == rightop; |
3381 | | BOOL lisprop = leftop == OP_PROP; |
3382 | | BOOL risprop = rightop == OP_PROP; |
3383 | | BOOL bothprop = lisprop && risprop; |
3384 | | |
3385 | | /* There's a table that specifies how each combination is to be |
3386 | | processed: |
3387 | | 0 Always return FALSE (never auto-possessify) |
3388 | | 1 Character groups are distinct (possessify if both are OP_PROP) |
3389 | | 2 Check character categories in the same group (general or particular) |
3390 | | 3 Return TRUE if the two opcodes are not the same |
3391 | | ... see comments below |
3392 | | */ |
3393 | | |
3394 | | n = propposstab[base_list[2]][list[2]]; |
3395 | | switch(n) |
3396 | | { |
3397 | | case 0: break; |
3398 | | case 1: accepted = bothprop; break; |
3399 | | case 2: accepted = (base_list[3] == list[3]) != same; break; |
3400 | | case 3: accepted = !same; break; |
3401 | | |
3402 | | case 4: /* Left general category, right particular category */ |
3403 | | accepted = risprop && catposstab[base_list[3]][list[3]] == same; |
3404 | | break; |
3405 | | |
3406 | | case 5: /* Right general category, left particular category */ |
3407 | | accepted = lisprop && catposstab[list[3]][base_list[3]] == same; |
3408 | | break; |
3409 | | |
3410 | | /* This code is logically tricky. Think hard before fiddling with it. |
3411 | | The posspropstab table has four entries per row. Each row relates to |
3412 | | one of PCRE's special properties such as ALNUM or SPACE or WORD. |
3413 | | Only WORD actually needs all four entries, but using repeats for the |
3414 | | others means they can all use the same code below. |
3415 | | |
3416 | | The first two entries in each row are Unicode general categories, and |
3417 | | apply always, because all the characters they include are part of the |
3418 | | PCRE character set. The third and fourth entries are a general and a |
3419 | | particular category, respectively, that include one or more relevant |
3420 | | characters. One or the other is used, depending on whether the check |
3421 | | is for a general or a particular category. However, in both cases the |
3422 | | category contains more characters than the specials that are defined |
3423 | | for the property being tested against. Therefore, it cannot be used |
3424 | | in a NOTPROP case. |
3425 | | |
3426 | | Example: the row for WORD contains ucp_L, ucp_N, ucp_P, ucp_Po. |
3427 | | Underscore is covered by ucp_P or ucp_Po. */ |
3428 | | |
3429 | | case 6: /* Left alphanum vs right general category */ |
3430 | | case 7: /* Left space vs right general category */ |
3431 | | case 8: /* Left word vs right general category */ |
3432 | | p = posspropstab[n-6]; |
3433 | | accepted = risprop && lisprop == |
3434 | | (list[3] != p[0] && |
3435 | | list[3] != p[1] && |
3436 | | (list[3] != p[2] || !lisprop)); |
3437 | | break; |
3438 | | |
3439 | | case 9: /* Right alphanum vs left general category */ |
3440 | | case 10: /* Right space vs left general category */ |
3441 | | case 11: /* Right word vs left general category */ |
3442 | | p = posspropstab[n-9]; |
3443 | | accepted = lisprop && risprop == |
3444 | | (base_list[3] != p[0] && |
3445 | | base_list[3] != p[1] && |
3446 | | (base_list[3] != p[2] || !risprop)); |
3447 | | break; |
3448 | | |
3449 | | case 12: /* Left alphanum vs right particular category */ |
3450 | | case 13: /* Left space vs right particular category */ |
3451 | | case 14: /* Left word vs right particular category */ |
3452 | | p = posspropstab[n-12]; |
3453 | | accepted = risprop && lisprop == |
3454 | | (catposstab[p[0]][list[3]] && |
3455 | | catposstab[p[1]][list[3]] && |
3456 | | (list[3] != p[3] || !lisprop)); |
3457 | | break; |
3458 | | |
3459 | | case 15: /* Right alphanum vs left particular category */ |
3460 | | case 16: /* Right space vs left particular category */ |
3461 | | case 17: /* Right word vs left particular category */ |
3462 | | p = posspropstab[n-15]; |
3463 | | accepted = lisprop && risprop == |
3464 | | (catposstab[p[0]][base_list[3]] && |
3465 | | catposstab[p[1]][base_list[3]] && |
3466 | | (base_list[3] != p[3] || !risprop)); |
3467 | | break; |
3468 | | } |
3469 | | } |
3470 | | } |
3471 | | |
3472 | | else |
3473 | | #endif /* SUPPORT_UCP */ |
3474 | |
|
3475 | 0 | accepted = leftop >= FIRST_AUTOTAB_OP && leftop <= LAST_AUTOTAB_LEFT_OP && |
3476 | 0 | rightop >= FIRST_AUTOTAB_OP && rightop <= LAST_AUTOTAB_RIGHT_OP && |
3477 | 0 | autoposstab[leftop - FIRST_AUTOTAB_OP][rightop - FIRST_AUTOTAB_OP]; |
3478 | |
|
3479 | 0 | if (!accepted) return FALSE; |
3480 | | |
3481 | 0 | if (list[1] == 0) return TRUE; |
3482 | | /* Might be an empty repeat. */ |
3483 | 0 | continue; |
3484 | 0 | } |
3485 | | |
3486 | | /* Control reaches here only if one of the items is a small character list. |
3487 | | All characters are checked against the other side. */ |
3488 | | |
3489 | 0 | do |
3490 | 0 | { |
3491 | 0 | chr = *chr_ptr; |
3492 | |
|
3493 | 0 | switch(list_ptr[0]) |
3494 | 0 | { |
3495 | 0 | case OP_CHAR: |
3496 | 0 | ochr_ptr = list_ptr + 2; |
3497 | 0 | do |
3498 | 0 | { |
3499 | 0 | if (chr == *ochr_ptr) return FALSE; |
3500 | 0 | ochr_ptr++; |
3501 | 0 | } |
3502 | 0 | while(*ochr_ptr != NOTACHAR); |
3503 | 0 | break; |
3504 | | |
3505 | 0 | case OP_NOT: |
3506 | 0 | ochr_ptr = list_ptr + 2; |
3507 | 0 | do |
3508 | 0 | { |
3509 | 0 | if (chr == *ochr_ptr) |
3510 | 0 | break; |
3511 | 0 | ochr_ptr++; |
3512 | 0 | } |
3513 | 0 | while(*ochr_ptr != NOTACHAR); |
3514 | 0 | if (*ochr_ptr == NOTACHAR) return FALSE; /* Not found */ |
3515 | 0 | break; |
3516 | | |
3517 | | /* Note that OP_DIGIT etc. are generated only when PCRE_UCP is *not* |
3518 | | set. When it is set, \d etc. are converted into OP_(NOT_)PROP codes. */ |
3519 | | |
3520 | 0 | case OP_DIGIT: |
3521 | 0 | if (chr < 256 && (cd->ctypes[chr] & ctype_digit) != 0) return FALSE; |
3522 | 0 | break; |
3523 | | |
3524 | 0 | case OP_NOT_DIGIT: |
3525 | 0 | if (chr > 255 || (cd->ctypes[chr] & ctype_digit) == 0) return FALSE; |
3526 | 0 | break; |
3527 | | |
3528 | 0 | case OP_WHITESPACE: |
3529 | 0 | if (chr < 256 && (cd->ctypes[chr] & ctype_space) != 0) return FALSE; |
3530 | 0 | break; |
3531 | | |
3532 | 0 | case OP_NOT_WHITESPACE: |
3533 | 0 | if (chr > 255 || (cd->ctypes[chr] & ctype_space) == 0) return FALSE; |
3534 | 0 | break; |
3535 | | |
3536 | 0 | case OP_WORDCHAR: |
3537 | 0 | if (chr < 255 && (cd->ctypes[chr] & ctype_word) != 0) return FALSE; |
3538 | 0 | break; |
3539 | | |
3540 | 0 | case OP_NOT_WORDCHAR: |
3541 | 0 | if (chr > 255 || (cd->ctypes[chr] & ctype_word) == 0) return FALSE; |
3542 | 0 | break; |
3543 | | |
3544 | 0 | case OP_HSPACE: |
3545 | 0 | switch(chr) |
3546 | 0 | { |
3547 | 0 | HSPACE_CASES: return FALSE; |
3548 | 0 | default: break; |
3549 | 0 | } |
3550 | 0 | break; |
3551 | | |
3552 | 0 | case OP_NOT_HSPACE: |
3553 | 0 | switch(chr) |
3554 | 0 | { |
3555 | 0 | HSPACE_CASES: break; |
3556 | 0 | default: return FALSE; |
3557 | 0 | } |
3558 | 0 | break; |
3559 | | |
3560 | 0 | case OP_ANYNL: |
3561 | 0 | case OP_VSPACE: |
3562 | 0 | switch(chr) |
3563 | 0 | { |
3564 | 0 | VSPACE_CASES: return FALSE; |
3565 | 0 | default: break; |
3566 | 0 | } |
3567 | 0 | break; |
3568 | | |
3569 | 0 | case OP_NOT_VSPACE: |
3570 | 0 | switch(chr) |
3571 | 0 | { |
3572 | 0 | VSPACE_CASES: break; |
3573 | 0 | default: return FALSE; |
3574 | 0 | } |
3575 | 0 | break; |
3576 | | |
3577 | 0 | case OP_DOLL: |
3578 | 0 | case OP_EODN: |
3579 | 0 | switch (chr) |
3580 | 0 | { |
3581 | 0 | case CHAR_CR: |
3582 | 0 | case CHAR_LF: |
3583 | 0 | case CHAR_VT: |
3584 | 0 | case CHAR_FF: |
3585 | 0 | case CHAR_NEL: |
3586 | 0 | #ifndef EBCDIC |
3587 | 0 | case 0x2028: |
3588 | 0 | case 0x2029: |
3589 | 0 | #endif /* Not EBCDIC */ |
3590 | 0 | return FALSE; |
3591 | 0 | } |
3592 | 0 | break; |
3593 | | |
3594 | 0 | case OP_EOD: /* Can always possessify before \z */ |
3595 | 0 | break; |
3596 | | |
3597 | | #ifdef SUPPORT_UCP |
3598 | | case OP_PROP: |
3599 | | case OP_NOTPROP: |
3600 | | if (!check_char_prop(chr, list_ptr[2], list_ptr[3], |
3601 | | list_ptr[0] == OP_NOTPROP)) |
3602 | | return FALSE; |
3603 | | break; |
3604 | | #endif |
3605 | | |
3606 | 0 | case OP_NCLASS: |
3607 | 0 | if (chr > 255) return FALSE; |
3608 | | /* Fall through */ |
3609 | | |
3610 | 0 | case OP_CLASS: |
3611 | 0 | if (chr > 255) break; |
3612 | 0 | class_bitset = (pcre_uint8 *) |
3613 | 0 | ((list_ptr == list ? code : base_end) - list_ptr[2]); |
3614 | 0 | if ((class_bitset[chr >> 3] & (1U << (chr & 7))) != 0) return FALSE; |
3615 | 0 | break; |
3616 | | |
3617 | | #if defined SUPPORT_UTF || !defined COMPILE_PCRE8 |
3618 | | case OP_XCLASS: |
3619 | | if (PRIV(xclass)(chr, (list_ptr == list ? code : base_end) - |
3620 | | list_ptr[2] + LINK_SIZE, utf)) return FALSE; |
3621 | | break; |
3622 | | #endif |
3623 | | |
3624 | 0 | default: |
3625 | 0 | return FALSE; |
3626 | 0 | } |
3627 | | |
3628 | 0 | chr_ptr++; |
3629 | 0 | } |
3630 | 0 | while(*chr_ptr != NOTACHAR); |
3631 | | |
3632 | | /* At least one character must be matched from this opcode. */ |
3633 | | |
3634 | 0 | if (list[1] == 0) return TRUE; |
3635 | 0 | } |
3636 | | |
3637 | | /* Control never reaches here. There used to be a fail-save return FALSE; here, |
3638 | | but some compilers complain about an unreachable statement. */ |
3639 | |
|
3640 | 0 | } |
3641 | | |
3642 | | |
3643 | | |
3644 | | /************************************************* |
3645 | | * Scan compiled regex for auto-possession * |
3646 | | *************************************************/ |
3647 | | |
3648 | | /* Replaces single character iterations with their possessive alternatives |
3649 | | if appropriate. This function modifies the compiled opcode! |
3650 | | |
3651 | | Arguments: |
3652 | | code points to start of the byte code |
3653 | | utf TRUE in UTF-8 / UTF-16 / UTF-32 mode |
3654 | | cd static compile data |
3655 | | |
3656 | | Returns: nothing |
3657 | | */ |
3658 | | |
3659 | | static void |
3660 | | auto_possessify(pcre_uchar *code, BOOL utf, const compile_data *cd) |
3661 | 0 | { |
3662 | 0 | register pcre_uchar c; |
3663 | 0 | const pcre_uchar *end; |
3664 | 0 | pcre_uchar *repeat_opcode; |
3665 | 0 | pcre_uint32 list[8]; |
3666 | 0 | int rec_limit; |
3667 | |
|
3668 | 0 | for (;;) |
3669 | 0 | { |
3670 | 0 | c = *code; |
3671 | | |
3672 | | /* When a pattern with bad UTF-8 encoding is compiled with NO_UTF_CHECK, |
3673 | | it may compile without complaining, but may get into a loop here if the code |
3674 | | pointer points to a bad value. This is, of course a documentated possibility, |
3675 | | when NO_UTF_CHECK is set, so it isn't a bug, but we can detect this case and |
3676 | | just give up on this optimization. */ |
3677 | |
|
3678 | 0 | if (c >= OP_TABLE_LENGTH) return; |
3679 | | |
3680 | 0 | if (c >= OP_STAR && c <= OP_TYPEPOSUPTO) |
3681 | 0 | { |
3682 | 0 | c -= get_repeat_base(c) - OP_STAR; |
3683 | 0 | end = (c <= OP_MINUPTO) ? |
3684 | 0 | get_chr_property_list(code, utf, cd->fcc, list) : NULL; |
3685 | 0 | list[1] = c == OP_STAR || c == OP_PLUS || c == OP_QUERY || c == OP_UPTO; |
3686 | |
|
3687 | 0 | rec_limit = 1000; |
3688 | 0 | if (end != NULL && compare_opcodes(end, utf, cd, list, end, &rec_limit)) |
3689 | 0 | { |
3690 | 0 | switch(c) |
3691 | 0 | { |
3692 | 0 | case OP_STAR: |
3693 | 0 | *code += OP_POSSTAR - OP_STAR; |
3694 | 0 | break; |
3695 | | |
3696 | 0 | case OP_MINSTAR: |
3697 | 0 | *code += OP_POSSTAR - OP_MINSTAR; |
3698 | 0 | break; |
3699 | | |
3700 | 0 | case OP_PLUS: |
3701 | 0 | *code += OP_POSPLUS - OP_PLUS; |
3702 | 0 | break; |
3703 | | |
3704 | 0 | case OP_MINPLUS: |
3705 | 0 | *code += OP_POSPLUS - OP_MINPLUS; |
3706 | 0 | break; |
3707 | | |
3708 | 0 | case OP_QUERY: |
3709 | 0 | *code += OP_POSQUERY - OP_QUERY; |
3710 | 0 | break; |
3711 | | |
3712 | 0 | case OP_MINQUERY: |
3713 | 0 | *code += OP_POSQUERY - OP_MINQUERY; |
3714 | 0 | break; |
3715 | | |
3716 | 0 | case OP_UPTO: |
3717 | 0 | *code += OP_POSUPTO - OP_UPTO; |
3718 | 0 | break; |
3719 | | |
3720 | 0 | case OP_MINUPTO: |
3721 | 0 | *code += OP_POSUPTO - OP_MINUPTO; |
3722 | 0 | break; |
3723 | 0 | } |
3724 | 0 | } |
3725 | 0 | c = *code; |
3726 | 0 | } |
3727 | 0 | else if (c == OP_CLASS || c == OP_NCLASS || c == OP_XCLASS) |
3728 | 0 | { |
3729 | | #if defined SUPPORT_UTF || !defined COMPILE_PCRE8 |
3730 | | if (c == OP_XCLASS) |
3731 | | repeat_opcode = code + GET(code, 1); |
3732 | | else |
3733 | | #endif |
3734 | 0 | repeat_opcode = code + 1 + (32 / sizeof(pcre_uchar)); |
3735 | |
|
3736 | 0 | c = *repeat_opcode; |
3737 | 0 | if (c >= OP_CRSTAR && c <= OP_CRMINRANGE) |
3738 | 0 | { |
3739 | | /* end must not be NULL. */ |
3740 | 0 | end = get_chr_property_list(code, utf, cd->fcc, list); |
3741 | |
|
3742 | 0 | list[1] = (c & 1) == 0; |
3743 | |
|
3744 | 0 | rec_limit = 1000; |
3745 | 0 | if (compare_opcodes(end, utf, cd, list, end, &rec_limit)) |
3746 | 0 | { |
3747 | 0 | switch (c) |
3748 | 0 | { |
3749 | 0 | case OP_CRSTAR: |
3750 | 0 | case OP_CRMINSTAR: |
3751 | 0 | *repeat_opcode = OP_CRPOSSTAR; |
3752 | 0 | break; |
3753 | | |
3754 | 0 | case OP_CRPLUS: |
3755 | 0 | case OP_CRMINPLUS: |
3756 | 0 | *repeat_opcode = OP_CRPOSPLUS; |
3757 | 0 | break; |
3758 | | |
3759 | 0 | case OP_CRQUERY: |
3760 | 0 | case OP_CRMINQUERY: |
3761 | 0 | *repeat_opcode = OP_CRPOSQUERY; |
3762 | 0 | break; |
3763 | | |
3764 | 0 | case OP_CRRANGE: |
3765 | 0 | case OP_CRMINRANGE: |
3766 | 0 | *repeat_opcode = OP_CRPOSRANGE; |
3767 | 0 | break; |
3768 | 0 | } |
3769 | 0 | } |
3770 | 0 | } |
3771 | 0 | c = *code; |
3772 | 0 | } |
3773 | | |
3774 | 0 | switch(c) |
3775 | 0 | { |
3776 | 0 | case OP_END: |
3777 | 0 | return; |
3778 | | |
3779 | 0 | case OP_TYPESTAR: |
3780 | 0 | case OP_TYPEMINSTAR: |
3781 | 0 | case OP_TYPEPLUS: |
3782 | 0 | case OP_TYPEMINPLUS: |
3783 | 0 | case OP_TYPEQUERY: |
3784 | 0 | case OP_TYPEMINQUERY: |
3785 | 0 | case OP_TYPEPOSSTAR: |
3786 | 0 | case OP_TYPEPOSPLUS: |
3787 | 0 | case OP_TYPEPOSQUERY: |
3788 | 0 | if (code[1] == OP_PROP || code[1] == OP_NOTPROP) code += 2; |
3789 | 0 | break; |
3790 | | |
3791 | 0 | case OP_TYPEUPTO: |
3792 | 0 | case OP_TYPEMINUPTO: |
3793 | 0 | case OP_TYPEEXACT: |
3794 | 0 | case OP_TYPEPOSUPTO: |
3795 | 0 | if (code[1 + IMM2_SIZE] == OP_PROP || code[1 + IMM2_SIZE] == OP_NOTPROP) |
3796 | 0 | code += 2; |
3797 | 0 | break; |
3798 | | |
3799 | | #if defined SUPPORT_UTF || !defined COMPILE_PCRE8 |
3800 | | case OP_XCLASS: |
3801 | | code += GET(code, 1); |
3802 | | break; |
3803 | | #endif |
3804 | | |
3805 | 0 | case OP_MARK: |
3806 | 0 | case OP_PRUNE_ARG: |
3807 | 0 | case OP_SKIP_ARG: |
3808 | 0 | case OP_THEN_ARG: |
3809 | 0 | code += code[1]; |
3810 | 0 | break; |
3811 | 0 | } |
3812 | | |
3813 | | /* Add in the fixed length from the table */ |
3814 | | |
3815 | 0 | code += PRIV(OP_lengths)[c]; |
3816 | | |
3817 | | /* In UTF-8 mode, opcodes that are followed by a character may be followed by |
3818 | | a multi-byte character. The length in the table is a minimum, so we have to |
3819 | | arrange to skip the extra bytes. */ |
3820 | |
|
3821 | | #if defined SUPPORT_UTF && !defined COMPILE_PCRE32 |
3822 | | if (utf) switch(c) |
3823 | | { |
3824 | | case OP_CHAR: |
3825 | | case OP_CHARI: |
3826 | | case OP_NOT: |
3827 | | case OP_NOTI: |
3828 | | case OP_STAR: |
3829 | | case OP_MINSTAR: |
3830 | | case OP_PLUS: |
3831 | | case OP_MINPLUS: |
3832 | | case OP_QUERY: |
3833 | | case OP_MINQUERY: |
3834 | | case OP_UPTO: |
3835 | | case OP_MINUPTO: |
3836 | | case OP_EXACT: |
3837 | | case OP_POSSTAR: |
3838 | | case OP_POSPLUS: |
3839 | | case OP_POSQUERY: |
3840 | | case OP_POSUPTO: |
3841 | | case OP_STARI: |
3842 | | case OP_MINSTARI: |
3843 | | case OP_PLUSI: |
3844 | | case OP_MINPLUSI: |
3845 | | case OP_QUERYI: |
3846 | | case OP_MINQUERYI: |
3847 | | case OP_UPTOI: |
3848 | | case OP_MINUPTOI: |
3849 | | case OP_EXACTI: |
3850 | | case OP_POSSTARI: |
3851 | | case OP_POSPLUSI: |
3852 | | case OP_POSQUERYI: |
3853 | | case OP_POSUPTOI: |
3854 | | case OP_NOTSTAR: |
3855 | | case OP_NOTMINSTAR: |
3856 | | case OP_NOTPLUS: |
3857 | | case OP_NOTMINPLUS: |
3858 | | case OP_NOTQUERY: |
3859 | | case OP_NOTMINQUERY: |
3860 | | case OP_NOTUPTO: |
3861 | | case OP_NOTMINUPTO: |
3862 | | case OP_NOTEXACT: |
3863 | | case OP_NOTPOSSTAR: |
3864 | | case OP_NOTPOSPLUS: |
3865 | | case OP_NOTPOSQUERY: |
3866 | | case OP_NOTPOSUPTO: |
3867 | | case OP_NOTSTARI: |
3868 | | case OP_NOTMINSTARI: |
3869 | | case OP_NOTPLUSI: |
3870 | | case OP_NOTMINPLUSI: |
3871 | | case OP_NOTQUERYI: |
3872 | | case OP_NOTMINQUERYI: |
3873 | | case OP_NOTUPTOI: |
3874 | | case OP_NOTMINUPTOI: |
3875 | | case OP_NOTEXACTI: |
3876 | | case OP_NOTPOSSTARI: |
3877 | | case OP_NOTPOSPLUSI: |
3878 | | case OP_NOTPOSQUERYI: |
3879 | | case OP_NOTPOSUPTOI: |
3880 | | if (HAS_EXTRALEN(code[-1])) code += GET_EXTRALEN(code[-1]); |
3881 | | break; |
3882 | | } |
3883 | | #else |
3884 | 0 | (void)(utf); /* Keep compiler happy by referencing function argument */ |
3885 | 0 | #endif |
3886 | 0 | } |
3887 | 0 | } |
3888 | | |
3889 | | |
3890 | | |
3891 | | /************************************************* |
3892 | | * Check for POSIX class syntax * |
3893 | | *************************************************/ |
3894 | | |
3895 | | /* This function is called when the sequence "[:" or "[." or "[=" is |
3896 | | encountered in a character class. It checks whether this is followed by a |
3897 | | sequence of characters terminated by a matching ":]" or ".]" or "=]". If we |
3898 | | reach an unescaped ']' without the special preceding character, return FALSE. |
3899 | | |
3900 | | Originally, this function only recognized a sequence of letters between the |
3901 | | terminators, but it seems that Perl recognizes any sequence of characters, |
3902 | | though of course unknown POSIX names are subsequently rejected. Perl gives an |
3903 | | "Unknown POSIX class" error for [:f\oo:] for example, where previously PCRE |
3904 | | didn't consider this to be a POSIX class. Likewise for [:1234:]. |
3905 | | |
3906 | | The problem in trying to be exactly like Perl is in the handling of escapes. We |
3907 | | have to be sure that [abc[:x\]pqr] is *not* treated as containing a POSIX |
3908 | | class, but [abc[:x\]pqr:]] is (so that an error can be generated). The code |
3909 | | below handles the special cases \\ and \], but does not try to do any other |
3910 | | escape processing. This makes it different from Perl for cases such as |
3911 | | [:l\ower:] where Perl recognizes it as the POSIX class "lower" but PCRE does |
3912 | | not recognize "l\ower". This is a lesser evil than not diagnosing bad classes |
3913 | | when Perl does, I think. |
3914 | | |
3915 | | A user pointed out that PCRE was rejecting [:a[:digit:]] whereas Perl was not. |
3916 | | It seems that the appearance of a nested POSIX class supersedes an apparent |
3917 | | external class. For example, [:a[:digit:]b:] matches "a", "b", ":", or |
3918 | | a digit. |
3919 | | |
3920 | | In Perl, unescaped square brackets may also appear as part of class names. For |
3921 | | example, [:a[:abc]b:] gives unknown POSIX class "[:abc]b:]". However, for |
3922 | | [:a[:abc]b][b:] it gives unknown POSIX class "[:abc]b][b:]", which does not |
3923 | | seem right at all. PCRE does not allow closing square brackets in POSIX class |
3924 | | names. |
3925 | | |
3926 | | Arguments: |
3927 | | ptr pointer to the initial [ |
3928 | | endptr where to return the end pointer |
3929 | | |
3930 | | Returns: TRUE or FALSE |
3931 | | */ |
3932 | | |
3933 | | static BOOL |
3934 | | check_posix_syntax(const pcre_uchar *ptr, const pcre_uchar **endptr) |
3935 | 0 | { |
3936 | 0 | pcre_uchar terminator; /* Don't combine these lines; the Solaris cc */ |
3937 | 0 | terminator = *(++ptr); /* compiler warns about "non-constant" initializer. */ |
3938 | 0 | for (++ptr; *ptr != CHAR_NULL; ptr++) |
3939 | 0 | { |
3940 | 0 | if (*ptr == CHAR_BACKSLASH && |
3941 | 0 | (ptr[1] == CHAR_RIGHT_SQUARE_BRACKET || |
3942 | 0 | ptr[1] == CHAR_BACKSLASH)) |
3943 | 0 | ptr++; |
3944 | 0 | else if ((*ptr == CHAR_LEFT_SQUARE_BRACKET && ptr[1] == terminator) || |
3945 | 0 | *ptr == CHAR_RIGHT_SQUARE_BRACKET) return FALSE; |
3946 | 0 | else if (*ptr == terminator && ptr[1] == CHAR_RIGHT_SQUARE_BRACKET) |
3947 | 0 | { |
3948 | 0 | *endptr = ptr; |
3949 | 0 | return TRUE; |
3950 | 0 | } |
3951 | 0 | } |
3952 | 0 | return FALSE; |
3953 | 0 | } |
3954 | | |
3955 | | |
3956 | | |
3957 | | |
3958 | | /************************************************* |
3959 | | * Check POSIX class name * |
3960 | | *************************************************/ |
3961 | | |
3962 | | /* This function is called to check the name given in a POSIX-style class entry |
3963 | | such as [:alnum:]. |
3964 | | |
3965 | | Arguments: |
3966 | | ptr points to the first letter |
3967 | | len the length of the name |
3968 | | |
3969 | | Returns: a value representing the name, or -1 if unknown |
3970 | | */ |
3971 | | |
3972 | | static int |
3973 | | check_posix_name(const pcre_uchar *ptr, int len) |
3974 | 0 | { |
3975 | 0 | const char *pn = posix_names; |
3976 | 0 | register int yield = 0; |
3977 | 0 | while (posix_name_lengths[yield] != 0) |
3978 | 0 | { |
3979 | 0 | if (len == posix_name_lengths[yield] && |
3980 | 0 | STRNCMP_UC_C8(ptr, pn, (unsigned int)len) == 0) return yield; |
3981 | 0 | pn += posix_name_lengths[yield] + 1; |
3982 | 0 | yield++; |
3983 | 0 | } |
3984 | 0 | return -1; |
3985 | 0 | } |
3986 | | |
3987 | | |
3988 | | /************************************************* |
3989 | | * Adjust OP_RECURSE items in repeated group * |
3990 | | *************************************************/ |
3991 | | |
3992 | | /* OP_RECURSE items contain an offset from the start of the regex to the group |
3993 | | that is referenced. This means that groups can be replicated for fixed |
3994 | | repetition simply by copying (because the recursion is allowed to refer to |
3995 | | earlier groups that are outside the current group). However, when a group is |
3996 | | optional (i.e. the minimum quantifier is zero), OP_BRAZERO or OP_SKIPZERO is |
3997 | | inserted before it, after it has been compiled. This means that any OP_RECURSE |
3998 | | items within it that refer to the group itself or any contained groups have to |
3999 | | have their offsets adjusted. That one of the jobs of this function. Before it |
4000 | | is called, the partially compiled regex must be temporarily terminated with |
4001 | | OP_END. |
4002 | | |
4003 | | This function has been extended to cope with forward references for recursions |
4004 | | and subroutine calls. It must check the list of such references for the |
4005 | | group we are dealing with. If it finds that one of the recursions in the |
4006 | | current group is on this list, it does not adjust the value in the reference |
4007 | | (which is a group number). After the group has been scanned, all the offsets in |
4008 | | the forward reference list for the group are adjusted. |
4009 | | |
4010 | | Arguments: |
4011 | | group points to the start of the group |
4012 | | adjust the amount by which the group is to be moved |
4013 | | utf TRUE in UTF-8 / UTF-16 / UTF-32 mode |
4014 | | cd contains pointers to tables etc. |
4015 | | save_hwm_offset the hwm forward reference offset at the start of the group |
4016 | | |
4017 | | Returns: nothing |
4018 | | */ |
4019 | | |
4020 | | static void |
4021 | | adjust_recurse(pcre_uchar *group, int adjust, BOOL utf, compile_data *cd, |
4022 | | size_t save_hwm_offset) |
4023 | 0 | { |
4024 | 0 | int offset; |
4025 | 0 | pcre_uchar *hc; |
4026 | 0 | pcre_uchar *ptr = group; |
4027 | |
|
4028 | 0 | while ((ptr = (pcre_uchar *)find_recurse(ptr, utf)) != NULL) |
4029 | 0 | { |
4030 | 0 | for (hc = (pcre_uchar *)cd->start_workspace + save_hwm_offset; hc < cd->hwm; |
4031 | 0 | hc += LINK_SIZE) |
4032 | 0 | { |
4033 | 0 | offset = (int)GET(hc, 0); |
4034 | 0 | if (cd->start_code + offset == ptr + 1) break; |
4035 | 0 | } |
4036 | | |
4037 | | /* If we have not found this recursion on the forward reference list, adjust |
4038 | | the recursion's offset if it's after the start of this group. */ |
4039 | |
|
4040 | 0 | if (hc >= cd->hwm) |
4041 | 0 | { |
4042 | 0 | offset = (int)GET(ptr, 1); |
4043 | 0 | if (cd->start_code + offset >= group) PUT(ptr, 1, offset + adjust); |
4044 | 0 | } |
4045 | |
|
4046 | 0 | ptr += 1 + LINK_SIZE; |
4047 | 0 | } |
4048 | | |
4049 | | /* Now adjust all forward reference offsets for the group. */ |
4050 | |
|
4051 | 0 | for (hc = (pcre_uchar *)cd->start_workspace + save_hwm_offset; hc < cd->hwm; |
4052 | 0 | hc += LINK_SIZE) |
4053 | 0 | { |
4054 | 0 | offset = (int)GET(hc, 0); |
4055 | 0 | PUT(hc, 0, offset + adjust); |
4056 | 0 | } |
4057 | 0 | } |
4058 | | |
4059 | | |
4060 | | |
4061 | | /************************************************* |
4062 | | * Insert an automatic callout point * |
4063 | | *************************************************/ |
4064 | | |
4065 | | /* This function is called when the PCRE_AUTO_CALLOUT option is set, to insert |
4066 | | callout points before each pattern item. |
4067 | | |
4068 | | Arguments: |
4069 | | code current code pointer |
4070 | | ptr current pattern pointer |
4071 | | cd pointers to tables etc |
4072 | | |
4073 | | Returns: new code pointer |
4074 | | */ |
4075 | | |
4076 | | static pcre_uchar * |
4077 | | auto_callout(pcre_uchar *code, const pcre_uchar *ptr, compile_data *cd) |
4078 | 0 | { |
4079 | 0 | *code++ = OP_CALLOUT; |
4080 | 0 | *code++ = 255; |
4081 | 0 | PUT(code, 0, (int)(ptr - cd->start_pattern)); /* Pattern offset */ |
4082 | 0 | PUT(code, LINK_SIZE, 0); /* Default length */ |
4083 | 0 | return code + 2 * LINK_SIZE; |
4084 | 0 | } |
4085 | | |
4086 | | |
4087 | | |
4088 | | /************************************************* |
4089 | | * Complete a callout item * |
4090 | | *************************************************/ |
4091 | | |
4092 | | /* A callout item contains the length of the next item in the pattern, which |
4093 | | we can't fill in till after we have reached the relevant point. This is used |
4094 | | for both automatic and manual callouts. |
4095 | | |
4096 | | Arguments: |
4097 | | previous_callout points to previous callout item |
4098 | | ptr current pattern pointer |
4099 | | cd pointers to tables etc |
4100 | | |
4101 | | Returns: nothing |
4102 | | */ |
4103 | | |
4104 | | static void |
4105 | | complete_callout(pcre_uchar *previous_callout, const pcre_uchar *ptr, compile_data *cd) |
4106 | 0 | { |
4107 | 0 | int length = (int)(ptr - cd->start_pattern - GET(previous_callout, 2)); |
4108 | 0 | PUT(previous_callout, 2 + LINK_SIZE, length); |
4109 | 0 | } |
4110 | | |
4111 | | |
4112 | | |
4113 | | #ifdef SUPPORT_UCP |
4114 | | /************************************************* |
4115 | | * Get othercase range * |
4116 | | *************************************************/ |
4117 | | |
4118 | | /* This function is passed the start and end of a class range, in UTF-8 mode |
4119 | | with UCP support. It searches up the characters, looking for ranges of |
4120 | | characters in the "other" case. Each call returns the next one, updating the |
4121 | | start address. A character with multiple other cases is returned on its own |
4122 | | with a special return value. |
4123 | | |
4124 | | Arguments: |
4125 | | cptr points to starting character value; updated |
4126 | | d end value |
4127 | | ocptr where to put start of othercase range |
4128 | | odptr where to put end of othercase range |
4129 | | |
4130 | | Yield: -1 when no more |
4131 | | 0 when a range is returned |
4132 | | >0 the CASESET offset for char with multiple other cases |
4133 | | in this case, ocptr contains the original |
4134 | | */ |
4135 | | |
4136 | | static int |
4137 | | get_othercase_range(pcre_uint32 *cptr, pcre_uint32 d, pcre_uint32 *ocptr, |
4138 | | pcre_uint32 *odptr) |
4139 | | { |
4140 | | pcre_uint32 c, othercase, next; |
4141 | | unsigned int co; |
4142 | | |
4143 | | /* Find the first character that has an other case. If it has multiple other |
4144 | | cases, return its case offset value. */ |
4145 | | |
4146 | | for (c = *cptr; c <= d; c++) |
4147 | | { |
4148 | | if ((co = UCD_CASESET(c)) != 0) |
4149 | | { |
4150 | | *ocptr = c++; /* Character that has the set */ |
4151 | | *cptr = c; /* Rest of input range */ |
4152 | | return (int)co; |
4153 | | } |
4154 | | if ((othercase = UCD_OTHERCASE(c)) != c) break; |
4155 | | } |
4156 | | |
4157 | | if (c > d) return -1; /* Reached end of range */ |
4158 | | |
4159 | | /* Found a character that has a single other case. Search for the end of the |
4160 | | range, which is either the end of the input range, or a character that has zero |
4161 | | or more than one other cases. */ |
4162 | | |
4163 | | *ocptr = othercase; |
4164 | | next = othercase + 1; |
4165 | | |
4166 | | for (++c; c <= d; c++) |
4167 | | { |
4168 | | if ((co = UCD_CASESET(c)) != 0 || UCD_OTHERCASE(c) != next) break; |
4169 | | next++; |
4170 | | } |
4171 | | |
4172 | | *odptr = next - 1; /* End of othercase range */ |
4173 | | *cptr = c; /* Rest of input range */ |
4174 | | return 0; |
4175 | | } |
4176 | | #endif /* SUPPORT_UCP */ |
4177 | | |
4178 | | |
4179 | | |
4180 | | /************************************************* |
4181 | | * Add a character or range to a class * |
4182 | | *************************************************/ |
4183 | | |
4184 | | /* This function packages up the logic of adding a character or range of |
4185 | | characters to a class. The character values in the arguments will be within the |
4186 | | valid values for the current mode (8-bit, 16-bit, UTF, etc). This function is |
4187 | | mutually recursive with the function immediately below. |
4188 | | |
4189 | | Arguments: |
4190 | | classbits the bit map for characters < 256 |
4191 | | uchardptr points to the pointer for extra data |
4192 | | options the options word |
4193 | | cd contains pointers to tables etc. |
4194 | | start start of range character |
4195 | | end end of range character |
4196 | | |
4197 | | Returns: the number of < 256 characters added |
4198 | | the pointer to extra data is updated |
4199 | | */ |
4200 | | |
4201 | | static int |
4202 | | add_to_class(pcre_uint8 *classbits, pcre_uchar **uchardptr, int options, |
4203 | | compile_data *cd, pcre_uint32 start, pcre_uint32 end) |
4204 | 0 | { |
4205 | 0 | pcre_uint32 c; |
4206 | 0 | pcre_uint32 classbits_end = (end <= 0xff ? end : 0xff); |
4207 | 0 | int n8 = 0; |
4208 | |
|
4209 | 0 | ((void)uchardptr); |
4210 | 0 | ((void)propposstab); |
4211 | 0 | ((void)catposstab); |
4212 | 0 | ((void)posspropstab); |
4213 | | |
4214 | | /* If caseless matching is required, scan the range and process alternate |
4215 | | cases. In Unicode, there are 8-bit characters that have alternate cases that |
4216 | | are greater than 255 and vice-versa. Sometimes we can just extend the original |
4217 | | range. */ |
4218 | |
|
4219 | 0 | if ((options & PCRE_CASELESS) != 0) |
4220 | 0 | { |
4221 | | #ifdef SUPPORT_UCP |
4222 | | if ((options & PCRE_UTF8) != 0) |
4223 | | { |
4224 | | int rc; |
4225 | | pcre_uint32 oc, od; |
4226 | | |
4227 | | options &= ~PCRE_CASELESS; /* Remove for recursive calls */ |
4228 | | c = start; |
4229 | | |
4230 | | while ((rc = get_othercase_range(&c, end, &oc, &od)) >= 0) |
4231 | | { |
4232 | | /* Handle a single character that has more than one other case. */ |
4233 | | |
4234 | | if (rc > 0) n8 += add_list_to_class(classbits, uchardptr, options, cd, |
4235 | | PRIV(ucd_caseless_sets) + rc, oc); |
4236 | | |
4237 | | /* Do nothing if the other case range is within the original range. */ |
4238 | | |
4239 | | else if (oc >= start && od <= end) continue; |
4240 | | |
4241 | | /* Extend the original range if there is overlap, noting that if oc < c, we |
4242 | | can't have od > end because a subrange is always shorter than the basic |
4243 | | range. Otherwise, use a recursive call to add the additional range. */ |
4244 | | |
4245 | | else if (oc < start && od >= start - 1) start = oc; /* Extend downwards */ |
4246 | | else if (od > end && oc <= end + 1) |
4247 | | { |
4248 | | end = od; /* Extend upwards */ |
4249 | | if (end > classbits_end) classbits_end = (end <= 0xff ? end : 0xff); |
4250 | | } |
4251 | | else n8 += add_to_class(classbits, uchardptr, options, cd, oc, od); |
4252 | | } |
4253 | | } |
4254 | | else |
4255 | | #endif /* SUPPORT_UCP */ |
4256 | | |
4257 | | /* Not UTF-mode, or no UCP */ |
4258 | |
|
4259 | 0 | for (c = start; c <= classbits_end; c++) |
4260 | 0 | { |
4261 | 0 | SETBIT(classbits, cd->fcc[c]); |
4262 | 0 | n8++; |
4263 | 0 | } |
4264 | 0 | } |
4265 | | |
4266 | | /* Now handle the original range. Adjust the final value according to the bit |
4267 | | length - this means that the same lists of (e.g.) horizontal spaces can be used |
4268 | | in all cases. */ |
4269 | |
|
4270 | 0 | #if defined COMPILE_PCRE8 |
4271 | | #ifdef SUPPORT_UTF |
4272 | | if ((options & PCRE_UTF8) == 0) |
4273 | | #endif |
4274 | 0 | if (end > 0xff) end = 0xff; |
4275 | |
|
4276 | | #elif defined COMPILE_PCRE16 |
4277 | | #ifdef SUPPORT_UTF |
4278 | | if ((options & PCRE_UTF16) == 0) |
4279 | | #endif |
4280 | | if (end > 0xffff) end = 0xffff; |
4281 | | |
4282 | | #endif /* COMPILE_PCRE[8|16] */ |
4283 | | |
4284 | | /* Use the bitmap for characters < 256. Otherwise use extra data.*/ |
4285 | |
|
4286 | 0 | for (c = start; c <= classbits_end; c++) |
4287 | 0 | { |
4288 | | /* Regardless of start, c will always be <= 255. */ |
4289 | 0 | SETBIT(classbits, c); |
4290 | 0 | n8++; |
4291 | 0 | } |
4292 | |
|
4293 | | #if defined SUPPORT_UTF || !defined COMPILE_PCRE8 |
4294 | | if (start <= 0xff) start = 0xff + 1; |
4295 | | |
4296 | | if (end >= start) |
4297 | | { |
4298 | | pcre_uchar *uchardata = *uchardptr; |
4299 | | #ifdef SUPPORT_UTF |
4300 | | if ((options & PCRE_UTF8) != 0) /* All UTFs use the same flag bit */ |
4301 | | { |
4302 | | if (start < end) |
4303 | | { |
4304 | | *uchardata++ = XCL_RANGE; |
4305 | | uchardata += PRIV(ord2utf)(start, uchardata); |
4306 | | uchardata += PRIV(ord2utf)(end, uchardata); |
4307 | | } |
4308 | | else if (start == end) |
4309 | | { |
4310 | | *uchardata++ = XCL_SINGLE; |
4311 | | uchardata += PRIV(ord2utf)(start, uchardata); |
4312 | | } |
4313 | | } |
4314 | | else |
4315 | | #endif /* SUPPORT_UTF */ |
4316 | | |
4317 | | /* Without UTF support, character values are constrained by the bit length, |
4318 | | and can only be > 256 for 16-bit and 32-bit libraries. */ |
4319 | | |
4320 | | #ifdef COMPILE_PCRE8 |
4321 | | {} |
4322 | | #else |
4323 | | if (start < end) |
4324 | | { |
4325 | | *uchardata++ = XCL_RANGE; |
4326 | | *uchardata++ = start; |
4327 | | *uchardata++ = end; |
4328 | | } |
4329 | | else if (start == end) |
4330 | | { |
4331 | | *uchardata++ = XCL_SINGLE; |
4332 | | *uchardata++ = start; |
4333 | | } |
4334 | | #endif |
4335 | | |
4336 | | *uchardptr = uchardata; /* Updata extra data pointer */ |
4337 | | } |
4338 | | #endif /* SUPPORT_UTF || !COMPILE_PCRE8 */ |
4339 | |
|
4340 | 0 | return n8; /* Number of 8-bit characters */ |
4341 | 0 | } |
4342 | | |
4343 | | |
4344 | | |
4345 | | |
4346 | | /************************************************* |
4347 | | * Add a list of characters to a class * |
4348 | | *************************************************/ |
4349 | | |
4350 | | /* This function is used for adding a list of case-equivalent characters to a |
4351 | | class, and also for adding a list of horizontal or vertical whitespace. If the |
4352 | | list is in order (which it should be), ranges of characters are detected and |
4353 | | handled appropriately. This function is mutually recursive with the function |
4354 | | above. |
4355 | | |
4356 | | Arguments: |
4357 | | classbits the bit map for characters < 256 |
4358 | | uchardptr points to the pointer for extra data |
4359 | | options the options word |
4360 | | cd contains pointers to tables etc. |
4361 | | p points to row of 32-bit values, terminated by NOTACHAR |
4362 | | except character to omit; this is used when adding lists of |
4363 | | case-equivalent characters to avoid including the one we |
4364 | | already know about |
4365 | | |
4366 | | Returns: the number of < 256 characters added |
4367 | | the pointer to extra data is updated |
4368 | | */ |
4369 | | |
4370 | | static int |
4371 | | add_list_to_class(pcre_uint8 *classbits, pcre_uchar **uchardptr, int options, |
4372 | | compile_data *cd, const pcre_uint32 *p, unsigned int except) |
4373 | 0 | { |
4374 | 0 | int n8 = 0; |
4375 | 0 | while (p[0] < NOTACHAR) |
4376 | 0 | { |
4377 | 0 | int n = 0; |
4378 | 0 | if (p[0] != except) |
4379 | 0 | { |
4380 | 0 | while(p[n+1] == p[0] + n + 1) n++; |
4381 | 0 | n8 += add_to_class(classbits, uchardptr, options, cd, p[0], p[n]); |
4382 | 0 | } |
4383 | 0 | p += n + 1; |
4384 | 0 | } |
4385 | 0 | return n8; |
4386 | 0 | } |
4387 | | |
4388 | | |
4389 | | |
4390 | | /************************************************* |
4391 | | * Add characters not in a list to a class * |
4392 | | *************************************************/ |
4393 | | |
4394 | | /* This function is used for adding the complement of a list of horizontal or |
4395 | | vertical whitespace to a class. The list must be in order. |
4396 | | |
4397 | | Arguments: |
4398 | | classbits the bit map for characters < 256 |
4399 | | uchardptr points to the pointer for extra data |
4400 | | options the options word |
4401 | | cd contains pointers to tables etc. |
4402 | | p points to row of 32-bit values, terminated by NOTACHAR |
4403 | | |
4404 | | Returns: the number of < 256 characters added |
4405 | | the pointer to extra data is updated |
4406 | | */ |
4407 | | |
4408 | | static int |
4409 | | add_not_list_to_class(pcre_uint8 *classbits, pcre_uchar **uchardptr, |
4410 | | int options, compile_data *cd, const pcre_uint32 *p) |
4411 | 0 | { |
4412 | 0 | BOOL utf = (options & PCRE_UTF8) != 0; |
4413 | 0 | int n8 = 0; |
4414 | 0 | if (p[0] > 0) |
4415 | 0 | n8 += add_to_class(classbits, uchardptr, options, cd, 0, p[0] - 1); |
4416 | 0 | while (p[0] < NOTACHAR) |
4417 | 0 | { |
4418 | 0 | while (p[1] == p[0] + 1) p++; |
4419 | 0 | n8 += add_to_class(classbits, uchardptr, options, cd, p[0] + 1, |
4420 | 0 | (p[1] == NOTACHAR) ? (utf ? 0x10ffffu : 0xffffffffu) : p[1] - 1); |
4421 | 0 | p++; |
4422 | 0 | } |
4423 | 0 | return n8; |
4424 | 0 | } |
4425 | | |
4426 | | |
4427 | | |
4428 | | /************************************************* |
4429 | | * Compile one branch * |
4430 | | *************************************************/ |
4431 | | |
4432 | | /* Scan the pattern, compiling it into the a vector. If the options are |
4433 | | changed during the branch, the pointer is used to change the external options |
4434 | | bits. This function is used during the pre-compile phase when we are trying |
4435 | | to find out the amount of memory needed, as well as during the real compile |
4436 | | phase. The value of lengthptr distinguishes the two phases. |
4437 | | |
4438 | | Arguments: |
4439 | | optionsptr pointer to the option bits |
4440 | | codeptr points to the pointer to the current code point |
4441 | | ptrptr points to the current pattern pointer |
4442 | | errorcodeptr points to error code variable |
4443 | | firstcharptr place to put the first required character |
4444 | | firstcharflagsptr place to put the first character flags, or a negative number |
4445 | | reqcharptr place to put the last required character |
4446 | | reqcharflagsptr place to put the last required character flags, or a negative number |
4447 | | bcptr points to current branch chain |
4448 | | cond_depth conditional nesting depth |
4449 | | cd contains pointers to tables etc. |
4450 | | lengthptr NULL during the real compile phase |
4451 | | points to length accumulator during pre-compile phase |
4452 | | |
4453 | | Returns: TRUE on success |
4454 | | FALSE, with *errorcodeptr set non-zero on error |
4455 | | */ |
4456 | | |
4457 | | static BOOL |
4458 | | compile_branch(int *optionsptr, pcre_uchar **codeptr, |
4459 | | const pcre_uchar **ptrptr, int *errorcodeptr, |
4460 | | pcre_uint32 *firstcharptr, pcre_int32 *firstcharflagsptr, |
4461 | | pcre_uint32 *reqcharptr, pcre_int32 *reqcharflagsptr, |
4462 | | branch_chain *bcptr, int cond_depth, |
4463 | | compile_data *cd, int *lengthptr) |
4464 | 0 | { |
4465 | 0 | int repeat_type, op_type; |
4466 | 0 | int repeat_min = 0, repeat_max = 0; /* To please picky compilers */ |
4467 | 0 | int bravalue = 0; |
4468 | 0 | int greedy_default, greedy_non_default; |
4469 | 0 | pcre_uint32 firstchar, reqchar; |
4470 | 0 | pcre_int32 firstcharflags, reqcharflags; |
4471 | 0 | pcre_uint32 zeroreqchar, zerofirstchar; |
4472 | 0 | pcre_int32 zeroreqcharflags, zerofirstcharflags; |
4473 | 0 | pcre_int32 req_caseopt, reqvary, tempreqvary; |
4474 | 0 | int options = *optionsptr; /* May change dynamically */ |
4475 | 0 | int after_manual_callout = 0; |
4476 | 0 | int length_prevgroup = 0; |
4477 | 0 | register pcre_uint32 c; |
4478 | 0 | int escape; |
4479 | 0 | register pcre_uchar *code = *codeptr; |
4480 | 0 | pcre_uchar *last_code = code; |
4481 | 0 | pcre_uchar *orig_code = code; |
4482 | 0 | pcre_uchar *tempcode; |
4483 | 0 | BOOL inescq = FALSE; |
4484 | 0 | BOOL groupsetfirstchar = FALSE; |
4485 | 0 | const pcre_uchar *ptr = *ptrptr; |
4486 | 0 | const pcre_uchar *tempptr; |
4487 | 0 | const pcre_uchar *nestptr = NULL; |
4488 | 0 | pcre_uchar *previous = NULL; |
4489 | 0 | pcre_uchar *previous_callout = NULL; |
4490 | 0 | size_t item_hwm_offset = 0; |
4491 | 0 | pcre_uint8 classbits[32]; |
4492 | | |
4493 | | /* We can fish out the UTF-8 setting once and for all into a BOOL, but we |
4494 | | must not do this for other options (e.g. PCRE_EXTENDED) because they may change |
4495 | | dynamically as we process the pattern. */ |
4496 | |
|
4497 | | #ifdef SUPPORT_UTF |
4498 | | /* PCRE_UTF[16|32] have the same value as PCRE_UTF8. */ |
4499 | | BOOL utf = (options & PCRE_UTF8) != 0; |
4500 | | #ifndef COMPILE_PCRE32 |
4501 | | pcre_uchar utf_chars[6]; |
4502 | | #endif |
4503 | | #else |
4504 | 0 | BOOL utf = FALSE; |
4505 | 0 | #endif |
4506 | | |
4507 | | /* Helper variables for OP_XCLASS opcode (for characters > 255). We define |
4508 | | class_uchardata always so that it can be passed to add_to_class() always, |
4509 | | though it will not be used in non-UTF 8-bit cases. This avoids having to supply |
4510 | | alternative calls for the different cases. */ |
4511 | |
|
4512 | 0 | pcre_uchar *class_uchardata; |
4513 | | #if defined SUPPORT_UTF || !defined COMPILE_PCRE8 |
4514 | | BOOL xclass; |
4515 | | pcre_uchar *class_uchardata_base; |
4516 | | #endif |
4517 | |
|
4518 | | #ifdef PCRE_DEBUG |
4519 | | if (lengthptr != NULL) DPRINTF((">> start branch\n")); |
4520 | | #endif |
4521 | | |
4522 | | /* Set up the default and non-default settings for greediness */ |
4523 | |
|
4524 | 0 | greedy_default = ((options & PCRE_UNGREEDY) != 0); |
4525 | 0 | greedy_non_default = greedy_default ^ 1; |
4526 | | |
4527 | | /* Initialize no first byte, no required byte. REQ_UNSET means "no char |
4528 | | matching encountered yet". It gets changed to REQ_NONE if we hit something that |
4529 | | matches a non-fixed char first char; reqchar just remains unset if we never |
4530 | | find one. |
4531 | | |
4532 | | When we hit a repeat whose minimum is zero, we may have to adjust these values |
4533 | | to take the zero repeat into account. This is implemented by setting them to |
4534 | | zerofirstbyte and zeroreqchar when such a repeat is encountered. The individual |
4535 | | item types that can be repeated set these backoff variables appropriately. */ |
4536 | |
|
4537 | 0 | firstchar = reqchar = zerofirstchar = zeroreqchar = 0; |
4538 | 0 | firstcharflags = reqcharflags = zerofirstcharflags = zeroreqcharflags = REQ_UNSET; |
4539 | | |
4540 | | /* The variable req_caseopt contains either the REQ_CASELESS value |
4541 | | or zero, according to the current setting of the caseless flag. The |
4542 | | REQ_CASELESS leaves the lower 28 bit empty. It is added into the |
4543 | | firstchar or reqchar variables to record the case status of the |
4544 | | value. This is used only for ASCII characters. */ |
4545 | |
|
4546 | 0 | req_caseopt = ((options & PCRE_CASELESS) != 0)? REQ_CASELESS:0; |
4547 | | |
4548 | | /* Switch on next character until the end of the branch */ |
4549 | |
|
4550 | 0 | for (;; ptr++) |
4551 | 0 | { |
4552 | 0 | BOOL negate_class; |
4553 | 0 | BOOL should_flip_negation; |
4554 | 0 | BOOL possessive_quantifier; |
4555 | 0 | BOOL is_quantifier; |
4556 | 0 | BOOL is_recurse; |
4557 | 0 | BOOL reset_bracount; |
4558 | 0 | int class_has_8bitchar; |
4559 | 0 | int class_one_char; |
4560 | | #if defined SUPPORT_UTF || !defined COMPILE_PCRE8 |
4561 | | BOOL xclass_has_prop; |
4562 | | #endif |
4563 | 0 | int newoptions; |
4564 | 0 | int recno; |
4565 | 0 | int refsign; |
4566 | 0 | int skipbytes; |
4567 | 0 | pcre_uint32 subreqchar, subfirstchar; |
4568 | 0 | pcre_int32 subreqcharflags, subfirstcharflags; |
4569 | 0 | int terminator; |
4570 | 0 | unsigned int mclength; |
4571 | 0 | unsigned int tempbracount; |
4572 | 0 | pcre_uint32 ec; |
4573 | 0 | pcre_uchar mcbuffer[8]; |
4574 | | |
4575 | | /* Come here to restart the loop without advancing the pointer. */ |
4576 | |
|
4577 | 0 | REDO_LOOP: |
4578 | | |
4579 | | /* Get next character in the pattern */ |
4580 | |
|
4581 | 0 | c = *ptr; |
4582 | | |
4583 | | /* If we are at the end of a nested substitution, revert to the outer level |
4584 | | string. Nesting only happens one level deep. */ |
4585 | |
|
4586 | 0 | if (c == CHAR_NULL && nestptr != NULL) |
4587 | 0 | { |
4588 | 0 | ptr = nestptr; |
4589 | 0 | nestptr = NULL; |
4590 | 0 | c = *ptr; |
4591 | 0 | } |
4592 | | |
4593 | | /* If we are in the pre-compile phase, accumulate the length used for the |
4594 | | previous cycle of this loop. */ |
4595 | |
|
4596 | 0 | if (lengthptr != NULL) |
4597 | 0 | { |
4598 | | #ifdef PCRE_DEBUG |
4599 | | if (code > cd->hwm) cd->hwm = code; /* High water info */ |
4600 | | #endif |
4601 | 0 | if (code > cd->start_workspace + cd->workspace_size - |
4602 | 0 | WORK_SIZE_SAFETY_MARGIN) /* Check for overrun */ |
4603 | 0 | { |
4604 | 0 | *errorcodeptr = (code >= cd->start_workspace + cd->workspace_size)? |
4605 | 0 | ERR52 : ERR87; |
4606 | 0 | goto FAILED; |
4607 | 0 | } |
4608 | | |
4609 | | /* There is at least one situation where code goes backwards: this is the |
4610 | | case of a zero quantifier after a class (e.g. [ab]{0}). At compile time, |
4611 | | the class is simply eliminated. However, it is created first, so we have to |
4612 | | allow memory for it. Therefore, don't ever reduce the length at this point. |
4613 | | */ |
4614 | | |
4615 | 0 | if (code < last_code) code = last_code; |
4616 | | |
4617 | | /* Paranoid check for integer overflow */ |
4618 | |
|
4619 | 0 | if (OFLOW_MAX - *lengthptr < code - last_code) |
4620 | 0 | { |
4621 | 0 | *errorcodeptr = ERR20; |
4622 | 0 | goto FAILED; |
4623 | 0 | } |
4624 | | |
4625 | 0 | *lengthptr += (int)(code - last_code); |
4626 | 0 | DPRINTF(("length=%d added %d c=%c (0x%x)\n", *lengthptr, |
4627 | 0 | (int)(code - last_code), c, c)); |
4628 | | |
4629 | | /* If "previous" is set and it is not at the start of the work space, move |
4630 | | it back to there, in order to avoid filling up the work space. Otherwise, |
4631 | | if "previous" is NULL, reset the current code pointer to the start. */ |
4632 | |
|
4633 | 0 | if (previous != NULL) |
4634 | 0 | { |
4635 | 0 | if (previous > orig_code) |
4636 | 0 | { |
4637 | 0 | memmove(orig_code, previous, IN_UCHARS(code - previous)); |
4638 | 0 | code -= previous - orig_code; |
4639 | 0 | previous = orig_code; |
4640 | 0 | } |
4641 | 0 | } |
4642 | 0 | else code = orig_code; |
4643 | | |
4644 | | /* Remember where this code item starts so we can pick up the length |
4645 | | next time round. */ |
4646 | |
|
4647 | 0 | last_code = code; |
4648 | 0 | } |
4649 | | |
4650 | | /* In the real compile phase, just check the workspace used by the forward |
4651 | | reference list. */ |
4652 | | |
4653 | 0 | else if (cd->hwm > cd->start_workspace + cd->workspace_size) |
4654 | 0 | { |
4655 | 0 | *errorcodeptr = ERR52; |
4656 | 0 | goto FAILED; |
4657 | 0 | } |
4658 | | |
4659 | | /* If in \Q...\E, check for the end; if not, we have a literal. Otherwise an |
4660 | | isolated \E is ignored. */ |
4661 | | |
4662 | 0 | if (c != CHAR_NULL) |
4663 | 0 | { |
4664 | 0 | if (c == CHAR_BACKSLASH && ptr[1] == CHAR_E) |
4665 | 0 | { |
4666 | 0 | inescq = FALSE; |
4667 | 0 | ptr++; |
4668 | 0 | continue; |
4669 | 0 | } |
4670 | 0 | else if (inescq) |
4671 | 0 | { |
4672 | 0 | if (previous_callout != NULL) |
4673 | 0 | { |
4674 | 0 | if (lengthptr == NULL) /* Don't attempt in pre-compile phase */ |
4675 | 0 | complete_callout(previous_callout, ptr, cd); |
4676 | 0 | previous_callout = NULL; |
4677 | 0 | } |
4678 | 0 | if ((options & PCRE_AUTO_CALLOUT) != 0) |
4679 | 0 | { |
4680 | 0 | previous_callout = code; |
4681 | 0 | code = auto_callout(code, ptr, cd); |
4682 | 0 | } |
4683 | 0 | goto NORMAL_CHAR; |
4684 | 0 | } |
4685 | | |
4686 | | /* Check for the start of a \Q...\E sequence. We must do this here rather |
4687 | | than later in case it is immediately followed by \E, which turns it into a |
4688 | | "do nothing" sequence. */ |
4689 | | |
4690 | 0 | if (c == CHAR_BACKSLASH && ptr[1] == CHAR_Q) |
4691 | 0 | { |
4692 | 0 | inescq = TRUE; |
4693 | 0 | ptr++; |
4694 | 0 | continue; |
4695 | 0 | } |
4696 | 0 | } |
4697 | | |
4698 | | /* In extended mode, skip white space and comments. */ |
4699 | | |
4700 | 0 | if ((options & PCRE_EXTENDED) != 0) |
4701 | 0 | { |
4702 | 0 | const pcre_uchar *wscptr = ptr; |
4703 | 0 | while (MAX_255(c) && (cd->ctypes[c] & ctype_space) != 0) c = *(++ptr); |
4704 | 0 | if (c == CHAR_NUMBER_SIGN) |
4705 | 0 | { |
4706 | 0 | ptr++; |
4707 | 0 | while (*ptr != CHAR_NULL) |
4708 | 0 | { |
4709 | 0 | if (IS_NEWLINE(ptr)) /* For non-fixed-length newline cases, */ |
4710 | 0 | { /* IS_NEWLINE sets cd->nllen. */ |
4711 | 0 | ptr += cd->nllen; |
4712 | 0 | break; |
4713 | 0 | } |
4714 | 0 | ptr++; |
4715 | | #ifdef SUPPORT_UTF |
4716 | | if (utf) FORWARDCHAR(ptr); |
4717 | | #endif |
4718 | 0 | } |
4719 | 0 | } |
4720 | | |
4721 | | /* If we skipped any characters, restart the loop. Otherwise, we didn't see |
4722 | | a comment. */ |
4723 | |
|
4724 | 0 | if (ptr > wscptr) goto REDO_LOOP; |
4725 | 0 | } |
4726 | | |
4727 | | /* Skip over (?# comments. We need to do this here because we want to know if |
4728 | | the next thing is a quantifier, and these comments may come between an item |
4729 | | and its quantifier. */ |
4730 | | |
4731 | 0 | if (c == CHAR_LEFT_PARENTHESIS && ptr[1] == CHAR_QUESTION_MARK && |
4732 | 0 | ptr[2] == CHAR_NUMBER_SIGN) |
4733 | 0 | { |
4734 | 0 | ptr += 3; |
4735 | 0 | while (*ptr != CHAR_NULL && *ptr != CHAR_RIGHT_PARENTHESIS) ptr++; |
4736 | 0 | if (*ptr == CHAR_NULL) |
4737 | 0 | { |
4738 | 0 | *errorcodeptr = ERR18; |
4739 | 0 | goto FAILED; |
4740 | 0 | } |
4741 | 0 | continue; |
4742 | 0 | } |
4743 | | |
4744 | | /* See if the next thing is a quantifier. */ |
4745 | | |
4746 | 0 | is_quantifier = |
4747 | 0 | c == CHAR_ASTERISK || c == CHAR_PLUS || c == CHAR_QUESTION_MARK || |
4748 | 0 | (c == CHAR_LEFT_CURLY_BRACKET && is_counted_repeat(ptr+1)); |
4749 | | |
4750 | | /* Fill in length of a previous callout, except when the next thing is a |
4751 | | quantifier or when processing a property substitution string in UCP mode. */ |
4752 | |
|
4753 | 0 | if (!is_quantifier && previous_callout != NULL && nestptr == NULL && |
4754 | 0 | after_manual_callout-- <= 0) |
4755 | 0 | { |
4756 | 0 | if (lengthptr == NULL) /* Don't attempt in pre-compile phase */ |
4757 | 0 | complete_callout(previous_callout, ptr, cd); |
4758 | 0 | previous_callout = NULL; |
4759 | 0 | } |
4760 | | |
4761 | | /* Create auto callout, except for quantifiers, or while processing property |
4762 | | strings that are substituted for \w etc in UCP mode. */ |
4763 | |
|
4764 | 0 | if ((options & PCRE_AUTO_CALLOUT) != 0 && !is_quantifier && nestptr == NULL) |
4765 | 0 | { |
4766 | 0 | previous_callout = code; |
4767 | 0 | code = auto_callout(code, ptr, cd); |
4768 | 0 | } |
4769 | | |
4770 | | /* Process the next pattern item. */ |
4771 | |
|
4772 | 0 | switch(c) |
4773 | 0 | { |
4774 | | /* ===================================================================*/ |
4775 | 0 | case CHAR_NULL: /* The branch terminates at string end */ |
4776 | 0 | case CHAR_VERTICAL_LINE: /* or | or ) */ |
4777 | 0 | case CHAR_RIGHT_PARENTHESIS: |
4778 | 0 | *firstcharptr = firstchar; |
4779 | 0 | *firstcharflagsptr = firstcharflags; |
4780 | 0 | *reqcharptr = reqchar; |
4781 | 0 | *reqcharflagsptr = reqcharflags; |
4782 | 0 | *codeptr = code; |
4783 | 0 | *ptrptr = ptr; |
4784 | 0 | if (lengthptr != NULL) |
4785 | 0 | { |
4786 | 0 | if (OFLOW_MAX - *lengthptr < code - last_code) |
4787 | 0 | { |
4788 | 0 | *errorcodeptr = ERR20; |
4789 | 0 | goto FAILED; |
4790 | 0 | } |
4791 | 0 | *lengthptr += (int)(code - last_code); /* To include callout length */ |
4792 | 0 | DPRINTF((">> end branch\n")); |
4793 | 0 | } |
4794 | 0 | return TRUE; |
4795 | | |
4796 | | |
4797 | | /* ===================================================================*/ |
4798 | | /* Handle single-character metacharacters. In multiline mode, ^ disables |
4799 | | the setting of any following char as a first character. */ |
4800 | | |
4801 | 0 | case CHAR_CIRCUMFLEX_ACCENT: |
4802 | 0 | previous = NULL; |
4803 | 0 | if ((options & PCRE_MULTILINE) != 0) |
4804 | 0 | { |
4805 | 0 | if (firstcharflags == REQ_UNSET) |
4806 | 0 | zerofirstcharflags = firstcharflags = REQ_NONE; |
4807 | 0 | *code++ = OP_CIRCM; |
4808 | 0 | } |
4809 | 0 | else *code++ = OP_CIRC; |
4810 | 0 | break; |
4811 | | |
4812 | 0 | case CHAR_DOLLAR_SIGN: |
4813 | 0 | previous = NULL; |
4814 | 0 | *code++ = ((options & PCRE_MULTILINE) != 0)? OP_DOLLM : OP_DOLL; |
4815 | 0 | break; |
4816 | | |
4817 | | /* There can never be a first char if '.' is first, whatever happens about |
4818 | | repeats. The value of reqchar doesn't change either. */ |
4819 | | |
4820 | 0 | case CHAR_DOT: |
4821 | 0 | if (firstcharflags == REQ_UNSET) firstcharflags = REQ_NONE; |
4822 | 0 | zerofirstchar = firstchar; |
4823 | 0 | zerofirstcharflags = firstcharflags; |
4824 | 0 | zeroreqchar = reqchar; |
4825 | 0 | zeroreqcharflags = reqcharflags; |
4826 | 0 | previous = code; |
4827 | 0 | item_hwm_offset = cd->hwm - cd->start_workspace; |
4828 | 0 | *code++ = ((options & PCRE_DOTALL) != 0)? OP_ALLANY: OP_ANY; |
4829 | 0 | break; |
4830 | | |
4831 | | |
4832 | | /* ===================================================================*/ |
4833 | | /* Character classes. If the included characters are all < 256, we build a |
4834 | | 32-byte bitmap of the permitted characters, except in the special case |
4835 | | where there is only one such character. For negated classes, we build the |
4836 | | map as usual, then invert it at the end. However, we use a different opcode |
4837 | | so that data characters > 255 can be handled correctly. |
4838 | | |
4839 | | If the class contains characters outside the 0-255 range, a different |
4840 | | opcode is compiled. It may optionally have a bit map for characters < 256, |
4841 | | but those above are are explicitly listed afterwards. A flag byte tells |
4842 | | whether the bitmap is present, and whether this is a negated class or not. |
4843 | | |
4844 | | In JavaScript compatibility mode, an isolated ']' causes an error. In |
4845 | | default (Perl) mode, it is treated as a data character. */ |
4846 | | |
4847 | 0 | case CHAR_RIGHT_SQUARE_BRACKET: |
4848 | 0 | if ((cd->external_options & PCRE_JAVASCRIPT_COMPAT) != 0) |
4849 | 0 | { |
4850 | 0 | *errorcodeptr = ERR64; |
4851 | 0 | goto FAILED; |
4852 | 0 | } |
4853 | 0 | goto NORMAL_CHAR; |
4854 | | |
4855 | | /* In another (POSIX) regex library, the ugly syntax [[:<:]] and [[:>:]] is |
4856 | | used for "start of word" and "end of word". As these are otherwise illegal |
4857 | | sequences, we don't break anything by recognizing them. They are replaced |
4858 | | by \b(?=\w) and \b(?<=\w) respectively. Sequences like [a[:<:]] are |
4859 | | erroneous and are handled by the normal code below. */ |
4860 | | |
4861 | 0 | case CHAR_LEFT_SQUARE_BRACKET: |
4862 | 0 | if (STRNCMP_UC_C8(ptr+1, STRING_WEIRD_STARTWORD, 6) == 0) |
4863 | 0 | { |
4864 | 0 | nestptr = ptr + 7; |
4865 | 0 | ptr = sub_start_of_word; |
4866 | 0 | goto REDO_LOOP; |
4867 | 0 | } |
4868 | | |
4869 | 0 | if (STRNCMP_UC_C8(ptr+1, STRING_WEIRD_ENDWORD, 6) == 0) |
4870 | 0 | { |
4871 | 0 | nestptr = ptr + 7; |
4872 | 0 | ptr = sub_end_of_word; |
4873 | 0 | goto REDO_LOOP; |
4874 | 0 | } |
4875 | | |
4876 | | /* Handle a real character class. */ |
4877 | | |
4878 | 0 | previous = code; |
4879 | 0 | item_hwm_offset = cd->hwm - cd->start_workspace; |
4880 | | |
4881 | | /* PCRE supports POSIX class stuff inside a class. Perl gives an error if |
4882 | | they are encountered at the top level, so we'll do that too. */ |
4883 | |
|
4884 | 0 | if ((ptr[1] == CHAR_COLON || ptr[1] == CHAR_DOT || |
4885 | 0 | ptr[1] == CHAR_EQUALS_SIGN) && |
4886 | 0 | check_posix_syntax(ptr, &tempptr)) |
4887 | 0 | { |
4888 | 0 | *errorcodeptr = (ptr[1] == CHAR_COLON)? ERR13 : ERR31; |
4889 | 0 | goto FAILED; |
4890 | 0 | } |
4891 | | |
4892 | | /* If the first character is '^', set the negation flag and skip it. Also, |
4893 | | if the first few characters (either before or after ^) are \Q\E or \E we |
4894 | | skip them too. This makes for compatibility with Perl. */ |
4895 | | |
4896 | 0 | negate_class = FALSE; |
4897 | 0 | for (;;) |
4898 | 0 | { |
4899 | 0 | c = *(++ptr); |
4900 | 0 | if (c == CHAR_BACKSLASH) |
4901 | 0 | { |
4902 | 0 | if (ptr[1] == CHAR_E) |
4903 | 0 | ptr++; |
4904 | 0 | else if (STRNCMP_UC_C8(ptr + 1, STR_Q STR_BACKSLASH STR_E, 3) == 0) |
4905 | 0 | ptr += 3; |
4906 | 0 | else |
4907 | 0 | break; |
4908 | 0 | } |
4909 | 0 | else if (!negate_class && c == CHAR_CIRCUMFLEX_ACCENT) |
4910 | 0 | negate_class = TRUE; |
4911 | 0 | else break; |
4912 | 0 | } |
4913 | | |
4914 | | /* Empty classes are allowed in JavaScript compatibility mode. Otherwise, |
4915 | | an initial ']' is taken as a data character -- the code below handles |
4916 | | that. In JS mode, [] must always fail, so generate OP_FAIL, whereas |
4917 | | [^] must match any character, so generate OP_ALLANY. */ |
4918 | |
|
4919 | 0 | if (c == CHAR_RIGHT_SQUARE_BRACKET && |
4920 | 0 | (cd->external_options & PCRE_JAVASCRIPT_COMPAT) != 0) |
4921 | 0 | { |
4922 | 0 | *code++ = negate_class? OP_ALLANY : OP_FAIL; |
4923 | 0 | if (firstcharflags == REQ_UNSET) firstcharflags = REQ_NONE; |
4924 | 0 | zerofirstchar = firstchar; |
4925 | 0 | zerofirstcharflags = firstcharflags; |
4926 | 0 | break; |
4927 | 0 | } |
4928 | | |
4929 | | /* If a class contains a negative special such as \S, we need to flip the |
4930 | | negation flag at the end, so that support for characters > 255 works |
4931 | | correctly (they are all included in the class). */ |
4932 | | |
4933 | 0 | should_flip_negation = FALSE; |
4934 | | |
4935 | | /* Extended class (xclass) will be used when characters > 255 |
4936 | | might match. */ |
4937 | |
|
4938 | | #if defined SUPPORT_UTF || !defined COMPILE_PCRE8 |
4939 | | xclass = FALSE; |
4940 | | class_uchardata = code + LINK_SIZE + 2; /* For XCLASS items */ |
4941 | | class_uchardata_base = class_uchardata; /* Save the start */ |
4942 | | #endif |
4943 | | |
4944 | | /* For optimization purposes, we track some properties of the class: |
4945 | | class_has_8bitchar will be non-zero if the class contains at least one < |
4946 | | 256 character; class_one_char will be 1 if the class contains just one |
4947 | | character; xclass_has_prop will be TRUE if unicode property checks |
4948 | | are present in the class. */ |
4949 | |
|
4950 | 0 | class_has_8bitchar = 0; |
4951 | 0 | class_one_char = 0; |
4952 | | #if defined SUPPORT_UTF || !defined COMPILE_PCRE8 |
4953 | | xclass_has_prop = FALSE; |
4954 | | #endif |
4955 | | |
4956 | | /* Initialize the 32-char bit map to all zeros. We build the map in a |
4957 | | temporary bit of memory, in case the class contains fewer than two |
4958 | | 8-bit characters because in that case the compiled code doesn't use the bit |
4959 | | map. */ |
4960 | |
|
4961 | 0 | memset(classbits, 0, 32 * sizeof(pcre_uint8)); |
4962 | | |
4963 | | /* Process characters until ] is reached. By writing this as a "do" it |
4964 | | means that an initial ] is taken as a data character. At the start of the |
4965 | | loop, c contains the first byte of the character. */ |
4966 | |
|
4967 | 0 | if (c != CHAR_NULL) do |
4968 | 0 | { |
4969 | 0 | const pcre_uchar *oldptr; |
4970 | |
|
4971 | | #ifdef SUPPORT_UTF |
4972 | | if (utf && HAS_EXTRALEN(c)) |
4973 | | { /* Braces are required because the */ |
4974 | | GETCHARLEN(c, ptr, ptr); /* macro generates multiple statements */ |
4975 | | } |
4976 | | #endif |
4977 | |
|
4978 | | #if defined SUPPORT_UTF || !defined COMPILE_PCRE8 |
4979 | | /* In the pre-compile phase, accumulate the length of any extra |
4980 | | data and reset the pointer. This is so that very large classes that |
4981 | | contain a zillion > 255 characters no longer overwrite the work space |
4982 | | (which is on the stack). We have to remember that there was XCLASS data, |
4983 | | however. */ |
4984 | | |
4985 | | if (class_uchardata > class_uchardata_base) xclass = TRUE; |
4986 | | |
4987 | | if (lengthptr != NULL && class_uchardata > class_uchardata_base) |
4988 | | { |
4989 | | *lengthptr += (int)(class_uchardata - class_uchardata_base); |
4990 | | class_uchardata = class_uchardata_base; |
4991 | | } |
4992 | | #endif |
4993 | | |
4994 | | /* Inside \Q...\E everything is literal except \E */ |
4995 | |
|
4996 | 0 | if (inescq) |
4997 | 0 | { |
4998 | 0 | if (c == CHAR_BACKSLASH && ptr[1] == CHAR_E) /* If we are at \E */ |
4999 | 0 | { |
5000 | 0 | inescq = FALSE; /* Reset literal state */ |
5001 | 0 | ptr++; /* Skip the 'E' */ |
5002 | 0 | continue; /* Carry on with next */ |
5003 | 0 | } |
5004 | 0 | goto CHECK_RANGE; /* Could be range if \E follows */ |
5005 | 0 | } |
5006 | | |
5007 | | /* Handle POSIX class names. Perl allows a negation extension of the |
5008 | | form [:^name:]. A square bracket that doesn't match the syntax is |
5009 | | treated as a literal. We also recognize the POSIX constructions |
5010 | | [.ch.] and [=ch=] ("collating elements") and fault them, as Perl |
5011 | | 5.6 and 5.8 do. */ |
5012 | | |
5013 | 0 | if (c == CHAR_LEFT_SQUARE_BRACKET && |
5014 | 0 | (ptr[1] == CHAR_COLON || ptr[1] == CHAR_DOT || |
5015 | 0 | ptr[1] == CHAR_EQUALS_SIGN) && check_posix_syntax(ptr, &tempptr)) |
5016 | 0 | { |
5017 | 0 | BOOL local_negate = FALSE; |
5018 | 0 | int posix_class, taboffset, tabopt; |
5019 | 0 | register const pcre_uint8 *cbits = cd->cbits; |
5020 | 0 | pcre_uint8 pbits[32]; |
5021 | |
|
5022 | 0 | if (ptr[1] != CHAR_COLON) |
5023 | 0 | { |
5024 | 0 | *errorcodeptr = ERR31; |
5025 | 0 | goto FAILED; |
5026 | 0 | } |
5027 | | |
5028 | 0 | ptr += 2; |
5029 | 0 | if (*ptr == CHAR_CIRCUMFLEX_ACCENT) |
5030 | 0 | { |
5031 | 0 | local_negate = TRUE; |
5032 | 0 | should_flip_negation = TRUE; /* Note negative special */ |
5033 | 0 | ptr++; |
5034 | 0 | } |
5035 | |
|
5036 | 0 | posix_class = check_posix_name(ptr, (int)(tempptr - ptr)); |
5037 | 0 | if (posix_class < 0) |
5038 | 0 | { |
5039 | 0 | *errorcodeptr = ERR30; |
5040 | 0 | goto FAILED; |
5041 | 0 | } |
5042 | | |
5043 | | /* If matching is caseless, upper and lower are converted to |
5044 | | alpha. This relies on the fact that the class table starts with |
5045 | | alpha, lower, upper as the first 3 entries. */ |
5046 | | |
5047 | 0 | if ((options & PCRE_CASELESS) != 0 && posix_class <= 2) |
5048 | 0 | posix_class = 0; |
5049 | | |
5050 | | /* When PCRE_UCP is set, some of the POSIX classes are converted to |
5051 | | different escape sequences that use Unicode properties \p or \P. Others |
5052 | | that are not available via \p or \P generate XCL_PROP/XCL_NOTPROP |
5053 | | directly. */ |
5054 | |
|
5055 | | #ifdef SUPPORT_UCP |
5056 | | if ((options & PCRE_UCP) != 0) |
5057 | | { |
5058 | | unsigned int ptype = 0; |
5059 | | int pc = posix_class + ((local_negate)? POSIX_SUBSIZE/2 : 0); |
5060 | | |
5061 | | /* The posix_substitutes table specifies which POSIX classes can be |
5062 | | converted to \p or \P items. */ |
5063 | | |
5064 | | if (posix_substitutes[pc] != NULL) |
5065 | | { |
5066 | | nestptr = tempptr + 1; |
5067 | | ptr = posix_substitutes[pc] - 1; |
5068 | | continue; |
5069 | | } |
5070 | | |
5071 | | /* There are three other classes that generate special property calls |
5072 | | that are recognized only in an XCLASS. */ |
5073 | | |
5074 | | else switch(posix_class) |
5075 | | { |
5076 | | case PC_GRAPH: |
5077 | | ptype = PT_PXGRAPH; |
5078 | | /* Fall through */ |
5079 | | case PC_PRINT: |
5080 | | if (ptype == 0) ptype = PT_PXPRINT; |
5081 | | /* Fall through */ |
5082 | | case PC_PUNCT: |
5083 | | if (ptype == 0) ptype = PT_PXPUNCT; |
5084 | | *class_uchardata++ = local_negate? XCL_NOTPROP : XCL_PROP; |
5085 | | *class_uchardata++ = ptype; |
5086 | | *class_uchardata++ = 0; |
5087 | | xclass_has_prop = TRUE; |
5088 | | ptr = tempptr + 1; |
5089 | | continue; |
5090 | | |
5091 | | /* For the other POSIX classes (ascii, cntrl, xdigit) we are going |
5092 | | to fall through to the non-UCP case and build a bit map for |
5093 | | characters with code points less than 256. If we are in a negated |
5094 | | POSIX class, characters with code points greater than 255 must |
5095 | | either all match or all not match. In the special case where we |
5096 | | have not yet generated any xclass data, and this is the final item |
5097 | | in the overall class, we need do nothing: later on, the opcode |
5098 | | OP_NCLASS will be used to indicate that characters greater than 255 |
5099 | | are acceptable. If we have already seen an xclass item or one may |
5100 | | follow (we have to assume that it might if this is not the end of |
5101 | | the class), explicitly list all wide codepoints, which will then |
5102 | | either not match or match, depending on whether the class is or is |
5103 | | not negated. */ |
5104 | | |
5105 | | default: |
5106 | | if (local_negate && |
5107 | | (xclass || tempptr[2] != CHAR_RIGHT_SQUARE_BRACKET)) |
5108 | | { |
5109 | | *class_uchardata++ = XCL_RANGE; |
5110 | | class_uchardata += PRIV(ord2utf)(0x100, class_uchardata); |
5111 | | class_uchardata += PRIV(ord2utf)(0x10ffff, class_uchardata); |
5112 | | } |
5113 | | break; |
5114 | | } |
5115 | | } |
5116 | | #endif |
5117 | | /* In the non-UCP case, or when UCP makes no difference, we build the |
5118 | | bit map for the POSIX class in a chunk of local store because we may be |
5119 | | adding and subtracting from it, and we don't want to subtract bits that |
5120 | | may be in the main map already. At the end we or the result into the |
5121 | | bit map that is being built. */ |
5122 | |
|
5123 | 0 | posix_class *= 3; |
5124 | | |
5125 | | /* Copy in the first table (always present) */ |
5126 | |
|
5127 | 0 | memcpy(pbits, cbits + posix_class_maps[posix_class], |
5128 | 0 | 32 * sizeof(pcre_uint8)); |
5129 | | |
5130 | | /* If there is a second table, add or remove it as required. */ |
5131 | |
|
5132 | 0 | taboffset = posix_class_maps[posix_class + 1]; |
5133 | 0 | tabopt = posix_class_maps[posix_class + 2]; |
5134 | |
|
5135 | 0 | if (taboffset >= 0) |
5136 | 0 | { |
5137 | 0 | if (tabopt >= 0) |
5138 | 0 | for (c = 0; c < 32; c++) pbits[c] |= cbits[c + taboffset]; |
5139 | 0 | else |
5140 | 0 | for (c = 0; c < 32; c++) pbits[c] &= ~cbits[c + taboffset]; |
5141 | 0 | } |
5142 | | |
5143 | | /* Now see if we need to remove any special characters. An option |
5144 | | value of 1 removes vertical space and 2 removes underscore. */ |
5145 | |
|
5146 | 0 | if (tabopt < 0) tabopt = -tabopt; |
5147 | 0 | if (tabopt == 1) pbits[1] &= ~0x3c; |
5148 | 0 | else if (tabopt == 2) pbits[11] &= 0x7f; |
5149 | | |
5150 | | /* Add the POSIX table or its complement into the main table that is |
5151 | | being built and we are done. */ |
5152 | |
|
5153 | 0 | if (local_negate) |
5154 | 0 | for (c = 0; c < 32; c++) classbits[c] |= ~pbits[c]; |
5155 | 0 | else |
5156 | 0 | for (c = 0; c < 32; c++) classbits[c] |= pbits[c]; |
5157 | |
|
5158 | 0 | ptr = tempptr + 1; |
5159 | | /* Every class contains at least one < 256 character. */ |
5160 | 0 | class_has_8bitchar = 1; |
5161 | | /* Every class contains at least two characters. */ |
5162 | 0 | class_one_char = 2; |
5163 | 0 | continue; /* End of POSIX syntax handling */ |
5164 | 0 | } |
5165 | | |
5166 | | /* Backslash may introduce a single character, or it may introduce one |
5167 | | of the specials, which just set a flag. The sequence \b is a special |
5168 | | case. Inside a class (and only there) it is treated as backspace. We |
5169 | | assume that other escapes have more than one character in them, so |
5170 | | speculatively set both class_has_8bitchar and class_one_char bigger |
5171 | | than one. Unrecognized escapes fall through and are either treated |
5172 | | as literal characters (by default), or are faulted if |
5173 | | PCRE_EXTRA is set. */ |
5174 | | |
5175 | 0 | if (c == CHAR_BACKSLASH) |
5176 | 0 | { |
5177 | 0 | escape = check_escape(&ptr, &ec, errorcodeptr, cd->bracount, options, |
5178 | 0 | TRUE); |
5179 | 0 | if (*errorcodeptr != 0) goto FAILED; |
5180 | 0 | if (escape == 0) c = ec; |
5181 | 0 | else if (escape == ESC_b) c = CHAR_BS; /* \b is backspace in a class */ |
5182 | 0 | else if (escape == ESC_N) /* \N is not supported in a class */ |
5183 | 0 | { |
5184 | 0 | *errorcodeptr = ERR71; |
5185 | 0 | goto FAILED; |
5186 | 0 | } |
5187 | 0 | else if (escape == ESC_Q) /* Handle start of quoted string */ |
5188 | 0 | { |
5189 | 0 | if (ptr[1] == CHAR_BACKSLASH && ptr[2] == CHAR_E) |
5190 | 0 | { |
5191 | 0 | ptr += 2; /* avoid empty string */ |
5192 | 0 | } |
5193 | 0 | else inescq = TRUE; |
5194 | 0 | continue; |
5195 | 0 | } |
5196 | 0 | else if (escape == ESC_E) continue; /* Ignore orphan \E */ |
5197 | | |
5198 | 0 | else |
5199 | 0 | { |
5200 | 0 | register const pcre_uint8 *cbits = cd->cbits; |
5201 | | /* Every class contains at least two < 256 characters. */ |
5202 | 0 | class_has_8bitchar++; |
5203 | | /* Every class contains at least two characters. */ |
5204 | 0 | class_one_char += 2; |
5205 | |
|
5206 | 0 | switch (escape) |
5207 | 0 | { |
5208 | | #ifdef SUPPORT_UCP |
5209 | | case ESC_du: /* These are the values given for \d etc */ |
5210 | | case ESC_DU: /* when PCRE_UCP is set. We replace the */ |
5211 | | case ESC_wu: /* escape sequence with an appropriate \p */ |
5212 | | case ESC_WU: /* or \P to test Unicode properties instead */ |
5213 | | case ESC_su: /* of the default ASCII testing. */ |
5214 | | case ESC_SU: |
5215 | | nestptr = ptr; |
5216 | | ptr = substitutes[escape - ESC_DU] - 1; /* Just before substitute */ |
5217 | | class_has_8bitchar--; /* Undo! */ |
5218 | | continue; |
5219 | | #endif |
5220 | 0 | case ESC_d: |
5221 | 0 | for (c = 0; c < 32; c++) classbits[c] |= cbits[c+cbit_digit]; |
5222 | 0 | continue; |
5223 | | |
5224 | 0 | case ESC_D: |
5225 | 0 | should_flip_negation = TRUE; |
5226 | 0 | for (c = 0; c < 32; c++) classbits[c] |= ~cbits[c+cbit_digit]; |
5227 | 0 | continue; |
5228 | | |
5229 | 0 | case ESC_w: |
5230 | 0 | for (c = 0; c < 32; c++) classbits[c] |= cbits[c+cbit_word]; |
5231 | 0 | continue; |
5232 | | |
5233 | 0 | case ESC_W: |
5234 | 0 | should_flip_negation = TRUE; |
5235 | 0 | for (c = 0; c < 32; c++) classbits[c] |= ~cbits[c+cbit_word]; |
5236 | 0 | continue; |
5237 | | |
5238 | | /* Perl 5.004 onwards omitted VT from \s, but restored it at Perl |
5239 | | 5.18. Before PCRE 8.34, we had to preserve the VT bit if it was |
5240 | | previously set by something earlier in the character class. |
5241 | | Luckily, the value of CHAR_VT is 0x0b in both ASCII and EBCDIC, so |
5242 | | we could just adjust the appropriate bit. From PCRE 8.34 we no |
5243 | | longer treat \s and \S specially. */ |
5244 | | |
5245 | 0 | case ESC_s: |
5246 | 0 | for (c = 0; c < 32; c++) classbits[c] |= cbits[c+cbit_space]; |
5247 | 0 | continue; |
5248 | | |
5249 | 0 | case ESC_S: |
5250 | 0 | should_flip_negation = TRUE; |
5251 | 0 | for (c = 0; c < 32; c++) classbits[c] |= ~cbits[c+cbit_space]; |
5252 | 0 | continue; |
5253 | | |
5254 | | /* The rest apply in both UCP and non-UCP cases. */ |
5255 | | |
5256 | 0 | case ESC_h: |
5257 | 0 | (void)add_list_to_class(classbits, &class_uchardata, options, cd, |
5258 | 0 | PRIV(hspace_list), NOTACHAR); |
5259 | 0 | continue; |
5260 | | |
5261 | 0 | case ESC_H: |
5262 | 0 | (void)add_not_list_to_class(classbits, &class_uchardata, options, |
5263 | 0 | cd, PRIV(hspace_list)); |
5264 | 0 | continue; |
5265 | | |
5266 | 0 | case ESC_v: |
5267 | 0 | (void)add_list_to_class(classbits, &class_uchardata, options, cd, |
5268 | 0 | PRIV(vspace_list), NOTACHAR); |
5269 | 0 | continue; |
5270 | | |
5271 | 0 | case ESC_V: |
5272 | 0 | (void)add_not_list_to_class(classbits, &class_uchardata, options, |
5273 | 0 | cd, PRIV(vspace_list)); |
5274 | 0 | continue; |
5275 | | |
5276 | 0 | case ESC_p: |
5277 | 0 | case ESC_P: |
5278 | | #ifdef SUPPORT_UCP |
5279 | | { |
5280 | | BOOL negated; |
5281 | | unsigned int ptype = 0, pdata = 0; |
5282 | | if (!get_ucp(&ptr, &negated, &ptype, &pdata, errorcodeptr)) |
5283 | | goto FAILED; |
5284 | | *class_uchardata++ = ((escape == ESC_p) != negated)? |
5285 | | XCL_PROP : XCL_NOTPROP; |
5286 | | *class_uchardata++ = ptype; |
5287 | | *class_uchardata++ = pdata; |
5288 | | xclass_has_prop = TRUE; |
5289 | | class_has_8bitchar--; /* Undo! */ |
5290 | | continue; |
5291 | | } |
5292 | | #else |
5293 | 0 | *errorcodeptr = ERR45; |
5294 | 0 | goto FAILED; |
5295 | 0 | #endif |
5296 | | /* Unrecognized escapes are faulted if PCRE is running in its |
5297 | | strict mode. By default, for compatibility with Perl, they are |
5298 | | treated as literals. */ |
5299 | | |
5300 | 0 | default: |
5301 | 0 | if ((options & PCRE_EXTRA) != 0) |
5302 | 0 | { |
5303 | 0 | *errorcodeptr = ERR7; |
5304 | 0 | goto FAILED; |
5305 | 0 | } |
5306 | 0 | class_has_8bitchar--; /* Undo the speculative increase. */ |
5307 | 0 | class_one_char -= 2; /* Undo the speculative increase. */ |
5308 | 0 | c = *ptr; /* Get the final character and fall through */ |
5309 | 0 | break; |
5310 | 0 | } |
5311 | 0 | } |
5312 | | |
5313 | | /* Fall through if the escape just defined a single character (c >= 0). |
5314 | | This may be greater than 256. */ |
5315 | | |
5316 | 0 | escape = 0; |
5317 | |
|
5318 | 0 | } /* End of backslash handling */ |
5319 | | |
5320 | | /* A character may be followed by '-' to form a range. However, Perl does |
5321 | | not permit ']' to be the end of the range. A '-' character at the end is |
5322 | | treated as a literal. Perl ignores orphaned \E sequences entirely. The |
5323 | | code for handling \Q and \E is messy. */ |
5324 | | |
5325 | 0 | CHECK_RANGE: |
5326 | 0 | while (ptr[1] == CHAR_BACKSLASH && ptr[2] == CHAR_E) |
5327 | 0 | { |
5328 | 0 | inescq = FALSE; |
5329 | 0 | ptr += 2; |
5330 | 0 | } |
5331 | 0 | oldptr = ptr; |
5332 | | |
5333 | | /* Remember if \r or \n were explicitly used */ |
5334 | |
|
5335 | 0 | if (c == CHAR_CR || c == CHAR_NL) cd->external_flags |= PCRE_HASCRORLF; |
5336 | | |
5337 | | /* Check for range */ |
5338 | |
|
5339 | 0 | if (!inescq && ptr[1] == CHAR_MINUS) |
5340 | 0 | { |
5341 | 0 | pcre_uint32 d; |
5342 | 0 | ptr += 2; |
5343 | 0 | while (*ptr == CHAR_BACKSLASH && ptr[1] == CHAR_E) ptr += 2; |
5344 | | |
5345 | | /* If we hit \Q (not followed by \E) at this point, go into escaped |
5346 | | mode. */ |
5347 | |
|
5348 | 0 | while (*ptr == CHAR_BACKSLASH && ptr[1] == CHAR_Q) |
5349 | 0 | { |
5350 | 0 | ptr += 2; |
5351 | 0 | if (*ptr == CHAR_BACKSLASH && ptr[1] == CHAR_E) |
5352 | 0 | { ptr += 2; continue; } |
5353 | 0 | inescq = TRUE; |
5354 | 0 | break; |
5355 | 0 | } |
5356 | | |
5357 | | /* Minus (hyphen) at the end of a class is treated as a literal, so put |
5358 | | back the pointer and jump to handle the character that preceded it. */ |
5359 | |
|
5360 | 0 | if (*ptr == CHAR_NULL || (!inescq && *ptr == CHAR_RIGHT_SQUARE_BRACKET)) |
5361 | 0 | { |
5362 | 0 | ptr = oldptr; |
5363 | 0 | goto CLASS_SINGLE_CHARACTER; |
5364 | 0 | } |
5365 | | |
5366 | | /* Otherwise, we have a potential range; pick up the next character */ |
5367 | | |
5368 | | #ifdef SUPPORT_UTF |
5369 | | if (utf) |
5370 | | { /* Braces are required because the */ |
5371 | | GETCHARLEN(d, ptr, ptr); /* macro generates multiple statements */ |
5372 | | } |
5373 | | else |
5374 | | #endif |
5375 | 0 | d = *ptr; /* Not UTF-8 mode */ |
5376 | | |
5377 | | /* The second part of a range can be a single-character escape |
5378 | | sequence, but not any of the other escapes. Perl treats a hyphen as a |
5379 | | literal in such circumstances. However, in Perl's warning mode, a |
5380 | | warning is given, so PCRE now faults it as it is almost certainly a |
5381 | | mistake on the user's part. */ |
5382 | |
|
5383 | 0 | if (!inescq) |
5384 | 0 | { |
5385 | 0 | if (d == CHAR_BACKSLASH) |
5386 | 0 | { |
5387 | 0 | int descape; |
5388 | 0 | descape = check_escape(&ptr, &d, errorcodeptr, cd->bracount, options, TRUE); |
5389 | 0 | if (*errorcodeptr != 0) goto FAILED; |
5390 | | |
5391 | | /* 0 means a character was put into d; \b is backspace; any other |
5392 | | special causes an error. */ |
5393 | | |
5394 | 0 | if (descape != 0) |
5395 | 0 | { |
5396 | 0 | if (descape == ESC_b) d = CHAR_BS; else |
5397 | 0 | { |
5398 | 0 | *errorcodeptr = ERR83; |
5399 | 0 | goto FAILED; |
5400 | 0 | } |
5401 | 0 | } |
5402 | 0 | } |
5403 | | |
5404 | | /* A hyphen followed by a POSIX class is treated in the same way. */ |
5405 | | |
5406 | 0 | else if (d == CHAR_LEFT_SQUARE_BRACKET && |
5407 | 0 | (ptr[1] == CHAR_COLON || ptr[1] == CHAR_DOT || |
5408 | 0 | ptr[1] == CHAR_EQUALS_SIGN) && |
5409 | 0 | check_posix_syntax(ptr, &tempptr)) |
5410 | 0 | { |
5411 | 0 | *errorcodeptr = ERR83; |
5412 | 0 | goto FAILED; |
5413 | 0 | } |
5414 | 0 | } |
5415 | | |
5416 | | /* Check that the two values are in the correct order. Optimize |
5417 | | one-character ranges. */ |
5418 | | |
5419 | 0 | if (d < c) |
5420 | 0 | { |
5421 | 0 | *errorcodeptr = ERR8; |
5422 | 0 | goto FAILED; |
5423 | 0 | } |
5424 | 0 | if (d == c) goto CLASS_SINGLE_CHARACTER; /* A few lines below */ |
5425 | | |
5426 | | /* We have found a character range, so single character optimizations |
5427 | | cannot be done anymore. Any value greater than 1 indicates that there |
5428 | | is more than one character. */ |
5429 | | |
5430 | 0 | class_one_char = 2; |
5431 | | |
5432 | | /* Remember an explicit \r or \n, and add the range to the class. */ |
5433 | |
|
5434 | 0 | if (d == CHAR_CR || d == CHAR_NL) cd->external_flags |= PCRE_HASCRORLF; |
5435 | |
|
5436 | 0 | class_has_8bitchar += |
5437 | 0 | add_to_class(classbits, &class_uchardata, options, cd, c, d); |
5438 | |
|
5439 | 0 | continue; /* Go get the next char in the class */ |
5440 | 0 | } |
5441 | | |
5442 | | /* Handle a single character - we can get here for a normal non-escape |
5443 | | char, or after \ that introduces a single character or for an apparent |
5444 | | range that isn't. Only the value 1 matters for class_one_char, so don't |
5445 | | increase it if it is already 2 or more ... just in case there's a class |
5446 | | with a zillion characters in it. */ |
5447 | | |
5448 | 0 | CLASS_SINGLE_CHARACTER: |
5449 | 0 | if (class_one_char < 2) class_one_char++; |
5450 | | |
5451 | | /* If xclass_has_prop is false and class_one_char is 1, we have the first |
5452 | | single character in the class, and there have been no prior ranges, or |
5453 | | XCLASS items generated by escapes. If this is the final character in the |
5454 | | class, we can optimize by turning the item into a 1-character OP_CHAR[I] |
5455 | | if it's positive, or OP_NOT[I] if it's negative. In the positive case, it |
5456 | | can cause firstchar to be set. Otherwise, there can be no first char if |
5457 | | this item is first, whatever repeat count may follow. In the case of |
5458 | | reqchar, save the previous value for reinstating. */ |
5459 | |
|
5460 | 0 | if (!inescq && |
5461 | | #ifdef SUPPORT_UCP |
5462 | | !xclass_has_prop && |
5463 | | #endif |
5464 | 0 | class_one_char == 1 && ptr[1] == CHAR_RIGHT_SQUARE_BRACKET) |
5465 | 0 | { |
5466 | 0 | ptr++; |
5467 | 0 | zeroreqchar = reqchar; |
5468 | 0 | zeroreqcharflags = reqcharflags; |
5469 | |
|
5470 | 0 | if (negate_class) |
5471 | 0 | { |
5472 | | #ifdef SUPPORT_UCP |
5473 | | int d; |
5474 | | #endif |
5475 | 0 | if (firstcharflags == REQ_UNSET) firstcharflags = REQ_NONE; |
5476 | 0 | zerofirstchar = firstchar; |
5477 | 0 | zerofirstcharflags = firstcharflags; |
5478 | | |
5479 | | /* For caseless UTF-8 mode when UCP support is available, check |
5480 | | whether this character has more than one other case. If so, generate |
5481 | | a special OP_NOTPROP item instead of OP_NOTI. */ |
5482 | |
|
5483 | | #ifdef SUPPORT_UCP |
5484 | | if (utf && (options & PCRE_CASELESS) != 0 && |
5485 | | (d = UCD_CASESET(c)) != 0) |
5486 | | { |
5487 | | *code++ = OP_NOTPROP; |
5488 | | *code++ = PT_CLIST; |
5489 | | *code++ = d; |
5490 | | } |
5491 | | else |
5492 | | #endif |
5493 | | /* Char has only one other case, or UCP not available */ |
5494 | |
|
5495 | 0 | { |
5496 | 0 | *code++ = ((options & PCRE_CASELESS) != 0)? OP_NOTI: OP_NOT; |
5497 | | #if defined SUPPORT_UTF && !defined COMPILE_PCRE32 |
5498 | | if (utf && c > MAX_VALUE_FOR_SINGLE_CHAR) |
5499 | | code += PRIV(ord2utf)(c, code); |
5500 | | else |
5501 | | #endif |
5502 | 0 | *code++ = c; |
5503 | 0 | } |
5504 | | |
5505 | | /* We are finished with this character class */ |
5506 | |
|
5507 | 0 | goto END_CLASS; |
5508 | 0 | } |
5509 | | |
5510 | | /* For a single, positive character, get the value into mcbuffer, and |
5511 | | then we can handle this with the normal one-character code. */ |
5512 | | |
5513 | | #if defined SUPPORT_UTF && !defined COMPILE_PCRE32 |
5514 | | if (utf && c > MAX_VALUE_FOR_SINGLE_CHAR) |
5515 | | mclength = PRIV(ord2utf)(c, mcbuffer); |
5516 | | else |
5517 | | #endif |
5518 | 0 | { |
5519 | 0 | mcbuffer[0] = c; |
5520 | 0 | mclength = 1; |
5521 | 0 | } |
5522 | 0 | goto ONE_CHAR; |
5523 | 0 | } /* End of 1-char optimization */ |
5524 | | |
5525 | | /* There is more than one character in the class, or an XCLASS item |
5526 | | has been generated. Add this character to the class. */ |
5527 | | |
5528 | 0 | class_has_8bitchar += |
5529 | 0 | add_to_class(classbits, &class_uchardata, options, cd, c, c); |
5530 | 0 | } |
5531 | | |
5532 | | /* Loop until ']' reached. This "while" is the end of the "do" far above. |
5533 | | If we are at the end of an internal nested string, revert to the outer |
5534 | | string. */ |
5535 | |
|
5536 | 0 | while (((c = *(++ptr)) != CHAR_NULL || |
5537 | 0 | (nestptr != NULL && |
5538 | 0 | (ptr = nestptr, nestptr = NULL, c = *(++ptr)) != CHAR_NULL)) && |
5539 | 0 | (c != CHAR_RIGHT_SQUARE_BRACKET || inescq)); |
5540 | | |
5541 | | /* Check for missing terminating ']' */ |
5542 | | |
5543 | 0 | if (c == CHAR_NULL) |
5544 | 0 | { |
5545 | 0 | *errorcodeptr = ERR6; |
5546 | 0 | goto FAILED; |
5547 | 0 | } |
5548 | | |
5549 | | /* We will need an XCLASS if data has been placed in class_uchardata. In |
5550 | | the second phase this is a sufficient test. However, in the pre-compile |
5551 | | phase, class_uchardata gets emptied to prevent workspace overflow, so it |
5552 | | only if the very last character in the class needs XCLASS will it contain |
5553 | | anything at this point. For this reason, xclass gets set TRUE above when |
5554 | | uchar_classdata is emptied, and that's why this code is the way it is here |
5555 | | instead of just doing a test on class_uchardata below. */ |
5556 | | |
5557 | | #if defined SUPPORT_UTF || !defined COMPILE_PCRE8 |
5558 | | if (class_uchardata > class_uchardata_base) xclass = TRUE; |
5559 | | #endif |
5560 | | |
5561 | | /* If this is the first thing in the branch, there can be no first char |
5562 | | setting, whatever the repeat count. Any reqchar setting must remain |
5563 | | unchanged after any kind of repeat. */ |
5564 | | |
5565 | 0 | if (firstcharflags == REQ_UNSET) firstcharflags = REQ_NONE; |
5566 | 0 | zerofirstchar = firstchar; |
5567 | 0 | zerofirstcharflags = firstcharflags; |
5568 | 0 | zeroreqchar = reqchar; |
5569 | 0 | zeroreqcharflags = reqcharflags; |
5570 | | |
5571 | | /* If there are characters with values > 255, we have to compile an |
5572 | | extended class, with its own opcode, unless there was a negated special |
5573 | | such as \S in the class, and PCRE_UCP is not set, because in that case all |
5574 | | characters > 255 are in the class, so any that were explicitly given as |
5575 | | well can be ignored. If (when there are explicit characters > 255 that must |
5576 | | be listed) there are no characters < 256, we can omit the bitmap in the |
5577 | | actual compiled code. */ |
5578 | |
|
5579 | | #ifdef SUPPORT_UTF |
5580 | | if (xclass && (xclass_has_prop || !should_flip_negation || |
5581 | | (options & PCRE_UCP) != 0)) |
5582 | | #elif !defined COMPILE_PCRE8 |
5583 | | if (xclass && (xclass_has_prop || !should_flip_negation)) |
5584 | | #endif |
5585 | | #if defined SUPPORT_UTF || !defined COMPILE_PCRE8 |
5586 | | { |
5587 | | /* For non-UCP wide characters, in a non-negative class containing \S or |
5588 | | similar (should_flip_negation is set), all characters greater than 255 |
5589 | | must be in the class. */ |
5590 | | |
5591 | | if ( |
5592 | | #if defined COMPILE_PCRE8 |
5593 | | utf && |
5594 | | #endif |
5595 | | should_flip_negation && !negate_class && (options & PCRE_UCP) == 0) |
5596 | | { |
5597 | | *class_uchardata++ = XCL_RANGE; |
5598 | | if (utf) /* Will always be utf in the 8-bit library */ |
5599 | | { |
5600 | | class_uchardata += PRIV(ord2utf)(0x100, class_uchardata); |
5601 | | class_uchardata += PRIV(ord2utf)(0x10ffff, class_uchardata); |
5602 | | } |
5603 | | else /* Can only happen for the 16-bit & 32-bit libraries */ |
5604 | | { |
5605 | | #if defined COMPILE_PCRE16 |
5606 | | *class_uchardata++ = 0x100; |
5607 | | *class_uchardata++ = 0xffffu; |
5608 | | #elif defined COMPILE_PCRE32 |
5609 | | *class_uchardata++ = 0x100; |
5610 | | *class_uchardata++ = 0xffffffffu; |
5611 | | #endif |
5612 | | } |
5613 | | } |
5614 | | |
5615 | | *class_uchardata++ = XCL_END; /* Marks the end of extra data */ |
5616 | | *code++ = OP_XCLASS; |
5617 | | code += LINK_SIZE; |
5618 | | *code = negate_class? XCL_NOT:0; |
5619 | | if (xclass_has_prop) *code |= XCL_HASPROP; |
5620 | | |
5621 | | /* If the map is required, move up the extra data to make room for it; |
5622 | | otherwise just move the code pointer to the end of the extra data. */ |
5623 | | |
5624 | | if (class_has_8bitchar > 0) |
5625 | | { |
5626 | | *code++ |= XCL_MAP; |
5627 | | memmove(code + (32 / sizeof(pcre_uchar)), code, |
5628 | | IN_UCHARS(class_uchardata - code)); |
5629 | | if (negate_class && !xclass_has_prop) |
5630 | | for (c = 0; c < 32; c++) classbits[c] = ~classbits[c]; |
5631 | | memcpy(code, classbits, 32); |
5632 | | code = class_uchardata + (32 / sizeof(pcre_uchar)); |
5633 | | } |
5634 | | else code = class_uchardata; |
5635 | | |
5636 | | /* Now fill in the complete length of the item */ |
5637 | | |
5638 | | PUT(previous, 1, (int)(code - previous)); |
5639 | | break; /* End of class handling */ |
5640 | | } |
5641 | | |
5642 | | /* Even though any XCLASS list is now discarded, we must allow for |
5643 | | its memory. */ |
5644 | | |
5645 | | if (lengthptr != NULL) |
5646 | | *lengthptr += (int)(class_uchardata - class_uchardata_base); |
5647 | | #endif |
5648 | | |
5649 | | /* If there are no characters > 255, or they are all to be included or |
5650 | | excluded, set the opcode to OP_CLASS or OP_NCLASS, depending on whether the |
5651 | | whole class was negated and whether there were negative specials such as \S |
5652 | | (non-UCP) in the class. Then copy the 32-byte map into the code vector, |
5653 | | negating it if necessary. */ |
5654 | |
|
5655 | 0 | *code++ = (negate_class == should_flip_negation) ? OP_CLASS : OP_NCLASS; |
5656 | 0 | if (lengthptr == NULL) /* Save time in the pre-compile phase */ |
5657 | 0 | { |
5658 | 0 | if (negate_class) |
5659 | 0 | for (c = 0; c < 32; c++) classbits[c] = ~classbits[c]; |
5660 | 0 | memcpy(code, classbits, 32); |
5661 | 0 | } |
5662 | 0 | code += 32 / sizeof(pcre_uchar); |
5663 | |
|
5664 | 0 | END_CLASS: |
5665 | 0 | break; |
5666 | | |
5667 | | |
5668 | | /* ===================================================================*/ |
5669 | | /* Various kinds of repeat; '{' is not necessarily a quantifier, but this |
5670 | | has been tested above. */ |
5671 | | |
5672 | 0 | case CHAR_LEFT_CURLY_BRACKET: |
5673 | 0 | if (!is_quantifier) goto NORMAL_CHAR; |
5674 | 0 | ptr = read_repeat_counts(ptr+1, &repeat_min, &repeat_max, errorcodeptr); |
5675 | 0 | if (*errorcodeptr != 0) goto FAILED; |
5676 | 0 | goto REPEAT; |
5677 | | |
5678 | 0 | case CHAR_ASTERISK: |
5679 | 0 | repeat_min = 0; |
5680 | 0 | repeat_max = -1; |
5681 | 0 | goto REPEAT; |
5682 | | |
5683 | 0 | case CHAR_PLUS: |
5684 | 0 | repeat_min = 1; |
5685 | 0 | repeat_max = -1; |
5686 | 0 | goto REPEAT; |
5687 | | |
5688 | 0 | case CHAR_QUESTION_MARK: |
5689 | 0 | repeat_min = 0; |
5690 | 0 | repeat_max = 1; |
5691 | |
|
5692 | 0 | REPEAT: |
5693 | 0 | if (previous == NULL) |
5694 | 0 | { |
5695 | 0 | *errorcodeptr = ERR9; |
5696 | 0 | goto FAILED; |
5697 | 0 | } |
5698 | | |
5699 | 0 | if (repeat_min == 0) |
5700 | 0 | { |
5701 | 0 | firstchar = zerofirstchar; /* Adjust for zero repeat */ |
5702 | 0 | firstcharflags = zerofirstcharflags; |
5703 | 0 | reqchar = zeroreqchar; /* Ditto */ |
5704 | 0 | reqcharflags = zeroreqcharflags; |
5705 | 0 | } |
5706 | | |
5707 | | /* Remember whether this is a variable length repeat */ |
5708 | |
|
5709 | 0 | reqvary = (repeat_min == repeat_max)? 0 : REQ_VARY; |
5710 | |
|
5711 | 0 | op_type = 0; /* Default single-char op codes */ |
5712 | 0 | possessive_quantifier = FALSE; /* Default not possessive quantifier */ |
5713 | | |
5714 | | /* Save start of previous item, in case we have to move it up in order to |
5715 | | insert something before it. */ |
5716 | |
|
5717 | 0 | tempcode = previous; |
5718 | | |
5719 | | /* Before checking for a possessive quantifier, we must skip over |
5720 | | whitespace and comments in extended mode because Perl allows white space at |
5721 | | this point. */ |
5722 | |
|
5723 | 0 | if ((options & PCRE_EXTENDED) != 0) |
5724 | 0 | { |
5725 | 0 | const pcre_uchar *p = ptr + 1; |
5726 | 0 | for (;;) |
5727 | 0 | { |
5728 | 0 | while (MAX_255(*p) && (cd->ctypes[*p] & ctype_space) != 0) p++; |
5729 | 0 | if (*p != CHAR_NUMBER_SIGN) break; |
5730 | 0 | p++; |
5731 | 0 | while (*p != CHAR_NULL) |
5732 | 0 | { |
5733 | 0 | if (IS_NEWLINE(p)) /* For non-fixed-length newline cases, */ |
5734 | 0 | { /* IS_NEWLINE sets cd->nllen. */ |
5735 | 0 | p += cd->nllen; |
5736 | 0 | break; |
5737 | 0 | } |
5738 | 0 | p++; |
5739 | | #ifdef SUPPORT_UTF |
5740 | | if (utf) FORWARDCHAR(p); |
5741 | | #endif |
5742 | 0 | } /* Loop for comment characters */ |
5743 | 0 | } /* Loop for multiple comments */ |
5744 | 0 | ptr = p - 1; /* Character before the next significant one. */ |
5745 | 0 | } |
5746 | | |
5747 | | /* We also need to skip over (?# comments, which are not dependent on |
5748 | | extended mode. */ |
5749 | |
|
5750 | 0 | if (ptr[1] == CHAR_LEFT_PARENTHESIS && ptr[2] == CHAR_QUESTION_MARK && |
5751 | 0 | ptr[3] == CHAR_NUMBER_SIGN) |
5752 | 0 | { |
5753 | 0 | ptr += 4; |
5754 | 0 | while (*ptr != CHAR_NULL && *ptr != CHAR_RIGHT_PARENTHESIS) ptr++; |
5755 | 0 | if (*ptr == CHAR_NULL) |
5756 | 0 | { |
5757 | 0 | *errorcodeptr = ERR18; |
5758 | 0 | goto FAILED; |
5759 | 0 | } |
5760 | 0 | } |
5761 | | |
5762 | | /* If the next character is '+', we have a possessive quantifier. This |
5763 | | implies greediness, whatever the setting of the PCRE_UNGREEDY option. |
5764 | | If the next character is '?' this is a minimizing repeat, by default, |
5765 | | but if PCRE_UNGREEDY is set, it works the other way round. We change the |
5766 | | repeat type to the non-default. */ |
5767 | | |
5768 | 0 | if (ptr[1] == CHAR_PLUS) |
5769 | 0 | { |
5770 | 0 | repeat_type = 0; /* Force greedy */ |
5771 | 0 | possessive_quantifier = TRUE; |
5772 | 0 | ptr++; |
5773 | 0 | } |
5774 | 0 | else if (ptr[1] == CHAR_QUESTION_MARK) |
5775 | 0 | { |
5776 | 0 | repeat_type = greedy_non_default; |
5777 | 0 | ptr++; |
5778 | 0 | } |
5779 | 0 | else repeat_type = greedy_default; |
5780 | | |
5781 | | /* If previous was a recursion call, wrap it in atomic brackets so that |
5782 | | previous becomes the atomic group. All recursions were so wrapped in the |
5783 | | past, but it no longer happens for non-repeated recursions. In fact, the |
5784 | | repeated ones could be re-implemented independently so as not to need this, |
5785 | | but for the moment we rely on the code for repeating groups. */ |
5786 | |
|
5787 | 0 | if (*previous == OP_RECURSE) |
5788 | 0 | { |
5789 | 0 | memmove(previous + 1 + LINK_SIZE, previous, IN_UCHARS(1 + LINK_SIZE)); |
5790 | 0 | *previous = OP_ONCE; |
5791 | 0 | PUT(previous, 1, 2 + 2*LINK_SIZE); |
5792 | 0 | previous[2 + 2*LINK_SIZE] = OP_KET; |
5793 | 0 | PUT(previous, 3 + 2*LINK_SIZE, 2 + 2*LINK_SIZE); |
5794 | 0 | code += 2 + 2 * LINK_SIZE; |
5795 | 0 | length_prevgroup = 3 + 3*LINK_SIZE; |
5796 | | |
5797 | | /* When actually compiling, we need to check whether this was a forward |
5798 | | reference, and if so, adjust the offset. */ |
5799 | |
|
5800 | 0 | if (lengthptr == NULL && cd->hwm >= cd->start_workspace + LINK_SIZE) |
5801 | 0 | { |
5802 | 0 | int offset = GET(cd->hwm, -LINK_SIZE); |
5803 | 0 | if (offset == previous + 1 - cd->start_code) |
5804 | 0 | PUT(cd->hwm, -LINK_SIZE, offset + 1 + LINK_SIZE); |
5805 | 0 | } |
5806 | 0 | } |
5807 | | |
5808 | | /* Now handle repetition for the different types of item. */ |
5809 | | |
5810 | | /* If previous was a character or negated character match, abolish the item |
5811 | | and generate a repeat item instead. If a char item has a minimum of more |
5812 | | than one, ensure that it is set in reqchar - it might not be if a sequence |
5813 | | such as x{3} is the first thing in a branch because the x will have gone |
5814 | | into firstchar instead. */ |
5815 | |
|
5816 | 0 | if (*previous == OP_CHAR || *previous == OP_CHARI |
5817 | 0 | || *previous == OP_NOT || *previous == OP_NOTI) |
5818 | 0 | { |
5819 | 0 | switch (*previous) |
5820 | 0 | { |
5821 | 0 | default: /* Make compiler happy. */ |
5822 | 0 | case OP_CHAR: op_type = OP_STAR - OP_STAR; break; |
5823 | 0 | case OP_CHARI: op_type = OP_STARI - OP_STAR; break; |
5824 | 0 | case OP_NOT: op_type = OP_NOTSTAR - OP_STAR; break; |
5825 | 0 | case OP_NOTI: op_type = OP_NOTSTARI - OP_STAR; break; |
5826 | 0 | } |
5827 | | |
5828 | | /* Deal with UTF characters that take up more than one character. It's |
5829 | | easier to write this out separately than try to macrify it. Use c to |
5830 | | hold the length of the character in bytes, plus UTF_LENGTH to flag that |
5831 | | it's a length rather than a small character. */ |
5832 | | |
5833 | | #if defined SUPPORT_UTF && !defined COMPILE_PCRE32 |
5834 | | if (utf && NOT_FIRSTCHAR(code[-1])) |
5835 | | { |
5836 | | pcre_uchar *lastchar = code - 1; |
5837 | | BACKCHAR(lastchar); |
5838 | | c = (int)(code - lastchar); /* Length of UTF-8 character */ |
5839 | | memcpy(utf_chars, lastchar, IN_UCHARS(c)); /* Save the char */ |
5840 | | c |= UTF_LENGTH; /* Flag c as a length */ |
5841 | | } |
5842 | | else |
5843 | | #endif /* SUPPORT_UTF */ |
5844 | | |
5845 | | /* Handle the case of a single charater - either with no UTF support, or |
5846 | | with UTF disabled, or for a single character UTF character. */ |
5847 | 0 | { |
5848 | 0 | c = code[-1]; |
5849 | 0 | if (*previous <= OP_CHARI && repeat_min > 1) |
5850 | 0 | { |
5851 | 0 | reqchar = c; |
5852 | 0 | reqcharflags = req_caseopt | cd->req_varyopt; |
5853 | 0 | } |
5854 | 0 | } |
5855 | |
|
5856 | 0 | goto OUTPUT_SINGLE_REPEAT; /* Code shared with single character types */ |
5857 | 0 | } |
5858 | | |
5859 | | /* If previous was a character type match (\d or similar), abolish it and |
5860 | | create a suitable repeat item. The code is shared with single-character |
5861 | | repeats by setting op_type to add a suitable offset into repeat_type. Note |
5862 | | the the Unicode property types will be present only when SUPPORT_UCP is |
5863 | | defined, but we don't wrap the little bits of code here because it just |
5864 | | makes it horribly messy. */ |
5865 | | |
5866 | 0 | else if (*previous < OP_EODN) |
5867 | 0 | { |
5868 | 0 | pcre_uchar *oldcode; |
5869 | 0 | int prop_type, prop_value; |
5870 | 0 | op_type = OP_TYPESTAR - OP_STAR; /* Use type opcodes */ |
5871 | 0 | c = *previous; |
5872 | |
|
5873 | 0 | OUTPUT_SINGLE_REPEAT: |
5874 | 0 | if (*previous == OP_PROP || *previous == OP_NOTPROP) |
5875 | 0 | { |
5876 | 0 | prop_type = previous[1]; |
5877 | 0 | prop_value = previous[2]; |
5878 | 0 | } |
5879 | 0 | else prop_type = prop_value = -1; |
5880 | |
|
5881 | 0 | oldcode = code; |
5882 | 0 | code = previous; /* Usually overwrite previous item */ |
5883 | | |
5884 | | /* If the maximum is zero then the minimum must also be zero; Perl allows |
5885 | | this case, so we do too - by simply omitting the item altogether. */ |
5886 | |
|
5887 | 0 | if (repeat_max == 0) goto END_REPEAT; |
5888 | | |
5889 | | /* Combine the op_type with the repeat_type */ |
5890 | | |
5891 | 0 | repeat_type += op_type; |
5892 | | |
5893 | | /* A minimum of zero is handled either as the special case * or ?, or as |
5894 | | an UPTO, with the maximum given. */ |
5895 | |
|
5896 | 0 | if (repeat_min == 0) |
5897 | 0 | { |
5898 | 0 | if (repeat_max == -1) *code++ = OP_STAR + repeat_type; |
5899 | 0 | else if (repeat_max == 1) *code++ = OP_QUERY + repeat_type; |
5900 | 0 | else |
5901 | 0 | { |
5902 | 0 | *code++ = OP_UPTO + repeat_type; |
5903 | 0 | PUT2INC(code, 0, repeat_max); |
5904 | 0 | } |
5905 | 0 | } |
5906 | | |
5907 | | /* A repeat minimum of 1 is optimized into some special cases. If the |
5908 | | maximum is unlimited, we use OP_PLUS. Otherwise, the original item is |
5909 | | left in place and, if the maximum is greater than 1, we use OP_UPTO with |
5910 | | one less than the maximum. */ |
5911 | | |
5912 | 0 | else if (repeat_min == 1) |
5913 | 0 | { |
5914 | 0 | if (repeat_max == -1) |
5915 | 0 | *code++ = OP_PLUS + repeat_type; |
5916 | 0 | else |
5917 | 0 | { |
5918 | 0 | code = oldcode; /* leave previous item in place */ |
5919 | 0 | if (repeat_max == 1) goto END_REPEAT; |
5920 | 0 | *code++ = OP_UPTO + repeat_type; |
5921 | 0 | PUT2INC(code, 0, repeat_max - 1); |
5922 | 0 | } |
5923 | 0 | } |
5924 | | |
5925 | | /* The case {n,n} is just an EXACT, while the general case {n,m} is |
5926 | | handled as an EXACT followed by an UPTO. */ |
5927 | | |
5928 | 0 | else |
5929 | 0 | { |
5930 | 0 | *code++ = OP_EXACT + op_type; /* NB EXACT doesn't have repeat_type */ |
5931 | 0 | PUT2INC(code, 0, repeat_min); |
5932 | | |
5933 | | /* If the maximum is unlimited, insert an OP_STAR. Before doing so, |
5934 | | we have to insert the character for the previous code. For a repeated |
5935 | | Unicode property match, there are two extra bytes that define the |
5936 | | required property. In UTF-8 mode, long characters have their length in |
5937 | | c, with the UTF_LENGTH bit as a flag. */ |
5938 | |
|
5939 | 0 | if (repeat_max < 0) |
5940 | 0 | { |
5941 | | #if defined SUPPORT_UTF && !defined COMPILE_PCRE32 |
5942 | | if (utf && (c & UTF_LENGTH) != 0) |
5943 | | { |
5944 | | memcpy(code, utf_chars, IN_UCHARS(c & 7)); |
5945 | | code += c & 7; |
5946 | | } |
5947 | | else |
5948 | | #endif |
5949 | 0 | { |
5950 | 0 | *code++ = c; |
5951 | 0 | if (prop_type >= 0) |
5952 | 0 | { |
5953 | 0 | *code++ = prop_type; |
5954 | 0 | *code++ = prop_value; |
5955 | 0 | } |
5956 | 0 | } |
5957 | 0 | *code++ = OP_STAR + repeat_type; |
5958 | 0 | } |
5959 | | |
5960 | | /* Else insert an UPTO if the max is greater than the min, again |
5961 | | preceded by the character, for the previously inserted code. If the |
5962 | | UPTO is just for 1 instance, we can use QUERY instead. */ |
5963 | | |
5964 | 0 | else if (repeat_max != repeat_min) |
5965 | 0 | { |
5966 | | #if defined SUPPORT_UTF && !defined COMPILE_PCRE32 |
5967 | | if (utf && (c & UTF_LENGTH) != 0) |
5968 | | { |
5969 | | memcpy(code, utf_chars, IN_UCHARS(c & 7)); |
5970 | | code += c & 7; |
5971 | | } |
5972 | | else |
5973 | | #endif |
5974 | 0 | *code++ = c; |
5975 | 0 | if (prop_type >= 0) |
5976 | 0 | { |
5977 | 0 | *code++ = prop_type; |
5978 | 0 | *code++ = prop_value; |
5979 | 0 | } |
5980 | 0 | repeat_max -= repeat_min; |
5981 | |
|
5982 | 0 | if (repeat_max == 1) |
5983 | 0 | { |
5984 | 0 | *code++ = OP_QUERY + repeat_type; |
5985 | 0 | } |
5986 | 0 | else |
5987 | 0 | { |
5988 | 0 | *code++ = OP_UPTO + repeat_type; |
5989 | 0 | PUT2INC(code, 0, repeat_max); |
5990 | 0 | } |
5991 | 0 | } |
5992 | 0 | } |
5993 | | |
5994 | | /* The character or character type itself comes last in all cases. */ |
5995 | | |
5996 | | #if defined SUPPORT_UTF && !defined COMPILE_PCRE32 |
5997 | | if (utf && (c & UTF_LENGTH) != 0) |
5998 | | { |
5999 | | memcpy(code, utf_chars, IN_UCHARS(c & 7)); |
6000 | | code += c & 7; |
6001 | | } |
6002 | | else |
6003 | | #endif |
6004 | 0 | *code++ = c; |
6005 | | |
6006 | | /* For a repeated Unicode property match, there are two extra bytes that |
6007 | | define the required property. */ |
6008 | |
|
6009 | | #ifdef SUPPORT_UCP |
6010 | | if (prop_type >= 0) |
6011 | | { |
6012 | | *code++ = prop_type; |
6013 | | *code++ = prop_value; |
6014 | | } |
6015 | | #endif |
6016 | 0 | } |
6017 | | |
6018 | | /* If previous was a character class or a back reference, we put the repeat |
6019 | | stuff after it, but just skip the item if the repeat was {0,0}. */ |
6020 | | |
6021 | 0 | else if (*previous == OP_CLASS || *previous == OP_NCLASS || |
6022 | | #if defined SUPPORT_UTF || !defined COMPILE_PCRE8 |
6023 | | *previous == OP_XCLASS || |
6024 | | #endif |
6025 | 0 | *previous == OP_REF || *previous == OP_REFI || |
6026 | 0 | *previous == OP_DNREF || *previous == OP_DNREFI) |
6027 | 0 | { |
6028 | 0 | if (repeat_max == 0) |
6029 | 0 | { |
6030 | 0 | code = previous; |
6031 | 0 | goto END_REPEAT; |
6032 | 0 | } |
6033 | | |
6034 | 0 | if (repeat_min == 0 && repeat_max == -1) |
6035 | 0 | *code++ = OP_CRSTAR + repeat_type; |
6036 | 0 | else if (repeat_min == 1 && repeat_max == -1) |
6037 | 0 | *code++ = OP_CRPLUS + repeat_type; |
6038 | 0 | else if (repeat_min == 0 && repeat_max == 1) |
6039 | 0 | *code++ = OP_CRQUERY + repeat_type; |
6040 | 0 | else |
6041 | 0 | { |
6042 | 0 | *code++ = OP_CRRANGE + repeat_type; |
6043 | 0 | PUT2INC(code, 0, repeat_min); |
6044 | 0 | if (repeat_max == -1) repeat_max = 0; /* 2-byte encoding for max */ |
6045 | 0 | PUT2INC(code, 0, repeat_max); |
6046 | 0 | } |
6047 | 0 | } |
6048 | | |
6049 | | /* If previous was a bracket group, we may have to replicate it in certain |
6050 | | cases. Note that at this point we can encounter only the "basic" bracket |
6051 | | opcodes such as BRA and CBRA, as this is the place where they get converted |
6052 | | into the more special varieties such as BRAPOS and SBRA. A test for >= |
6053 | | OP_ASSERT and <= OP_COND includes ASSERT, ASSERT_NOT, ASSERTBACK, |
6054 | | ASSERTBACK_NOT, ONCE, ONCE_NC, BRA, BRAPOS, CBRA, CBRAPOS, and COND. |
6055 | | Originally, PCRE did not allow repetition of assertions, but now it does, |
6056 | | for Perl compatibility. */ |
6057 | | |
6058 | 0 | else if (*previous >= OP_ASSERT && *previous <= OP_COND) |
6059 | 0 | { |
6060 | 0 | register int i; |
6061 | 0 | int len = (int)(code - previous); |
6062 | 0 | size_t base_hwm_offset = item_hwm_offset; |
6063 | 0 | pcre_uchar *bralink = NULL; |
6064 | 0 | pcre_uchar *brazeroptr = NULL; |
6065 | | |
6066 | | /* Repeating a DEFINE group is pointless, but Perl allows the syntax, so |
6067 | | we just ignore the repeat. */ |
6068 | |
|
6069 | 0 | if (*previous == OP_COND && previous[LINK_SIZE+1] == OP_DEF) |
6070 | 0 | goto END_REPEAT; |
6071 | | |
6072 | | /* There is no sense in actually repeating assertions. The only potential |
6073 | | use of repetition is in cases when the assertion is optional. Therefore, |
6074 | | if the minimum is greater than zero, just ignore the repeat. If the |
6075 | | maximum is not zero or one, set it to 1. */ |
6076 | | |
6077 | 0 | if (*previous < OP_ONCE) /* Assertion */ |
6078 | 0 | { |
6079 | 0 | if (repeat_min > 0) goto END_REPEAT; |
6080 | 0 | if (repeat_max < 0 || repeat_max > 1) repeat_max = 1; |
6081 | 0 | } |
6082 | | |
6083 | | /* The case of a zero minimum is special because of the need to stick |
6084 | | OP_BRAZERO in front of it, and because the group appears once in the |
6085 | | data, whereas in other cases it appears the minimum number of times. For |
6086 | | this reason, it is simplest to treat this case separately, as otherwise |
6087 | | the code gets far too messy. There are several special subcases when the |
6088 | | minimum is zero. */ |
6089 | | |
6090 | 0 | if (repeat_min == 0) |
6091 | 0 | { |
6092 | | /* If the maximum is also zero, we used to just omit the group from the |
6093 | | output altogether, like this: |
6094 | | |
6095 | | ** if (repeat_max == 0) |
6096 | | ** { |
6097 | | ** code = previous; |
6098 | | ** goto END_REPEAT; |
6099 | | ** } |
6100 | | |
6101 | | However, that fails when a group or a subgroup within it is referenced |
6102 | | as a subroutine from elsewhere in the pattern, so now we stick in |
6103 | | OP_SKIPZERO in front of it so that it is skipped on execution. As we |
6104 | | don't have a list of which groups are referenced, we cannot do this |
6105 | | selectively. |
6106 | | |
6107 | | If the maximum is 1 or unlimited, we just have to stick in the BRAZERO |
6108 | | and do no more at this point. However, we do need to adjust any |
6109 | | OP_RECURSE calls inside the group that refer to the group itself or any |
6110 | | internal or forward referenced group, because the offset is from the |
6111 | | start of the whole regex. Temporarily terminate the pattern while doing |
6112 | | this. */ |
6113 | |
|
6114 | 0 | if (repeat_max <= 1) /* Covers 0, 1, and unlimited */ |
6115 | 0 | { |
6116 | 0 | *code = OP_END; |
6117 | 0 | adjust_recurse(previous, 1, utf, cd, item_hwm_offset); |
6118 | 0 | memmove(previous + 1, previous, IN_UCHARS(len)); |
6119 | 0 | code++; |
6120 | 0 | if (repeat_max == 0) |
6121 | 0 | { |
6122 | 0 | *previous++ = OP_SKIPZERO; |
6123 | 0 | goto END_REPEAT; |
6124 | 0 | } |
6125 | 0 | brazeroptr = previous; /* Save for possessive optimizing */ |
6126 | 0 | *previous++ = OP_BRAZERO + repeat_type; |
6127 | 0 | } |
6128 | | |
6129 | | /* If the maximum is greater than 1 and limited, we have to replicate |
6130 | | in a nested fashion, sticking OP_BRAZERO before each set of brackets. |
6131 | | The first one has to be handled carefully because it's the original |
6132 | | copy, which has to be moved up. The remainder can be handled by code |
6133 | | that is common with the non-zero minimum case below. We have to |
6134 | | adjust the value or repeat_max, since one less copy is required. Once |
6135 | | again, we may have to adjust any OP_RECURSE calls inside the group. */ |
6136 | | |
6137 | 0 | else |
6138 | 0 | { |
6139 | 0 | int offset; |
6140 | 0 | *code = OP_END; |
6141 | 0 | adjust_recurse(previous, 2 + LINK_SIZE, utf, cd, item_hwm_offset); |
6142 | 0 | memmove(previous + 2 + LINK_SIZE, previous, IN_UCHARS(len)); |
6143 | 0 | code += 2 + LINK_SIZE; |
6144 | 0 | *previous++ = OP_BRAZERO + repeat_type; |
6145 | 0 | *previous++ = OP_BRA; |
6146 | | |
6147 | | /* We chain together the bracket offset fields that have to be |
6148 | | filled in later when the ends of the brackets are reached. */ |
6149 | |
|
6150 | 0 | offset = (bralink == NULL)? 0 : (int)(previous - bralink); |
6151 | 0 | bralink = previous; |
6152 | 0 | PUTINC(previous, 0, offset); |
6153 | 0 | } |
6154 | | |
6155 | 0 | repeat_max--; |
6156 | 0 | } |
6157 | | |
6158 | | /* If the minimum is greater than zero, replicate the group as many |
6159 | | times as necessary, and adjust the maximum to the number of subsequent |
6160 | | copies that we need. If we set a first char from the group, and didn't |
6161 | | set a required char, copy the latter from the former. If there are any |
6162 | | forward reference subroutine calls in the group, there will be entries on |
6163 | | the workspace list; replicate these with an appropriate increment. */ |
6164 | | |
6165 | 0 | else |
6166 | 0 | { |
6167 | 0 | if (repeat_min > 1) |
6168 | 0 | { |
6169 | | /* In the pre-compile phase, we don't actually do the replication. We |
6170 | | just adjust the length as if we had. Do some paranoid checks for |
6171 | | potential integer overflow. The INT64_OR_DOUBLE type is a 64-bit |
6172 | | integer type when available, otherwise double. */ |
6173 | |
|
6174 | 0 | if (lengthptr != NULL) |
6175 | 0 | { |
6176 | 0 | int delta = (repeat_min - 1)*length_prevgroup; |
6177 | 0 | if ((INT64_OR_DOUBLE)(repeat_min - 1)* |
6178 | 0 | (INT64_OR_DOUBLE)length_prevgroup > |
6179 | 0 | (INT64_OR_DOUBLE)INT_MAX || |
6180 | 0 | OFLOW_MAX - *lengthptr < delta) |
6181 | 0 | { |
6182 | 0 | *errorcodeptr = ERR20; |
6183 | 0 | goto FAILED; |
6184 | 0 | } |
6185 | 0 | *lengthptr += delta; |
6186 | 0 | } |
6187 | | |
6188 | | /* This is compiling for real. If there is a set first byte for |
6189 | | the group, and we have not yet set a "required byte", set it. Make |
6190 | | sure there is enough workspace for copying forward references before |
6191 | | doing the copy. */ |
6192 | | |
6193 | 0 | else |
6194 | 0 | { |
6195 | 0 | if (groupsetfirstchar && reqcharflags < 0) |
6196 | 0 | { |
6197 | 0 | reqchar = firstchar; |
6198 | 0 | reqcharflags = firstcharflags; |
6199 | 0 | } |
6200 | |
|
6201 | 0 | for (i = 1; i < repeat_min; i++) |
6202 | 0 | { |
6203 | 0 | pcre_uchar *hc; |
6204 | 0 | size_t this_hwm_offset = cd->hwm - cd->start_workspace; |
6205 | 0 | memcpy(code, previous, IN_UCHARS(len)); |
6206 | |
|
6207 | 0 | while (cd->hwm > cd->start_workspace + cd->workspace_size - |
6208 | 0 | WORK_SIZE_SAFETY_MARGIN - |
6209 | 0 | (this_hwm_offset - base_hwm_offset)) |
6210 | 0 | { |
6211 | 0 | *errorcodeptr = expand_workspace(cd); |
6212 | 0 | if (*errorcodeptr != 0) goto FAILED; |
6213 | 0 | } |
6214 | | |
6215 | 0 | for (hc = (pcre_uchar *)cd->start_workspace + base_hwm_offset; |
6216 | 0 | hc < (pcre_uchar *)cd->start_workspace + this_hwm_offset; |
6217 | 0 | hc += LINK_SIZE) |
6218 | 0 | { |
6219 | 0 | PUT(cd->hwm, 0, GET(hc, 0) + len); |
6220 | 0 | cd->hwm += LINK_SIZE; |
6221 | 0 | } |
6222 | 0 | base_hwm_offset = this_hwm_offset; |
6223 | 0 | code += len; |
6224 | 0 | } |
6225 | 0 | } |
6226 | 0 | } |
6227 | | |
6228 | 0 | if (repeat_max > 0) repeat_max -= repeat_min; |
6229 | 0 | } |
6230 | | |
6231 | | /* This code is common to both the zero and non-zero minimum cases. If |
6232 | | the maximum is limited, it replicates the group in a nested fashion, |
6233 | | remembering the bracket starts on a stack. In the case of a zero minimum, |
6234 | | the first one was set up above. In all cases the repeat_max now specifies |
6235 | | the number of additional copies needed. Again, we must remember to |
6236 | | replicate entries on the forward reference list. */ |
6237 | | |
6238 | 0 | if (repeat_max >= 0) |
6239 | 0 | { |
6240 | | /* In the pre-compile phase, we don't actually do the replication. We |
6241 | | just adjust the length as if we had. For each repetition we must add 1 |
6242 | | to the length for BRAZERO and for all but the last repetition we must |
6243 | | add 2 + 2*LINKSIZE to allow for the nesting that occurs. Do some |
6244 | | paranoid checks to avoid integer overflow. The INT64_OR_DOUBLE type is |
6245 | | a 64-bit integer type when available, otherwise double. */ |
6246 | |
|
6247 | 0 | if (lengthptr != NULL && repeat_max > 0) |
6248 | 0 | { |
6249 | 0 | int delta = repeat_max * (length_prevgroup + 1 + 2 + 2*LINK_SIZE) - |
6250 | 0 | 2 - 2*LINK_SIZE; /* Last one doesn't nest */ |
6251 | 0 | if ((INT64_OR_DOUBLE)repeat_max * |
6252 | 0 | (INT64_OR_DOUBLE)(length_prevgroup + 1 + 2 + 2*LINK_SIZE) |
6253 | 0 | > (INT64_OR_DOUBLE)INT_MAX || |
6254 | 0 | OFLOW_MAX - *lengthptr < delta) |
6255 | 0 | { |
6256 | 0 | *errorcodeptr = ERR20; |
6257 | 0 | goto FAILED; |
6258 | 0 | } |
6259 | 0 | *lengthptr += delta; |
6260 | 0 | } |
6261 | | |
6262 | | /* This is compiling for real */ |
6263 | | |
6264 | 0 | else for (i = repeat_max - 1; i >= 0; i--) |
6265 | 0 | { |
6266 | 0 | pcre_uchar *hc; |
6267 | 0 | size_t this_hwm_offset = cd->hwm - cd->start_workspace; |
6268 | |
|
6269 | 0 | *code++ = OP_BRAZERO + repeat_type; |
6270 | | |
6271 | | /* All but the final copy start a new nesting, maintaining the |
6272 | | chain of brackets outstanding. */ |
6273 | |
|
6274 | 0 | if (i != 0) |
6275 | 0 | { |
6276 | 0 | int offset; |
6277 | 0 | *code++ = OP_BRA; |
6278 | 0 | offset = (bralink == NULL)? 0 : (int)(code - bralink); |
6279 | 0 | bralink = code; |
6280 | 0 | PUTINC(code, 0, offset); |
6281 | 0 | } |
6282 | |
|
6283 | 0 | memcpy(code, previous, IN_UCHARS(len)); |
6284 | | |
6285 | | /* Ensure there is enough workspace for forward references before |
6286 | | copying them. */ |
6287 | |
|
6288 | 0 | while (cd->hwm > cd->start_workspace + cd->workspace_size - |
6289 | 0 | WORK_SIZE_SAFETY_MARGIN - |
6290 | 0 | (this_hwm_offset - base_hwm_offset)) |
6291 | 0 | { |
6292 | 0 | *errorcodeptr = expand_workspace(cd); |
6293 | 0 | if (*errorcodeptr != 0) goto FAILED; |
6294 | 0 | } |
6295 | | |
6296 | 0 | for (hc = (pcre_uchar *)cd->start_workspace + base_hwm_offset; |
6297 | 0 | hc < (pcre_uchar *)cd->start_workspace + this_hwm_offset; |
6298 | 0 | hc += LINK_SIZE) |
6299 | 0 | { |
6300 | 0 | PUT(cd->hwm, 0, GET(hc, 0) + len + ((i != 0)? 2+LINK_SIZE : 1)); |
6301 | 0 | cd->hwm += LINK_SIZE; |
6302 | 0 | } |
6303 | 0 | base_hwm_offset = this_hwm_offset; |
6304 | 0 | code += len; |
6305 | 0 | } |
6306 | | |
6307 | | /* Now chain through the pending brackets, and fill in their length |
6308 | | fields (which are holding the chain links pro tem). */ |
6309 | | |
6310 | 0 | while (bralink != NULL) |
6311 | 0 | { |
6312 | 0 | int oldlinkoffset; |
6313 | 0 | int offset = (int)(code - bralink + 1); |
6314 | 0 | pcre_uchar *bra = code - offset; |
6315 | 0 | oldlinkoffset = GET(bra, 1); |
6316 | 0 | bralink = (oldlinkoffset == 0)? NULL : bralink - oldlinkoffset; |
6317 | 0 | *code++ = OP_KET; |
6318 | 0 | PUTINC(code, 0, offset); |
6319 | 0 | PUT(bra, 1, offset); |
6320 | 0 | } |
6321 | 0 | } |
6322 | | |
6323 | | /* If the maximum is unlimited, set a repeater in the final copy. For |
6324 | | ONCE brackets, that's all we need to do. However, possessively repeated |
6325 | | ONCE brackets can be converted into non-capturing brackets, as the |
6326 | | behaviour of (?:xx)++ is the same as (?>xx)++ and this saves having to |
6327 | | deal with possessive ONCEs specially. |
6328 | | |
6329 | | Otherwise, when we are doing the actual compile phase, check to see |
6330 | | whether this group is one that could match an empty string. If so, |
6331 | | convert the initial operator to the S form (e.g. OP_BRA -> OP_SBRA) so |
6332 | | that runtime checking can be done. [This check is also applied to ONCE |
6333 | | groups at runtime, but in a different way.] |
6334 | | |
6335 | | Then, if the quantifier was possessive and the bracket is not a |
6336 | | conditional, we convert the BRA code to the POS form, and the KET code to |
6337 | | KETRPOS. (It turns out to be convenient at runtime to detect this kind of |
6338 | | subpattern at both the start and at the end.) The use of special opcodes |
6339 | | makes it possible to reduce greatly the stack usage in pcre_exec(). If |
6340 | | the group is preceded by OP_BRAZERO, convert this to OP_BRAPOSZERO. |
6341 | | |
6342 | | Then, if the minimum number of matches is 1 or 0, cancel the possessive |
6343 | | flag so that the default action below, of wrapping everything inside |
6344 | | atomic brackets, does not happen. When the minimum is greater than 1, |
6345 | | there will be earlier copies of the group, and so we still have to wrap |
6346 | | the whole thing. */ |
6347 | | |
6348 | 0 | else |
6349 | 0 | { |
6350 | 0 | pcre_uchar *ketcode = code - 1 - LINK_SIZE; |
6351 | 0 | pcre_uchar *bracode = ketcode - GET(ketcode, 1); |
6352 | | |
6353 | | /* Convert possessive ONCE brackets to non-capturing */ |
6354 | |
|
6355 | 0 | if ((*bracode == OP_ONCE || *bracode == OP_ONCE_NC) && |
6356 | 0 | possessive_quantifier) *bracode = OP_BRA; |
6357 | | |
6358 | | /* For non-possessive ONCE brackets, all we need to do is to |
6359 | | set the KET. */ |
6360 | |
|
6361 | 0 | if (*bracode == OP_ONCE || *bracode == OP_ONCE_NC) |
6362 | 0 | *ketcode = OP_KETRMAX + repeat_type; |
6363 | | |
6364 | | /* Handle non-ONCE brackets and possessive ONCEs (which have been |
6365 | | converted to non-capturing above). */ |
6366 | | |
6367 | 0 | else |
6368 | 0 | { |
6369 | | /* In the compile phase, check for empty string matching. */ |
6370 | |
|
6371 | 0 | if (lengthptr == NULL) |
6372 | 0 | { |
6373 | 0 | pcre_uchar *scode = bracode; |
6374 | 0 | do |
6375 | 0 | { |
6376 | 0 | if (could_be_empty_branch(scode, ketcode, utf, cd, NULL)) |
6377 | 0 | { |
6378 | 0 | *bracode += OP_SBRA - OP_BRA; |
6379 | 0 | break; |
6380 | 0 | } |
6381 | 0 | scode += GET(scode, 1); |
6382 | 0 | } |
6383 | 0 | while (*scode == OP_ALT); |
6384 | 0 | } |
6385 | | |
6386 | | /* A conditional group with only one branch has an implicit empty |
6387 | | alternative branch. */ |
6388 | | |
6389 | 0 | if (*bracode == OP_COND && bracode[GET(bracode,1)] != OP_ALT) |
6390 | 0 | *bracode = OP_SCOND; |
6391 | | |
6392 | | /* Handle possessive quantifiers. */ |
6393 | |
|
6394 | 0 | if (possessive_quantifier) |
6395 | 0 | { |
6396 | | /* For COND brackets, we wrap the whole thing in a possessively |
6397 | | repeated non-capturing bracket, because we have not invented POS |
6398 | | versions of the COND opcodes. Because we are moving code along, we |
6399 | | must ensure that any pending recursive references are updated. */ |
6400 | |
|
6401 | 0 | if (*bracode == OP_COND || *bracode == OP_SCOND) |
6402 | 0 | { |
6403 | 0 | int nlen = (int)(code - bracode); |
6404 | 0 | *code = OP_END; |
6405 | 0 | adjust_recurse(bracode, 1 + LINK_SIZE, utf, cd, item_hwm_offset); |
6406 | 0 | memmove(bracode + 1 + LINK_SIZE, bracode, IN_UCHARS(nlen)); |
6407 | 0 | code += 1 + LINK_SIZE; |
6408 | 0 | nlen += 1 + LINK_SIZE; |
6409 | 0 | *bracode = (*bracode == OP_COND)? OP_BRAPOS : OP_SBRAPOS; |
6410 | 0 | *code++ = OP_KETRPOS; |
6411 | 0 | PUTINC(code, 0, nlen); |
6412 | 0 | PUT(bracode, 1, nlen); |
6413 | 0 | } |
6414 | | |
6415 | | /* For non-COND brackets, we modify the BRA code and use KETRPOS. */ |
6416 | | |
6417 | 0 | else |
6418 | 0 | { |
6419 | 0 | *bracode += 1; /* Switch to xxxPOS opcodes */ |
6420 | 0 | *ketcode = OP_KETRPOS; |
6421 | 0 | } |
6422 | | |
6423 | | /* If the minimum is zero, mark it as possessive, then unset the |
6424 | | possessive flag when the minimum is 0 or 1. */ |
6425 | |
|
6426 | 0 | if (brazeroptr != NULL) *brazeroptr = OP_BRAPOSZERO; |
6427 | 0 | if (repeat_min < 2) possessive_quantifier = FALSE; |
6428 | 0 | } |
6429 | | |
6430 | | /* Non-possessive quantifier */ |
6431 | | |
6432 | 0 | else *ketcode = OP_KETRMAX + repeat_type; |
6433 | 0 | } |
6434 | 0 | } |
6435 | 0 | } |
6436 | | |
6437 | | /* If previous is OP_FAIL, it was generated by an empty class [] in |
6438 | | JavaScript mode. The other ways in which OP_FAIL can be generated, that is |
6439 | | by (*FAIL) or (?!) set previous to NULL, which gives a "nothing to repeat" |
6440 | | error above. We can just ignore the repeat in JS case. */ |
6441 | | |
6442 | 0 | else if (*previous == OP_FAIL) goto END_REPEAT; |
6443 | | |
6444 | | /* Else there's some kind of shambles */ |
6445 | | |
6446 | 0 | else |
6447 | 0 | { |
6448 | 0 | *errorcodeptr = ERR11; |
6449 | 0 | goto FAILED; |
6450 | 0 | } |
6451 | | |
6452 | | /* If the character following a repeat is '+', possessive_quantifier is |
6453 | | TRUE. For some opcodes, there are special alternative opcodes for this |
6454 | | case. For anything else, we wrap the entire repeated item inside OP_ONCE |
6455 | | brackets. Logically, the '+' notation is just syntactic sugar, taken from |
6456 | | Sun's Java package, but the special opcodes can optimize it. |
6457 | | |
6458 | | Some (but not all) possessively repeated subpatterns have already been |
6459 | | completely handled in the code just above. For them, possessive_quantifier |
6460 | | is always FALSE at this stage. Note that the repeated item starts at |
6461 | | tempcode, not at previous, which might be the first part of a string whose |
6462 | | (former) last char we repeated. */ |
6463 | | |
6464 | 0 | if (possessive_quantifier) |
6465 | 0 | { |
6466 | 0 | int len; |
6467 | | |
6468 | | /* Possessifying an EXACT quantifier has no effect, so we can ignore it. |
6469 | | However, QUERY, STAR, or UPTO may follow (for quantifiers such as {5,6}, |
6470 | | {5,}, or {5,10}). We skip over an EXACT item; if the length of what |
6471 | | remains is greater than zero, there's a further opcode that can be |
6472 | | handled. If not, do nothing, leaving the EXACT alone. */ |
6473 | |
|
6474 | 0 | switch(*tempcode) |
6475 | 0 | { |
6476 | 0 | case OP_TYPEEXACT: |
6477 | 0 | tempcode += PRIV(OP_lengths)[*tempcode] + |
6478 | 0 | ((tempcode[1 + IMM2_SIZE] == OP_PROP |
6479 | 0 | || tempcode[1 + IMM2_SIZE] == OP_NOTPROP)? 2 : 0); |
6480 | 0 | break; |
6481 | | |
6482 | | /* CHAR opcodes are used for exacts whose count is 1. */ |
6483 | | |
6484 | 0 | case OP_CHAR: |
6485 | 0 | case OP_CHARI: |
6486 | 0 | case OP_NOT: |
6487 | 0 | case OP_NOTI: |
6488 | 0 | case OP_EXACT: |
6489 | 0 | case OP_EXACTI: |
6490 | 0 | case OP_NOTEXACT: |
6491 | 0 | case OP_NOTEXACTI: |
6492 | 0 | tempcode += PRIV(OP_lengths)[*tempcode]; |
6493 | | #ifdef SUPPORT_UTF |
6494 | | if (utf && HAS_EXTRALEN(tempcode[-1])) |
6495 | | tempcode += GET_EXTRALEN(tempcode[-1]); |
6496 | | #endif |
6497 | 0 | break; |
6498 | | |
6499 | | /* For the class opcodes, the repeat operator appears at the end; |
6500 | | adjust tempcode to point to it. */ |
6501 | | |
6502 | 0 | case OP_CLASS: |
6503 | 0 | case OP_NCLASS: |
6504 | 0 | tempcode += 1 + 32/sizeof(pcre_uchar); |
6505 | 0 | break; |
6506 | |
|
6507 | | #if defined SUPPORT_UTF || !defined COMPILE_PCRE8 |
6508 | | case OP_XCLASS: |
6509 | | tempcode += GET(tempcode, 1); |
6510 | | break; |
6511 | | #endif |
6512 | 0 | } |
6513 | | |
6514 | | /* If tempcode is equal to code (which points to the end of the repeated |
6515 | | item), it means we have skipped an EXACT item but there is no following |
6516 | | QUERY, STAR, or UPTO; the value of len will be 0, and we do nothing. In |
6517 | | all other cases, tempcode will be pointing to the repeat opcode, and will |
6518 | | be less than code, so the value of len will be greater than 0. */ |
6519 | | |
6520 | 0 | len = (int)(code - tempcode); |
6521 | 0 | if (len > 0) |
6522 | 0 | { |
6523 | 0 | unsigned int repcode = *tempcode; |
6524 | | |
6525 | | /* There is a table for possessifying opcodes, all of which are less |
6526 | | than OP_CALLOUT. A zero entry means there is no possessified version. |
6527 | | */ |
6528 | |
|
6529 | 0 | if (repcode < OP_CALLOUT && opcode_possessify[repcode] > 0) |
6530 | 0 | *tempcode = opcode_possessify[repcode]; |
6531 | | |
6532 | | /* For opcode without a special possessified version, wrap the item in |
6533 | | ONCE brackets. Because we are moving code along, we must ensure that any |
6534 | | pending recursive references are updated. */ |
6535 | | |
6536 | 0 | else |
6537 | 0 | { |
6538 | 0 | *code = OP_END; |
6539 | 0 | adjust_recurse(tempcode, 1 + LINK_SIZE, utf, cd, item_hwm_offset); |
6540 | 0 | memmove(tempcode + 1 + LINK_SIZE, tempcode, IN_UCHARS(len)); |
6541 | 0 | code += 1 + LINK_SIZE; |
6542 | 0 | len += 1 + LINK_SIZE; |
6543 | 0 | tempcode[0] = OP_ONCE; |
6544 | 0 | *code++ = OP_KET; |
6545 | 0 | PUTINC(code, 0, len); |
6546 | 0 | PUT(tempcode, 1, len); |
6547 | 0 | } |
6548 | 0 | } |
6549 | |
|
6550 | | #ifdef NEVER |
6551 | | if (len > 0) switch (*tempcode) |
6552 | | { |
6553 | | case OP_STAR: *tempcode = OP_POSSTAR; break; |
6554 | | case OP_PLUS: *tempcode = OP_POSPLUS; break; |
6555 | | case OP_QUERY: *tempcode = OP_POSQUERY; break; |
6556 | | case OP_UPTO: *tempcode = OP_POSUPTO; break; |
6557 | | |
6558 | | case OP_STARI: *tempcode = OP_POSSTARI; break; |
6559 | | case OP_PLUSI: *tempcode = OP_POSPLUSI; break; |
6560 | | case OP_QUERYI: *tempcode = OP_POSQUERYI; break; |
6561 | | case OP_UPTOI: *tempcode = OP_POSUPTOI; break; |
6562 | | |
6563 | | case OP_NOTSTAR: *tempcode = OP_NOTPOSSTAR; break; |
6564 | | case OP_NOTPLUS: *tempcode = OP_NOTPOSPLUS; break; |
6565 | | case OP_NOTQUERY: *tempcode = OP_NOTPOSQUERY; break; |
6566 | | case OP_NOTUPTO: *tempcode = OP_NOTPOSUPTO; break; |
6567 | | |
6568 | | case OP_NOTSTARI: *tempcode = OP_NOTPOSSTARI; break; |
6569 | | case OP_NOTPLUSI: *tempcode = OP_NOTPOSPLUSI; break; |
6570 | | case OP_NOTQUERYI: *tempcode = OP_NOTPOSQUERYI; break; |
6571 | | case OP_NOTUPTOI: *tempcode = OP_NOTPOSUPTOI; break; |
6572 | | |
6573 | | case OP_TYPESTAR: *tempcode = OP_TYPEPOSSTAR; break; |
6574 | | case OP_TYPEPLUS: *tempcode = OP_TYPEPOSPLUS; break; |
6575 | | case OP_TYPEQUERY: *tempcode = OP_TYPEPOSQUERY; break; |
6576 | | case OP_TYPEUPTO: *tempcode = OP_TYPEPOSUPTO; break; |
6577 | | |
6578 | | case OP_CRSTAR: *tempcode = OP_CRPOSSTAR; break; |
6579 | | case OP_CRPLUS: *tempcode = OP_CRPOSPLUS; break; |
6580 | | case OP_CRQUERY: *tempcode = OP_CRPOSQUERY; break; |
6581 | | case OP_CRRANGE: *tempcode = OP_CRPOSRANGE; break; |
6582 | | |
6583 | | /* Because we are moving code along, we must ensure that any |
6584 | | pending recursive references are updated. */ |
6585 | | |
6586 | | default: |
6587 | | *code = OP_END; |
6588 | | adjust_recurse(tempcode, 1 + LINK_SIZE, utf, cd, item_hwm_offset); |
6589 | | memmove(tempcode + 1 + LINK_SIZE, tempcode, IN_UCHARS(len)); |
6590 | | code += 1 + LINK_SIZE; |
6591 | | len += 1 + LINK_SIZE; |
6592 | | tempcode[0] = OP_ONCE; |
6593 | | *code++ = OP_KET; |
6594 | | PUTINC(code, 0, len); |
6595 | | PUT(tempcode, 1, len); |
6596 | | break; |
6597 | | } |
6598 | | #endif |
6599 | 0 | } |
6600 | | |
6601 | | /* In all case we no longer have a previous item. We also set the |
6602 | | "follows varying string" flag for subsequently encountered reqchars if |
6603 | | it isn't already set and we have just passed a varying length item. */ |
6604 | | |
6605 | 0 | END_REPEAT: |
6606 | 0 | previous = NULL; |
6607 | 0 | cd->req_varyopt |= reqvary; |
6608 | 0 | break; |
6609 | | |
6610 | | |
6611 | | /* ===================================================================*/ |
6612 | | /* Start of nested parenthesized sub-expression, or comment or lookahead or |
6613 | | lookbehind or option setting or condition or all the other extended |
6614 | | parenthesis forms. */ |
6615 | | |
6616 | 0 | case CHAR_LEFT_PARENTHESIS: |
6617 | 0 | ptr++; |
6618 | | |
6619 | | /* Now deal with various "verbs" that can be introduced by '*'. */ |
6620 | |
|
6621 | 0 | if (ptr[0] == CHAR_ASTERISK && (ptr[1] == ':' |
6622 | 0 | || (MAX_255(ptr[1]) && ((cd->ctypes[ptr[1]] & ctype_letter) != 0)))) |
6623 | 0 | { |
6624 | 0 | int i, namelen; |
6625 | 0 | int arglen = 0; |
6626 | 0 | const char *vn = verbnames; |
6627 | 0 | const pcre_uchar *name = ptr + 1; |
6628 | 0 | const pcre_uchar *arg = NULL; |
6629 | 0 | previous = NULL; |
6630 | 0 | ptr++; |
6631 | 0 | while (MAX_255(*ptr) && (cd->ctypes[*ptr] & ctype_letter) != 0) ptr++; |
6632 | 0 | namelen = (int)(ptr - name); |
6633 | | |
6634 | | /* It appears that Perl allows any characters whatsoever, other than |
6635 | | a closing parenthesis, to appear in arguments, so we no longer insist on |
6636 | | letters, digits, and underscores. */ |
6637 | |
|
6638 | 0 | if (*ptr == CHAR_COLON) |
6639 | 0 | { |
6640 | 0 | arg = ++ptr; |
6641 | 0 | while (*ptr != CHAR_NULL && *ptr != CHAR_RIGHT_PARENTHESIS) ptr++; |
6642 | 0 | arglen = (int)(ptr - arg); |
6643 | 0 | if ((unsigned int)arglen > MAX_MARK) |
6644 | 0 | { |
6645 | 0 | *errorcodeptr = ERR75; |
6646 | 0 | goto FAILED; |
6647 | 0 | } |
6648 | 0 | } |
6649 | | |
6650 | 0 | if (*ptr != CHAR_RIGHT_PARENTHESIS) |
6651 | 0 | { |
6652 | 0 | *errorcodeptr = ERR60; |
6653 | 0 | goto FAILED; |
6654 | 0 | } |
6655 | | |
6656 | | /* Scan the table of verb names */ |
6657 | | |
6658 | 0 | for (i = 0; i < verbcount; i++) |
6659 | 0 | { |
6660 | 0 | if (namelen == verbs[i].len && |
6661 | 0 | STRNCMP_UC_C8(name, vn, namelen) == 0) |
6662 | 0 | { |
6663 | 0 | int setverb; |
6664 | | |
6665 | | /* Check for open captures before ACCEPT and convert it to |
6666 | | ASSERT_ACCEPT if in an assertion. */ |
6667 | |
|
6668 | 0 | if (verbs[i].op == OP_ACCEPT) |
6669 | 0 | { |
6670 | 0 | open_capitem *oc; |
6671 | 0 | if (arglen != 0) |
6672 | 0 | { |
6673 | 0 | *errorcodeptr = ERR59; |
6674 | 0 | goto FAILED; |
6675 | 0 | } |
6676 | 0 | cd->had_accept = TRUE; |
6677 | 0 | for (oc = cd->open_caps; oc != NULL; oc = oc->next) |
6678 | 0 | { |
6679 | 0 | if (lengthptr != NULL) |
6680 | 0 | { |
6681 | 0 | #ifdef COMPILE_PCRE8 |
6682 | 0 | *lengthptr += 1 + IMM2_SIZE; |
6683 | | #elif defined COMPILE_PCRE16 |
6684 | | *lengthptr += 2 + IMM2_SIZE; |
6685 | | #elif defined COMPILE_PCRE32 |
6686 | | *lengthptr += 4 + IMM2_SIZE; |
6687 | | #endif |
6688 | 0 | } |
6689 | 0 | else |
6690 | 0 | { |
6691 | 0 | *code++ = OP_CLOSE; |
6692 | 0 | PUT2INC(code, 0, oc->number); |
6693 | 0 | } |
6694 | 0 | } |
6695 | 0 | setverb = *code++ = |
6696 | 0 | (cd->assert_depth > 0)? OP_ASSERT_ACCEPT : OP_ACCEPT; |
6697 | | |
6698 | | /* Do not set firstchar after *ACCEPT */ |
6699 | 0 | if (firstcharflags == REQ_UNSET) firstcharflags = REQ_NONE; |
6700 | 0 | } |
6701 | | |
6702 | | /* Handle other cases with/without an argument */ |
6703 | | |
6704 | 0 | else if (arglen == 0) |
6705 | 0 | { |
6706 | 0 | if (verbs[i].op < 0) /* Argument is mandatory */ |
6707 | 0 | { |
6708 | 0 | *errorcodeptr = ERR66; |
6709 | 0 | goto FAILED; |
6710 | 0 | } |
6711 | 0 | setverb = *code++ = verbs[i].op; |
6712 | 0 | } |
6713 | | |
6714 | 0 | else |
6715 | 0 | { |
6716 | 0 | if (verbs[i].op_arg < 0) /* Argument is forbidden */ |
6717 | 0 | { |
6718 | 0 | *errorcodeptr = ERR59; |
6719 | 0 | goto FAILED; |
6720 | 0 | } |
6721 | 0 | setverb = *code++ = verbs[i].op_arg; |
6722 | 0 | if (lengthptr != NULL) /* In pass 1 just add in the length */ |
6723 | 0 | { /* to avoid potential workspace */ |
6724 | 0 | *lengthptr += arglen; /* overflow. */ |
6725 | 0 | *code++ = 0; |
6726 | 0 | } |
6727 | 0 | else |
6728 | 0 | { |
6729 | 0 | *code++ = arglen; |
6730 | 0 | memcpy(code, arg, IN_UCHARS(arglen)); |
6731 | 0 | code += arglen; |
6732 | 0 | } |
6733 | 0 | *code++ = 0; |
6734 | 0 | } |
6735 | | |
6736 | 0 | switch (setverb) |
6737 | 0 | { |
6738 | 0 | case OP_THEN: |
6739 | 0 | case OP_THEN_ARG: |
6740 | 0 | cd->external_flags |= PCRE_HASTHEN; |
6741 | 0 | break; |
6742 | | |
6743 | 0 | case OP_PRUNE: |
6744 | 0 | case OP_PRUNE_ARG: |
6745 | 0 | case OP_SKIP: |
6746 | 0 | case OP_SKIP_ARG: |
6747 | 0 | cd->had_pruneorskip = TRUE; |
6748 | 0 | break; |
6749 | 0 | } |
6750 | | |
6751 | 0 | break; /* Found verb, exit loop */ |
6752 | 0 | } |
6753 | | |
6754 | 0 | vn += verbs[i].len + 1; |
6755 | 0 | } |
6756 | | |
6757 | 0 | if (i < verbcount) continue; /* Successfully handled a verb */ |
6758 | 0 | *errorcodeptr = ERR60; /* Verb not recognized */ |
6759 | 0 | goto FAILED; |
6760 | 0 | } |
6761 | | |
6762 | | /* Initialize for "real" parentheses */ |
6763 | | |
6764 | 0 | newoptions = options; |
6765 | 0 | skipbytes = 0; |
6766 | 0 | bravalue = OP_CBRA; |
6767 | 0 | item_hwm_offset = cd->hwm - cd->start_workspace; |
6768 | 0 | reset_bracount = FALSE; |
6769 | | |
6770 | | /* Deal with the extended parentheses; all are introduced by '?', and the |
6771 | | appearance of any of them means that this is not a capturing group. */ |
6772 | |
|
6773 | 0 | if (*ptr == CHAR_QUESTION_MARK) |
6774 | 0 | { |
6775 | 0 | int i, set, unset, namelen; |
6776 | 0 | int *optset; |
6777 | 0 | const pcre_uchar *name; |
6778 | 0 | pcre_uchar *slot; |
6779 | |
|
6780 | 0 | switch (*(++ptr)) |
6781 | 0 | { |
6782 | | /* ------------------------------------------------------------ */ |
6783 | 0 | case CHAR_VERTICAL_LINE: /* Reset capture count for each branch */ |
6784 | 0 | reset_bracount = TRUE; |
6785 | 0 | cd->dupgroups = TRUE; /* Record (?| encountered */ |
6786 | | /* Fall through */ |
6787 | | |
6788 | | /* ------------------------------------------------------------ */ |
6789 | 0 | case CHAR_COLON: /* Non-capturing bracket */ |
6790 | 0 | bravalue = OP_BRA; |
6791 | 0 | ptr++; |
6792 | 0 | break; |
6793 | | |
6794 | | |
6795 | | /* ------------------------------------------------------------ */ |
6796 | 0 | case CHAR_LEFT_PARENTHESIS: |
6797 | 0 | bravalue = OP_COND; /* Conditional group */ |
6798 | 0 | tempptr = ptr; |
6799 | | |
6800 | | /* A condition can be an assertion, a number (referring to a numbered |
6801 | | group's having been set), a name (referring to a named group), or 'R', |
6802 | | referring to recursion. R<digits> and R&name are also permitted for |
6803 | | recursion tests. |
6804 | | |
6805 | | There are ways of testing a named group: (?(name)) is used by Python; |
6806 | | Perl 5.10 onwards uses (?(<name>) or (?('name')). |
6807 | | |
6808 | | There is one unfortunate ambiguity, caused by history. 'R' can be the |
6809 | | recursive thing or the name 'R' (and similarly for 'R' followed by |
6810 | | digits). We look for a name first; if not found, we try the other case. |
6811 | | |
6812 | | For compatibility with auto-callouts, we allow a callout to be |
6813 | | specified before a condition that is an assertion. First, check for the |
6814 | | syntax of a callout; if found, adjust the temporary pointer that is |
6815 | | used to check for an assertion condition. That's all that is needed! */ |
6816 | |
|
6817 | 0 | if (ptr[1] == CHAR_QUESTION_MARK && ptr[2] == CHAR_C) |
6818 | 0 | { |
6819 | 0 | for (i = 3;; i++) if (!IS_DIGIT(ptr[i])) break; |
6820 | 0 | if (ptr[i] == CHAR_RIGHT_PARENTHESIS) |
6821 | 0 | tempptr += i + 1; |
6822 | | |
6823 | | /* tempptr should now be pointing to the opening parenthesis of the |
6824 | | assertion condition. */ |
6825 | |
|
6826 | 0 | if (*tempptr != CHAR_LEFT_PARENTHESIS) |
6827 | 0 | { |
6828 | 0 | *errorcodeptr = ERR28; |
6829 | 0 | goto FAILED; |
6830 | 0 | } |
6831 | 0 | } |
6832 | | |
6833 | | /* For conditions that are assertions, check the syntax, and then exit |
6834 | | the switch. This will take control down to where bracketed groups, |
6835 | | including assertions, are processed. */ |
6836 | | |
6837 | 0 | if (tempptr[1] == CHAR_QUESTION_MARK && |
6838 | 0 | (tempptr[2] == CHAR_EQUALS_SIGN || |
6839 | 0 | tempptr[2] == CHAR_EXCLAMATION_MARK || |
6840 | 0 | (tempptr[2] == CHAR_LESS_THAN_SIGN && |
6841 | 0 | (tempptr[3] == CHAR_EQUALS_SIGN || |
6842 | 0 | tempptr[3] == CHAR_EXCLAMATION_MARK)))) |
6843 | 0 | { |
6844 | 0 | cd->iscondassert = TRUE; |
6845 | 0 | break; |
6846 | 0 | } |
6847 | | |
6848 | | /* Other conditions use OP_CREF/OP_DNCREF/OP_RREF/OP_DNRREF, and all |
6849 | | need to skip at least 1+IMM2_SIZE bytes at the start of the group. */ |
6850 | | |
6851 | 0 | code[1+LINK_SIZE] = OP_CREF; |
6852 | 0 | skipbytes = 1+IMM2_SIZE; |
6853 | 0 | refsign = -1; /* => not a number */ |
6854 | 0 | namelen = -1; /* => not a name; must set to avoid warning */ |
6855 | 0 | name = NULL; /* Always set to avoid warning */ |
6856 | 0 | recno = 0; /* Always set to avoid warning */ |
6857 | | |
6858 | | /* Check for a test for recursion in a named group. */ |
6859 | |
|
6860 | 0 | ptr++; |
6861 | 0 | if (*ptr == CHAR_R && ptr[1] == CHAR_AMPERSAND) |
6862 | 0 | { |
6863 | 0 | terminator = -1; |
6864 | 0 | ptr += 2; |
6865 | 0 | code[1+LINK_SIZE] = OP_RREF; /* Change the type of test */ |
6866 | 0 | } |
6867 | | |
6868 | | /* Check for a test for a named group's having been set, using the Perl |
6869 | | syntax (?(<name>) or (?('name'), and also allow for the original PCRE |
6870 | | syntax of (?(name) or for (?(+n), (?(-n), and just (?(n). */ |
6871 | | |
6872 | 0 | else if (*ptr == CHAR_LESS_THAN_SIGN) |
6873 | 0 | { |
6874 | 0 | terminator = CHAR_GREATER_THAN_SIGN; |
6875 | 0 | ptr++; |
6876 | 0 | } |
6877 | 0 | else if (*ptr == CHAR_APOSTROPHE) |
6878 | 0 | { |
6879 | 0 | terminator = CHAR_APOSTROPHE; |
6880 | 0 | ptr++; |
6881 | 0 | } |
6882 | 0 | else |
6883 | 0 | { |
6884 | 0 | terminator = CHAR_NULL; |
6885 | 0 | if (*ptr == CHAR_MINUS || *ptr == CHAR_PLUS) refsign = *ptr++; |
6886 | 0 | else if (IS_DIGIT(*ptr)) refsign = 0; |
6887 | 0 | } |
6888 | | |
6889 | | /* Handle a number */ |
6890 | |
|
6891 | 0 | if (refsign >= 0) |
6892 | 0 | { |
6893 | 0 | while (IS_DIGIT(*ptr)) |
6894 | 0 | { |
6895 | 0 | if (recno > INT_MAX / 10 - 1) /* Integer overflow */ |
6896 | 0 | { |
6897 | 0 | while (IS_DIGIT(*ptr)) ptr++; |
6898 | 0 | *errorcodeptr = ERR61; |
6899 | 0 | goto FAILED; |
6900 | 0 | } |
6901 | 0 | recno = recno * 10 + (int)(*ptr - CHAR_0); |
6902 | 0 | ptr++; |
6903 | 0 | } |
6904 | 0 | } |
6905 | | |
6906 | | /* Otherwise we expect to read a name; anything else is an error. When |
6907 | | a name is one of a number of duplicates, a different opcode is used and |
6908 | | it needs more memory. Unfortunately we cannot tell whether a name is a |
6909 | | duplicate in the first pass, so we have to allow for more memory. */ |
6910 | | |
6911 | 0 | else |
6912 | 0 | { |
6913 | 0 | if (IS_DIGIT(*ptr)) |
6914 | 0 | { |
6915 | 0 | *errorcodeptr = ERR84; |
6916 | 0 | goto FAILED; |
6917 | 0 | } |
6918 | 0 | if (!MAX_255(*ptr) || (cd->ctypes[*ptr] & ctype_word) == 0) |
6919 | 0 | { |
6920 | 0 | *errorcodeptr = ERR28; /* Assertion expected */ |
6921 | 0 | goto FAILED; |
6922 | 0 | } |
6923 | 0 | name = ptr++; |
6924 | 0 | while (MAX_255(*ptr) && (cd->ctypes[*ptr] & ctype_word) != 0) |
6925 | 0 | { |
6926 | 0 | ptr++; |
6927 | 0 | } |
6928 | 0 | namelen = (int)(ptr - name); |
6929 | 0 | if (lengthptr != NULL) skipbytes += IMM2_SIZE; |
6930 | 0 | } |
6931 | | |
6932 | | /* Check the terminator */ |
6933 | | |
6934 | 0 | if ((terminator > 0 && *ptr++ != (pcre_uchar)terminator) || |
6935 | 0 | *ptr++ != CHAR_RIGHT_PARENTHESIS) |
6936 | 0 | { |
6937 | 0 | ptr--; /* Error offset */ |
6938 | 0 | *errorcodeptr = ERR26; /* Malformed number or name */ |
6939 | 0 | goto FAILED; |
6940 | 0 | } |
6941 | | |
6942 | | /* Do no further checking in the pre-compile phase. */ |
6943 | | |
6944 | 0 | if (lengthptr != NULL) break; |
6945 | | |
6946 | | /* In the real compile we do the work of looking for the actual |
6947 | | reference. If refsign is not negative, it means we have a number in |
6948 | | recno. */ |
6949 | | |
6950 | 0 | if (refsign >= 0) |
6951 | 0 | { |
6952 | 0 | if (recno <= 0) |
6953 | 0 | { |
6954 | 0 | *errorcodeptr = ERR35; |
6955 | 0 | goto FAILED; |
6956 | 0 | } |
6957 | 0 | if (refsign != 0) recno = (refsign == CHAR_MINUS)? |
6958 | 0 | cd->bracount - recno + 1 : recno + cd->bracount; |
6959 | 0 | if (recno <= 0 || recno > cd->final_bracount) |
6960 | 0 | { |
6961 | 0 | *errorcodeptr = ERR15; |
6962 | 0 | goto FAILED; |
6963 | 0 | } |
6964 | 0 | PUT2(code, 2+LINK_SIZE, recno); |
6965 | 0 | if (recno > cd->top_backref) cd->top_backref = recno; |
6966 | 0 | break; |
6967 | 0 | } |
6968 | | |
6969 | | /* Otherwise look for the name. */ |
6970 | | |
6971 | 0 | slot = cd->name_table; |
6972 | 0 | for (i = 0; i < cd->names_found; i++) |
6973 | 0 | { |
6974 | 0 | if (STRNCMP_UC_UC(name, slot+IMM2_SIZE, namelen) == 0 && |
6975 | 0 | slot[IMM2_SIZE+namelen] == 0) break; |
6976 | 0 | slot += cd->name_entry_size; |
6977 | 0 | } |
6978 | | |
6979 | | /* Found the named subpattern. If the name is duplicated, add one to |
6980 | | the opcode to change CREF/RREF into DNCREF/DNRREF and insert |
6981 | | appropriate data values. Otherwise, just insert the unique subpattern |
6982 | | number. */ |
6983 | |
|
6984 | 0 | if (i < cd->names_found) |
6985 | 0 | { |
6986 | 0 | int offset = i++; |
6987 | 0 | int count = 1; |
6988 | 0 | recno = GET2(slot, 0); /* Number from first found */ |
6989 | 0 | if (recno > cd->top_backref) cd->top_backref = recno; |
6990 | 0 | for (; i < cd->names_found; i++) |
6991 | 0 | { |
6992 | 0 | slot += cd->name_entry_size; |
6993 | 0 | if (STRNCMP_UC_UC(name, slot+IMM2_SIZE, namelen) != 0 || |
6994 | 0 | (slot+IMM2_SIZE)[namelen] != 0) break; |
6995 | 0 | count++; |
6996 | 0 | } |
6997 | |
|
6998 | 0 | if (count > 1) |
6999 | 0 | { |
7000 | 0 | PUT2(code, 2+LINK_SIZE, offset); |
7001 | 0 | PUT2(code, 2+LINK_SIZE+IMM2_SIZE, count); |
7002 | 0 | skipbytes += IMM2_SIZE; |
7003 | 0 | code[1+LINK_SIZE]++; |
7004 | 0 | } |
7005 | 0 | else /* Not a duplicated name */ |
7006 | 0 | { |
7007 | 0 | PUT2(code, 2+LINK_SIZE, recno); |
7008 | 0 | } |
7009 | 0 | } |
7010 | | |
7011 | | /* If terminator == CHAR_NULL it means that the name followed directly |
7012 | | after the opening parenthesis [e.g. (?(abc)...] and in this case there |
7013 | | are some further alternatives to try. For the cases where terminator != |
7014 | | CHAR_NULL [things like (?(<name>... or (?('name')... or (?(R&name)... ] |
7015 | | we have now checked all the possibilities, so give an error. */ |
7016 | | |
7017 | 0 | else if (terminator != CHAR_NULL) |
7018 | 0 | { |
7019 | 0 | *errorcodeptr = ERR15; |
7020 | 0 | goto FAILED; |
7021 | 0 | } |
7022 | | |
7023 | | /* Check for (?(R) for recursion. Allow digits after R to specify a |
7024 | | specific group number. */ |
7025 | | |
7026 | 0 | else if (*name == CHAR_R) |
7027 | 0 | { |
7028 | 0 | recno = 0; |
7029 | 0 | for (i = 1; i < namelen; i++) |
7030 | 0 | { |
7031 | 0 | if (!IS_DIGIT(name[i])) |
7032 | 0 | { |
7033 | 0 | *errorcodeptr = ERR15; |
7034 | 0 | goto FAILED; |
7035 | 0 | } |
7036 | 0 | if (recno > INT_MAX / 10 - 1) /* Integer overflow */ |
7037 | 0 | { |
7038 | 0 | *errorcodeptr = ERR61; |
7039 | 0 | goto FAILED; |
7040 | 0 | } |
7041 | 0 | recno = recno * 10 + name[i] - CHAR_0; |
7042 | 0 | } |
7043 | 0 | if (recno == 0) recno = RREF_ANY; |
7044 | 0 | code[1+LINK_SIZE] = OP_RREF; /* Change test type */ |
7045 | 0 | PUT2(code, 2+LINK_SIZE, recno); |
7046 | 0 | } |
7047 | | |
7048 | | /* Similarly, check for the (?(DEFINE) "condition", which is always |
7049 | | false. */ |
7050 | | |
7051 | 0 | else if (namelen == 6 && STRNCMP_UC_C8(name, STRING_DEFINE, 6) == 0) |
7052 | 0 | { |
7053 | 0 | code[1+LINK_SIZE] = OP_DEF; |
7054 | 0 | skipbytes = 1; |
7055 | 0 | } |
7056 | | |
7057 | | /* Reference to an unidentified subpattern. */ |
7058 | | |
7059 | 0 | else |
7060 | 0 | { |
7061 | 0 | *errorcodeptr = ERR15; |
7062 | 0 | goto FAILED; |
7063 | 0 | } |
7064 | 0 | break; |
7065 | | |
7066 | | |
7067 | | /* ------------------------------------------------------------ */ |
7068 | 0 | case CHAR_EQUALS_SIGN: /* Positive lookahead */ |
7069 | 0 | bravalue = OP_ASSERT; |
7070 | 0 | cd->assert_depth += 1; |
7071 | 0 | ptr++; |
7072 | 0 | break; |
7073 | | |
7074 | | /* Optimize (?!) to (*FAIL) unless it is quantified - which is a weird |
7075 | | thing to do, but Perl allows all assertions to be quantified, and when |
7076 | | they contain capturing parentheses there may be a potential use for |
7077 | | this feature. Not that that applies to a quantified (?!) but we allow |
7078 | | it for uniformity. */ |
7079 | | |
7080 | | /* ------------------------------------------------------------ */ |
7081 | 0 | case CHAR_EXCLAMATION_MARK: /* Negative lookahead */ |
7082 | 0 | ptr++; |
7083 | 0 | if (*ptr == CHAR_RIGHT_PARENTHESIS && ptr[1] != CHAR_ASTERISK && |
7084 | 0 | ptr[1] != CHAR_PLUS && ptr[1] != CHAR_QUESTION_MARK && |
7085 | 0 | (ptr[1] != CHAR_LEFT_CURLY_BRACKET || !is_counted_repeat(ptr+2))) |
7086 | 0 | { |
7087 | 0 | *code++ = OP_FAIL; |
7088 | 0 | previous = NULL; |
7089 | 0 | continue; |
7090 | 0 | } |
7091 | 0 | bravalue = OP_ASSERT_NOT; |
7092 | 0 | cd->assert_depth += 1; |
7093 | 0 | break; |
7094 | | |
7095 | | |
7096 | | /* ------------------------------------------------------------ */ |
7097 | 0 | case CHAR_LESS_THAN_SIGN: /* Lookbehind or named define */ |
7098 | 0 | switch (ptr[1]) |
7099 | 0 | { |
7100 | 0 | case CHAR_EQUALS_SIGN: /* Positive lookbehind */ |
7101 | 0 | bravalue = OP_ASSERTBACK; |
7102 | 0 | cd->assert_depth += 1; |
7103 | 0 | ptr += 2; |
7104 | 0 | break; |
7105 | | |
7106 | 0 | case CHAR_EXCLAMATION_MARK: /* Negative lookbehind */ |
7107 | 0 | bravalue = OP_ASSERTBACK_NOT; |
7108 | 0 | cd->assert_depth += 1; |
7109 | 0 | ptr += 2; |
7110 | 0 | break; |
7111 | | |
7112 | 0 | default: /* Could be name define, else bad */ |
7113 | 0 | if (MAX_255(ptr[1]) && (cd->ctypes[ptr[1]] & ctype_word) != 0) |
7114 | 0 | goto DEFINE_NAME; |
7115 | 0 | ptr++; /* Correct offset for error */ |
7116 | 0 | *errorcodeptr = ERR24; |
7117 | 0 | goto FAILED; |
7118 | 0 | } |
7119 | 0 | break; |
7120 | | |
7121 | | |
7122 | | /* ------------------------------------------------------------ */ |
7123 | 0 | case CHAR_GREATER_THAN_SIGN: /* One-time brackets */ |
7124 | 0 | bravalue = OP_ONCE; |
7125 | 0 | ptr++; |
7126 | 0 | break; |
7127 | | |
7128 | | |
7129 | | /* ------------------------------------------------------------ */ |
7130 | 0 | case CHAR_C: /* Callout - may be followed by digits; */ |
7131 | 0 | previous_callout = code; /* Save for later completion */ |
7132 | 0 | after_manual_callout = 1; /* Skip one item before completing */ |
7133 | 0 | *code++ = OP_CALLOUT; |
7134 | 0 | { |
7135 | 0 | int n = 0; |
7136 | 0 | ptr++; |
7137 | 0 | while(IS_DIGIT(*ptr)) |
7138 | 0 | { |
7139 | 0 | n = n * 10 + *ptr++ - CHAR_0; |
7140 | 0 | if (n > 255) |
7141 | 0 | { |
7142 | 0 | *errorcodeptr = ERR38; |
7143 | 0 | goto FAILED; |
7144 | 0 | } |
7145 | 0 | } |
7146 | 0 | if (*ptr != CHAR_RIGHT_PARENTHESIS) |
7147 | 0 | { |
7148 | 0 | *errorcodeptr = ERR39; |
7149 | 0 | goto FAILED; |
7150 | 0 | } |
7151 | 0 | *code++ = n; |
7152 | 0 | PUT(code, 0, (int)(ptr - cd->start_pattern + 1)); /* Pattern offset */ |
7153 | 0 | PUT(code, LINK_SIZE, 0); /* Default length */ |
7154 | 0 | code += 2 * LINK_SIZE; |
7155 | 0 | } |
7156 | 0 | previous = NULL; |
7157 | 0 | continue; |
7158 | | |
7159 | | |
7160 | | /* ------------------------------------------------------------ */ |
7161 | 0 | case CHAR_P: /* Python-style named subpattern handling */ |
7162 | 0 | if (*(++ptr) == CHAR_EQUALS_SIGN || |
7163 | 0 | *ptr == CHAR_GREATER_THAN_SIGN) /* Reference or recursion */ |
7164 | 0 | { |
7165 | 0 | is_recurse = *ptr == CHAR_GREATER_THAN_SIGN; |
7166 | 0 | terminator = CHAR_RIGHT_PARENTHESIS; |
7167 | 0 | goto NAMED_REF_OR_RECURSE; |
7168 | 0 | } |
7169 | 0 | else if (*ptr != CHAR_LESS_THAN_SIGN) /* Test for Python-style defn */ |
7170 | 0 | { |
7171 | 0 | *errorcodeptr = ERR41; |
7172 | 0 | goto FAILED; |
7173 | 0 | } |
7174 | | /* Fall through to handle (?P< as (?< is handled */ |
7175 | | |
7176 | | |
7177 | | /* ------------------------------------------------------------ */ |
7178 | 0 | DEFINE_NAME: /* Come here from (?< handling */ |
7179 | 0 | case CHAR_APOSTROPHE: |
7180 | 0 | terminator = (*ptr == CHAR_LESS_THAN_SIGN)? |
7181 | 0 | CHAR_GREATER_THAN_SIGN : CHAR_APOSTROPHE; |
7182 | 0 | name = ++ptr; |
7183 | 0 | if (IS_DIGIT(*ptr)) |
7184 | 0 | { |
7185 | 0 | *errorcodeptr = ERR84; /* Group name must start with non-digit */ |
7186 | 0 | goto FAILED; |
7187 | 0 | } |
7188 | 0 | while (MAX_255(*ptr) && (cd->ctypes[*ptr] & ctype_word) != 0) ptr++; |
7189 | 0 | namelen = (int)(ptr - name); |
7190 | | |
7191 | | /* In the pre-compile phase, do a syntax check, remember the longest |
7192 | | name, and then remember the group in a vector, expanding it if |
7193 | | necessary. Duplicates for the same number are skipped; other duplicates |
7194 | | are checked for validity. In the actual compile, there is nothing to |
7195 | | do. */ |
7196 | |
|
7197 | 0 | if (lengthptr != NULL) |
7198 | 0 | { |
7199 | 0 | named_group *ng; |
7200 | 0 | pcre_uint32 number = cd->bracount + 1; |
7201 | |
|
7202 | 0 | if (*ptr != (pcre_uchar)terminator) |
7203 | 0 | { |
7204 | 0 | *errorcodeptr = ERR42; |
7205 | 0 | goto FAILED; |
7206 | 0 | } |
7207 | | |
7208 | 0 | if (cd->names_found >= MAX_NAME_COUNT) |
7209 | 0 | { |
7210 | 0 | *errorcodeptr = ERR49; |
7211 | 0 | goto FAILED; |
7212 | 0 | } |
7213 | | |
7214 | 0 | if (namelen + IMM2_SIZE + 1 > cd->name_entry_size) |
7215 | 0 | { |
7216 | 0 | cd->name_entry_size = namelen + IMM2_SIZE + 1; |
7217 | 0 | if (namelen > MAX_NAME_SIZE) |
7218 | 0 | { |
7219 | 0 | *errorcodeptr = ERR48; |
7220 | 0 | goto FAILED; |
7221 | 0 | } |
7222 | 0 | } |
7223 | | |
7224 | | /* Scan the list to check for duplicates. For duplicate names, if the |
7225 | | number is the same, break the loop, which causes the name to be |
7226 | | discarded; otherwise, if DUPNAMES is not set, give an error. |
7227 | | If it is set, allow the name with a different number, but continue |
7228 | | scanning in case this is a duplicate with the same number. For |
7229 | | non-duplicate names, give an error if the number is duplicated. */ |
7230 | | |
7231 | 0 | ng = cd->named_groups; |
7232 | 0 | for (i = 0; i < cd->names_found; i++, ng++) |
7233 | 0 | { |
7234 | 0 | if (namelen == ng->length && |
7235 | 0 | STRNCMP_UC_UC(name, ng->name, namelen) == 0) |
7236 | 0 | { |
7237 | 0 | if (ng->number == number) break; |
7238 | 0 | if ((options & PCRE_DUPNAMES) == 0) |
7239 | 0 | { |
7240 | 0 | *errorcodeptr = ERR43; |
7241 | 0 | goto FAILED; |
7242 | 0 | } |
7243 | 0 | cd->dupnames = TRUE; /* Duplicate names exist */ |
7244 | 0 | } |
7245 | 0 | else if (ng->number == number) |
7246 | 0 | { |
7247 | 0 | *errorcodeptr = ERR65; |
7248 | 0 | goto FAILED; |
7249 | 0 | } |
7250 | 0 | } |
7251 | | |
7252 | 0 | if (i >= cd->names_found) /* Not a duplicate with same number */ |
7253 | 0 | { |
7254 | | /* Increase the list size if necessary */ |
7255 | |
|
7256 | 0 | if (cd->names_found >= cd->named_group_list_size) |
7257 | 0 | { |
7258 | 0 | int newsize = cd->named_group_list_size * 2; |
7259 | 0 | named_group *newspace = (PUBL(malloc)) |
7260 | 0 | (newsize * sizeof(named_group)); |
7261 | |
|
7262 | 0 | if (newspace == NULL) |
7263 | 0 | { |
7264 | 0 | *errorcodeptr = ERR21; |
7265 | 0 | goto FAILED; |
7266 | 0 | } |
7267 | | |
7268 | 0 | memcpy(newspace, cd->named_groups, |
7269 | 0 | cd->named_group_list_size * sizeof(named_group)); |
7270 | 0 | if (cd->named_group_list_size > NAMED_GROUP_LIST_SIZE) |
7271 | 0 | (PUBL(free))((void *)cd->named_groups); |
7272 | 0 | cd->named_groups = newspace; |
7273 | 0 | cd->named_group_list_size = newsize; |
7274 | 0 | } |
7275 | | |
7276 | 0 | cd->named_groups[cd->names_found].name = name; |
7277 | 0 | cd->named_groups[cd->names_found].length = namelen; |
7278 | 0 | cd->named_groups[cd->names_found].number = number; |
7279 | 0 | cd->names_found++; |
7280 | 0 | } |
7281 | 0 | } |
7282 | | |
7283 | 0 | ptr++; /* Move past > or ' in both passes. */ |
7284 | 0 | goto NUMBERED_GROUP; |
7285 | | |
7286 | | |
7287 | | /* ------------------------------------------------------------ */ |
7288 | 0 | case CHAR_AMPERSAND: /* Perl recursion/subroutine syntax */ |
7289 | 0 | terminator = CHAR_RIGHT_PARENTHESIS; |
7290 | 0 | is_recurse = TRUE; |
7291 | | /* Fall through */ |
7292 | | |
7293 | | /* We come here from the Python syntax above that handles both |
7294 | | references (?P=name) and recursion (?P>name), as well as falling |
7295 | | through from the Perl recursion syntax (?&name). We also come here from |
7296 | | the Perl \k<name> or \k'name' back reference syntax and the \k{name} |
7297 | | .NET syntax, and the Oniguruma \g<...> and \g'...' subroutine syntax. */ |
7298 | |
|
7299 | 0 | NAMED_REF_OR_RECURSE: |
7300 | 0 | name = ++ptr; |
7301 | 0 | if (IS_DIGIT(*ptr)) |
7302 | 0 | { |
7303 | 0 | *errorcodeptr = ERR84; /* Group name must start with non-digit */ |
7304 | 0 | goto FAILED; |
7305 | 0 | } |
7306 | 0 | while (MAX_255(*ptr) && (cd->ctypes[*ptr] & ctype_word) != 0) ptr++; |
7307 | 0 | namelen = (int)(ptr - name); |
7308 | | |
7309 | | /* In the pre-compile phase, do a syntax check. We used to just set |
7310 | | a dummy reference number, because it was not used in the first pass. |
7311 | | However, with the change of recursive back references to be atomic, |
7312 | | we have to look for the number so that this state can be identified, as |
7313 | | otherwise the incorrect length is computed. If it's not a backwards |
7314 | | reference, the dummy number will do. */ |
7315 | |
|
7316 | 0 | if (lengthptr != NULL) |
7317 | 0 | { |
7318 | 0 | named_group *ng; |
7319 | 0 | recno = 0; |
7320 | |
|
7321 | 0 | if (namelen == 0) |
7322 | 0 | { |
7323 | 0 | *errorcodeptr = ERR62; |
7324 | 0 | goto FAILED; |
7325 | 0 | } |
7326 | 0 | if (*ptr != (pcre_uchar)terminator) |
7327 | 0 | { |
7328 | 0 | *errorcodeptr = ERR42; |
7329 | 0 | goto FAILED; |
7330 | 0 | } |
7331 | 0 | if (namelen > MAX_NAME_SIZE) |
7332 | 0 | { |
7333 | 0 | *errorcodeptr = ERR48; |
7334 | 0 | goto FAILED; |
7335 | 0 | } |
7336 | | |
7337 | | /* Count named back references. */ |
7338 | | |
7339 | 0 | if (!is_recurse) cd->namedrefcount++; |
7340 | | |
7341 | | /* We have to allow for a named reference to a duplicated name (this |
7342 | | cannot be determined until the second pass). This needs an extra |
7343 | | 16-bit data item. */ |
7344 | |
|
7345 | 0 | *lengthptr += IMM2_SIZE; |
7346 | | |
7347 | | /* If this is a forward reference and we are within a (?|...) group, |
7348 | | the reference may end up as the number of a group which we are |
7349 | | currently inside, that is, it could be a recursive reference. In the |
7350 | | real compile this will be picked up and the reference wrapped with |
7351 | | OP_ONCE to make it atomic, so we must space in case this occurs. */ |
7352 | | |
7353 | | /* In fact, this can happen for a non-forward reference because |
7354 | | another group with the same number might be created later. This |
7355 | | issue is fixed "properly" in PCRE2. As PCRE1 is now in maintenance |
7356 | | only mode, we finesse the bug by allowing more memory always. */ |
7357 | |
|
7358 | 0 | *lengthptr += 4 + 4*LINK_SIZE; |
7359 | | |
7360 | | /* It is even worse than that. The current reference may be to an |
7361 | | existing named group with a different number (so apparently not |
7362 | | recursive) but which later on is also attached to a group with the |
7363 | | current number. This can only happen if $(| has been previous |
7364 | | encountered. In that case, we allow yet more memory, just in case. |
7365 | | (Again, this is fixed "properly" in PCRE2. */ |
7366 | |
|
7367 | 0 | if (cd->dupgroups) *lengthptr += 4 + 4*LINK_SIZE; |
7368 | | |
7369 | | /* Otherwise, check for recursion here. The name table does not exist |
7370 | | in the first pass; instead we must scan the list of names encountered |
7371 | | so far in order to get the number. If the name is not found, leave |
7372 | | the value of recno as 0 for a forward reference. */ |
7373 | | |
7374 | | /* This patch (removing "else") fixes a problem when a reference is |
7375 | | to multiple identically named nested groups from within the nest. |
7376 | | Once again, it is not the "proper" fix, and it results in an |
7377 | | over-allocation of memory. */ |
7378 | | |
7379 | | /* else */ |
7380 | 0 | { |
7381 | 0 | ng = cd->named_groups; |
7382 | 0 | for (i = 0; i < cd->names_found; i++, ng++) |
7383 | 0 | { |
7384 | 0 | if (namelen == ng->length && |
7385 | 0 | STRNCMP_UC_UC(name, ng->name, namelen) == 0) |
7386 | 0 | { |
7387 | 0 | open_capitem *oc; |
7388 | 0 | recno = ng->number; |
7389 | 0 | if (is_recurse) break; |
7390 | 0 | for (oc = cd->open_caps; oc != NULL; oc = oc->next) |
7391 | 0 | { |
7392 | 0 | if (oc->number == recno) |
7393 | 0 | { |
7394 | 0 | oc->flag = TRUE; |
7395 | 0 | break; |
7396 | 0 | } |
7397 | 0 | } |
7398 | 0 | } |
7399 | 0 | } |
7400 | 0 | } |
7401 | 0 | } |
7402 | | |
7403 | | /* In the real compile, search the name table. We check the name |
7404 | | first, and then check that we have reached the end of the name in the |
7405 | | table. That way, if the name is longer than any in the table, the |
7406 | | comparison will fail without reading beyond the table entry. */ |
7407 | | |
7408 | 0 | else |
7409 | 0 | { |
7410 | 0 | slot = cd->name_table; |
7411 | 0 | for (i = 0; i < cd->names_found; i++) |
7412 | 0 | { |
7413 | 0 | if (STRNCMP_UC_UC(name, slot+IMM2_SIZE, namelen) == 0 && |
7414 | 0 | slot[IMM2_SIZE+namelen] == 0) |
7415 | 0 | break; |
7416 | 0 | slot += cd->name_entry_size; |
7417 | 0 | } |
7418 | |
|
7419 | 0 | if (i < cd->names_found) |
7420 | 0 | { |
7421 | 0 | recno = GET2(slot, 0); |
7422 | 0 | } |
7423 | 0 | else |
7424 | 0 | { |
7425 | 0 | *errorcodeptr = ERR15; |
7426 | 0 | goto FAILED; |
7427 | 0 | } |
7428 | 0 | } |
7429 | | |
7430 | | /* In both phases, for recursions, we can now go to the code than |
7431 | | handles numerical recursion. */ |
7432 | | |
7433 | 0 | if (is_recurse) goto HANDLE_RECURSION; |
7434 | | |
7435 | | /* In the second pass we must see if the name is duplicated. If so, we |
7436 | | generate a different opcode. */ |
7437 | | |
7438 | 0 | if (lengthptr == NULL && cd->dupnames) |
7439 | 0 | { |
7440 | 0 | int count = 1; |
7441 | 0 | unsigned int index = i; |
7442 | 0 | pcre_uchar *cslot = slot + cd->name_entry_size; |
7443 | |
|
7444 | 0 | for (i++; i < cd->names_found; i++) |
7445 | 0 | { |
7446 | 0 | if (STRCMP_UC_UC(slot + IMM2_SIZE, cslot + IMM2_SIZE) != 0) break; |
7447 | 0 | count++; |
7448 | 0 | cslot += cd->name_entry_size; |
7449 | 0 | } |
7450 | |
|
7451 | 0 | if (count > 1) |
7452 | 0 | { |
7453 | 0 | if (firstcharflags == REQ_UNSET) firstcharflags = REQ_NONE; |
7454 | 0 | previous = code; |
7455 | 0 | item_hwm_offset = cd->hwm - cd->start_workspace; |
7456 | 0 | *code++ = ((options & PCRE_CASELESS) != 0)? OP_DNREFI : OP_DNREF; |
7457 | 0 | PUT2INC(code, 0, index); |
7458 | 0 | PUT2INC(code, 0, count); |
7459 | | |
7460 | | /* Process each potentially referenced group. */ |
7461 | |
|
7462 | 0 | for (; slot < cslot; slot += cd->name_entry_size) |
7463 | 0 | { |
7464 | 0 | open_capitem *oc; |
7465 | 0 | recno = GET2(slot, 0); |
7466 | 0 | cd->backref_map |= (recno < 32)? (1U << recno) : 1; |
7467 | 0 | if (recno > cd->top_backref) cd->top_backref = recno; |
7468 | | |
7469 | | /* Check to see if this back reference is recursive, that it, it |
7470 | | is inside the group that it references. A flag is set so that the |
7471 | | group can be made atomic. */ |
7472 | |
|
7473 | 0 | for (oc = cd->open_caps; oc != NULL; oc = oc->next) |
7474 | 0 | { |
7475 | 0 | if (oc->number == recno) |
7476 | 0 | { |
7477 | 0 | oc->flag = TRUE; |
7478 | 0 | break; |
7479 | 0 | } |
7480 | 0 | } |
7481 | 0 | } |
7482 | |
|
7483 | 0 | continue; /* End of back ref handling */ |
7484 | 0 | } |
7485 | 0 | } |
7486 | | |
7487 | | /* First pass, or a non-duplicated name. */ |
7488 | | |
7489 | 0 | goto HANDLE_REFERENCE; |
7490 | | |
7491 | | |
7492 | | /* ------------------------------------------------------------ */ |
7493 | 0 | case CHAR_R: /* Recursion, same as (?0) */ |
7494 | 0 | recno = 0; |
7495 | 0 | if (*(++ptr) != CHAR_RIGHT_PARENTHESIS) |
7496 | 0 | { |
7497 | 0 | *errorcodeptr = ERR29; |
7498 | 0 | goto FAILED; |
7499 | 0 | } |
7500 | 0 | goto HANDLE_RECURSION; |
7501 | | |
7502 | | |
7503 | | /* ------------------------------------------------------------ */ |
7504 | 0 | case CHAR_MINUS: case CHAR_PLUS: /* Recursion or subroutine */ |
7505 | 0 | case CHAR_0: case CHAR_1: case CHAR_2: case CHAR_3: case CHAR_4: |
7506 | 0 | case CHAR_5: case CHAR_6: case CHAR_7: case CHAR_8: case CHAR_9: |
7507 | 0 | { |
7508 | 0 | const pcre_uchar *called; |
7509 | 0 | terminator = CHAR_RIGHT_PARENTHESIS; |
7510 | | |
7511 | | /* Come here from the \g<...> and \g'...' code (Oniguruma |
7512 | | compatibility). However, the syntax has been checked to ensure that |
7513 | | the ... are a (signed) number, so that neither ERR63 nor ERR29 will |
7514 | | be called on this path, nor with the jump to OTHER_CHAR_AFTER_QUERY |
7515 | | ever be taken. */ |
7516 | |
|
7517 | 0 | HANDLE_NUMERICAL_RECURSION: |
7518 | |
|
7519 | 0 | if ((refsign = *ptr) == CHAR_PLUS) |
7520 | 0 | { |
7521 | 0 | ptr++; |
7522 | 0 | if (!IS_DIGIT(*ptr)) |
7523 | 0 | { |
7524 | 0 | *errorcodeptr = ERR63; |
7525 | 0 | goto FAILED; |
7526 | 0 | } |
7527 | 0 | } |
7528 | 0 | else if (refsign == CHAR_MINUS) |
7529 | 0 | { |
7530 | 0 | if (!IS_DIGIT(ptr[1])) |
7531 | 0 | goto OTHER_CHAR_AFTER_QUERY; |
7532 | 0 | ptr++; |
7533 | 0 | } |
7534 | | |
7535 | 0 | recno = 0; |
7536 | 0 | while(IS_DIGIT(*ptr)) |
7537 | 0 | { |
7538 | 0 | if (recno > INT_MAX / 10 - 1) /* Integer overflow */ |
7539 | 0 | { |
7540 | 0 | while (IS_DIGIT(*ptr)) ptr++; |
7541 | 0 | *errorcodeptr = ERR61; |
7542 | 0 | goto FAILED; |
7543 | 0 | } |
7544 | 0 | recno = recno * 10 + *ptr++ - CHAR_0; |
7545 | 0 | } |
7546 | | |
7547 | 0 | if (*ptr != (pcre_uchar)terminator) |
7548 | 0 | { |
7549 | 0 | *errorcodeptr = ERR29; |
7550 | 0 | goto FAILED; |
7551 | 0 | } |
7552 | | |
7553 | 0 | if (refsign == CHAR_MINUS) |
7554 | 0 | { |
7555 | 0 | if (recno == 0) |
7556 | 0 | { |
7557 | 0 | *errorcodeptr = ERR58; |
7558 | 0 | goto FAILED; |
7559 | 0 | } |
7560 | 0 | recno = cd->bracount - recno + 1; |
7561 | 0 | if (recno <= 0) |
7562 | 0 | { |
7563 | 0 | *errorcodeptr = ERR15; |
7564 | 0 | goto FAILED; |
7565 | 0 | } |
7566 | 0 | } |
7567 | 0 | else if (refsign == CHAR_PLUS) |
7568 | 0 | { |
7569 | 0 | if (recno == 0) |
7570 | 0 | { |
7571 | 0 | *errorcodeptr = ERR58; |
7572 | 0 | goto FAILED; |
7573 | 0 | } |
7574 | 0 | recno += cd->bracount; |
7575 | 0 | } |
7576 | | |
7577 | | /* Come here from code above that handles a named recursion */ |
7578 | | |
7579 | 0 | HANDLE_RECURSION: |
7580 | |
|
7581 | 0 | previous = code; |
7582 | 0 | item_hwm_offset = cd->hwm - cd->start_workspace; |
7583 | 0 | called = cd->start_code; |
7584 | | |
7585 | | /* When we are actually compiling, find the bracket that is being |
7586 | | referenced. Temporarily end the regex in case it doesn't exist before |
7587 | | this point. If we end up with a forward reference, first check that |
7588 | | the bracket does occur later so we can give the error (and position) |
7589 | | now. Then remember this forward reference in the workspace so it can |
7590 | | be filled in at the end. */ |
7591 | |
|
7592 | 0 | if (lengthptr == NULL) |
7593 | 0 | { |
7594 | 0 | *code = OP_END; |
7595 | 0 | if (recno != 0) |
7596 | 0 | called = PRIV(find_bracket)(cd->start_code, utf, recno); |
7597 | | |
7598 | | /* Forward reference */ |
7599 | |
|
7600 | 0 | if (called == NULL) |
7601 | 0 | { |
7602 | 0 | if (recno > cd->final_bracount) |
7603 | 0 | { |
7604 | 0 | *errorcodeptr = ERR15; |
7605 | 0 | goto FAILED; |
7606 | 0 | } |
7607 | | |
7608 | | /* Fudge the value of "called" so that when it is inserted as an |
7609 | | offset below, what it actually inserted is the reference number |
7610 | | of the group. Then remember the forward reference. */ |
7611 | | |
7612 | 0 | called = cd->start_code + recno; |
7613 | 0 | if (cd->hwm >= cd->start_workspace + cd->workspace_size - |
7614 | 0 | WORK_SIZE_SAFETY_MARGIN) |
7615 | 0 | { |
7616 | 0 | *errorcodeptr = expand_workspace(cd); |
7617 | 0 | if (*errorcodeptr != 0) goto FAILED; |
7618 | 0 | } |
7619 | 0 | PUTINC(cd->hwm, 0, (int)(code + 1 - cd->start_code)); |
7620 | 0 | } |
7621 | | |
7622 | | /* If not a forward reference, and the subpattern is still open, |
7623 | | this is a recursive call. We check to see if this is a left |
7624 | | recursion that could loop for ever, and diagnose that case. We |
7625 | | must not, however, do this check if we are in a conditional |
7626 | | subpattern because the condition might be testing for recursion in |
7627 | | a pattern such as /(?(R)a+|(?R)b)/, which is perfectly valid. |
7628 | | Forever loops are also detected at runtime, so those that occur in |
7629 | | conditional subpatterns will be picked up then. */ |
7630 | | |
7631 | 0 | else if (GET(called, 1) == 0 && cond_depth <= 0 && |
7632 | 0 | could_be_empty(called, code, bcptr, utf, cd)) |
7633 | 0 | { |
7634 | 0 | *errorcodeptr = ERR40; |
7635 | 0 | goto FAILED; |
7636 | 0 | } |
7637 | 0 | } |
7638 | | |
7639 | | /* Insert the recursion/subroutine item. It does not have a set first |
7640 | | character (relevant if it is repeated, because it will then be |
7641 | | wrapped with ONCE brackets). */ |
7642 | | |
7643 | 0 | *code = OP_RECURSE; |
7644 | 0 | PUT(code, 1, (int)(called - cd->start_code)); |
7645 | 0 | code += 1 + LINK_SIZE; |
7646 | 0 | groupsetfirstchar = FALSE; |
7647 | 0 | } |
7648 | | |
7649 | | /* Can't determine a first byte now */ |
7650 | | |
7651 | 0 | if (firstcharflags == REQ_UNSET) firstcharflags = REQ_NONE; |
7652 | 0 | zerofirstchar = firstchar; |
7653 | 0 | zerofirstcharflags = firstcharflags; |
7654 | 0 | continue; |
7655 | | |
7656 | | |
7657 | | /* ------------------------------------------------------------ */ |
7658 | 0 | default: /* Other characters: check option setting */ |
7659 | 0 | OTHER_CHAR_AFTER_QUERY: |
7660 | 0 | set = unset = 0; |
7661 | 0 | optset = &set; |
7662 | |
|
7663 | 0 | while (*ptr != CHAR_RIGHT_PARENTHESIS && *ptr != CHAR_COLON) |
7664 | 0 | { |
7665 | 0 | switch (*ptr++) |
7666 | 0 | { |
7667 | 0 | case CHAR_MINUS: optset = &unset; break; |
7668 | | |
7669 | 0 | case CHAR_J: /* Record that it changed in the external options */ |
7670 | 0 | *optset |= PCRE_DUPNAMES; |
7671 | 0 | cd->external_flags |= PCRE_JCHANGED; |
7672 | 0 | break; |
7673 | | |
7674 | 0 | case CHAR_i: *optset |= PCRE_CASELESS; break; |
7675 | 0 | case CHAR_m: *optset |= PCRE_MULTILINE; break; |
7676 | 0 | case CHAR_s: *optset |= PCRE_DOTALL; break; |
7677 | 0 | case CHAR_x: *optset |= PCRE_EXTENDED; break; |
7678 | 0 | case CHAR_U: *optset |= PCRE_UNGREEDY; break; |
7679 | 0 | case CHAR_X: *optset |= PCRE_EXTRA; break; |
7680 | | |
7681 | 0 | default: *errorcodeptr = ERR12; |
7682 | 0 | ptr--; /* Correct the offset */ |
7683 | 0 | goto FAILED; |
7684 | 0 | } |
7685 | 0 | } |
7686 | | |
7687 | | /* Set up the changed option bits, but don't change anything yet. */ |
7688 | | |
7689 | 0 | newoptions = (options | set) & (~unset); |
7690 | | |
7691 | | /* If the options ended with ')' this is not the start of a nested |
7692 | | group with option changes, so the options change at this level. |
7693 | | If we are not at the pattern start, reset the greedy defaults and the |
7694 | | case value for firstchar and reqchar. */ |
7695 | |
|
7696 | 0 | if (*ptr == CHAR_RIGHT_PARENTHESIS) |
7697 | 0 | { |
7698 | 0 | greedy_default = ((newoptions & PCRE_UNGREEDY) != 0); |
7699 | 0 | greedy_non_default = greedy_default ^ 1; |
7700 | 0 | req_caseopt = ((newoptions & PCRE_CASELESS) != 0)? REQ_CASELESS:0; |
7701 | | |
7702 | | /* Change options at this level, and pass them back for use |
7703 | | in subsequent branches. */ |
7704 | |
|
7705 | 0 | *optionsptr = options = newoptions; |
7706 | 0 | previous = NULL; /* This item can't be repeated */ |
7707 | 0 | continue; /* It is complete */ |
7708 | 0 | } |
7709 | | |
7710 | | /* If the options ended with ':' we are heading into a nested group |
7711 | | with possible change of options. Such groups are non-capturing and are |
7712 | | not assertions of any kind. All we need to do is skip over the ':'; |
7713 | | the newoptions value is handled below. */ |
7714 | | |
7715 | 0 | bravalue = OP_BRA; |
7716 | 0 | ptr++; |
7717 | 0 | } /* End of switch for character following (? */ |
7718 | 0 | } /* End of (? handling */ |
7719 | | |
7720 | | /* Opening parenthesis not followed by '*' or '?'. If PCRE_NO_AUTO_CAPTURE |
7721 | | is set, all unadorned brackets become non-capturing and behave like (?:...) |
7722 | | brackets. */ |
7723 | | |
7724 | 0 | else if ((options & PCRE_NO_AUTO_CAPTURE) != 0) |
7725 | 0 | { |
7726 | 0 | bravalue = OP_BRA; |
7727 | 0 | } |
7728 | | |
7729 | | /* Else we have a capturing group. */ |
7730 | | |
7731 | 0 | else |
7732 | 0 | { |
7733 | 0 | NUMBERED_GROUP: |
7734 | 0 | cd->bracount += 1; |
7735 | 0 | PUT2(code, 1+LINK_SIZE, cd->bracount); |
7736 | 0 | skipbytes = IMM2_SIZE; |
7737 | 0 | } |
7738 | | |
7739 | | /* Process nested bracketed regex. First check for parentheses nested too |
7740 | | deeply. */ |
7741 | | |
7742 | 0 | if ((cd->parens_depth += 1) > PARENS_NEST_LIMIT) |
7743 | 0 | { |
7744 | 0 | *errorcodeptr = ERR82; |
7745 | 0 | goto FAILED; |
7746 | 0 | } |
7747 | | |
7748 | | /* All assertions used not to be repeatable, but this was changed for Perl |
7749 | | compatibility. All kinds can now be repeated except for assertions that are |
7750 | | conditions (Perl also forbids these to be repeated). We copy code into a |
7751 | | non-register variable (tempcode) in order to be able to pass its address |
7752 | | because some compilers complain otherwise. At the start of a conditional |
7753 | | group whose condition is an assertion, cd->iscondassert is set. We unset it |
7754 | | here so as to allow assertions later in the group to be quantified. */ |
7755 | | |
7756 | 0 | if (bravalue >= OP_ASSERT && bravalue <= OP_ASSERTBACK_NOT && |
7757 | 0 | cd->iscondassert) |
7758 | 0 | { |
7759 | 0 | previous = NULL; |
7760 | 0 | cd->iscondassert = FALSE; |
7761 | 0 | } |
7762 | 0 | else |
7763 | 0 | { |
7764 | 0 | previous = code; |
7765 | 0 | item_hwm_offset = cd->hwm - cd->start_workspace; |
7766 | 0 | } |
7767 | |
|
7768 | 0 | *code = bravalue; |
7769 | 0 | tempcode = code; |
7770 | 0 | tempreqvary = cd->req_varyopt; /* Save value before bracket */ |
7771 | 0 | tempbracount = cd->bracount; /* Save value before bracket */ |
7772 | 0 | length_prevgroup = 0; /* Initialize for pre-compile phase */ |
7773 | |
|
7774 | 0 | if (!compile_regex( |
7775 | 0 | newoptions, /* The complete new option state */ |
7776 | 0 | &tempcode, /* Where to put code (updated) */ |
7777 | 0 | &ptr, /* Input pointer (updated) */ |
7778 | 0 | errorcodeptr, /* Where to put an error message */ |
7779 | 0 | (bravalue == OP_ASSERTBACK || |
7780 | 0 | bravalue == OP_ASSERTBACK_NOT), /* TRUE if back assert */ |
7781 | 0 | reset_bracount, /* True if (?| group */ |
7782 | 0 | skipbytes, /* Skip over bracket number */ |
7783 | 0 | cond_depth + |
7784 | 0 | ((bravalue == OP_COND)?1:0), /* Depth of condition subpatterns */ |
7785 | 0 | &subfirstchar, /* For possible first char */ |
7786 | 0 | &subfirstcharflags, |
7787 | 0 | &subreqchar, /* For possible last char */ |
7788 | 0 | &subreqcharflags, |
7789 | 0 | bcptr, /* Current branch chain */ |
7790 | 0 | cd, /* Tables block */ |
7791 | 0 | (lengthptr == NULL)? NULL : /* Actual compile phase */ |
7792 | 0 | &length_prevgroup /* Pre-compile phase */ |
7793 | 0 | )) |
7794 | 0 | goto FAILED; |
7795 | | |
7796 | 0 | cd->parens_depth -= 1; |
7797 | | |
7798 | | /* If this was an atomic group and there are no capturing groups within it, |
7799 | | generate OP_ONCE_NC instead of OP_ONCE. */ |
7800 | |
|
7801 | 0 | if (bravalue == OP_ONCE && cd->bracount <= tempbracount) |
7802 | 0 | *code = OP_ONCE_NC; |
7803 | |
|
7804 | 0 | if (bravalue >= OP_ASSERT && bravalue <= OP_ASSERTBACK_NOT) |
7805 | 0 | cd->assert_depth -= 1; |
7806 | | |
7807 | | /* At the end of compiling, code is still pointing to the start of the |
7808 | | group, while tempcode has been updated to point past the end of the group. |
7809 | | The pattern pointer (ptr) is on the bracket. |
7810 | | |
7811 | | If this is a conditional bracket, check that there are no more than |
7812 | | two branches in the group, or just one if it's a DEFINE group. We do this |
7813 | | in the real compile phase, not in the pre-pass, where the whole group may |
7814 | | not be available. */ |
7815 | |
|
7816 | 0 | if (bravalue == OP_COND && lengthptr == NULL) |
7817 | 0 | { |
7818 | 0 | pcre_uchar *tc = code; |
7819 | 0 | int condcount = 0; |
7820 | |
|
7821 | 0 | do { |
7822 | 0 | condcount++; |
7823 | 0 | tc += GET(tc,1); |
7824 | 0 | } |
7825 | 0 | while (*tc != OP_KET); |
7826 | | |
7827 | | /* A DEFINE group is never obeyed inline (the "condition" is always |
7828 | | false). It must have only one branch. */ |
7829 | |
|
7830 | 0 | if (code[LINK_SIZE+1] == OP_DEF) |
7831 | 0 | { |
7832 | 0 | if (condcount > 1) |
7833 | 0 | { |
7834 | 0 | *errorcodeptr = ERR54; |
7835 | 0 | goto FAILED; |
7836 | 0 | } |
7837 | 0 | bravalue = OP_DEF; /* Just a flag to suppress char handling below */ |
7838 | 0 | } |
7839 | | |
7840 | | /* A "normal" conditional group. If there is just one branch, we must not |
7841 | | make use of its firstchar or reqchar, because this is equivalent to an |
7842 | | empty second branch. */ |
7843 | | |
7844 | 0 | else |
7845 | 0 | { |
7846 | 0 | if (condcount > 2) |
7847 | 0 | { |
7848 | 0 | *errorcodeptr = ERR27; |
7849 | 0 | goto FAILED; |
7850 | 0 | } |
7851 | 0 | if (condcount == 1) subfirstcharflags = subreqcharflags = REQ_NONE; |
7852 | 0 | } |
7853 | 0 | } |
7854 | | |
7855 | | /* Error if hit end of pattern */ |
7856 | | |
7857 | 0 | if (*ptr != CHAR_RIGHT_PARENTHESIS) |
7858 | 0 | { |
7859 | 0 | *errorcodeptr = ERR14; |
7860 | 0 | goto FAILED; |
7861 | 0 | } |
7862 | | |
7863 | | /* In the pre-compile phase, update the length by the length of the group, |
7864 | | less the brackets at either end. Then reduce the compiled code to just a |
7865 | | set of non-capturing brackets so that it doesn't use much memory if it is |
7866 | | duplicated by a quantifier.*/ |
7867 | | |
7868 | 0 | if (lengthptr != NULL) |
7869 | 0 | { |
7870 | 0 | if (OFLOW_MAX - *lengthptr < length_prevgroup - 2 - 2*LINK_SIZE) |
7871 | 0 | { |
7872 | 0 | *errorcodeptr = ERR20; |
7873 | 0 | goto FAILED; |
7874 | 0 | } |
7875 | 0 | *lengthptr += length_prevgroup - 2 - 2*LINK_SIZE; |
7876 | 0 | code++; /* This already contains bravalue */ |
7877 | 0 | PUTINC(code, 0, 1 + LINK_SIZE); |
7878 | 0 | *code++ = OP_KET; |
7879 | 0 | PUTINC(code, 0, 1 + LINK_SIZE); |
7880 | 0 | break; /* No need to waste time with special character handling */ |
7881 | 0 | } |
7882 | | |
7883 | | /* Otherwise update the main code pointer to the end of the group. */ |
7884 | | |
7885 | 0 | code = tempcode; |
7886 | | |
7887 | | /* For a DEFINE group, required and first character settings are not |
7888 | | relevant. */ |
7889 | |
|
7890 | 0 | if (bravalue == OP_DEF) break; |
7891 | | |
7892 | | /* Handle updating of the required and first characters for other types of |
7893 | | group. Update for normal brackets of all kinds, and conditions with two |
7894 | | branches (see code above). If the bracket is followed by a quantifier with |
7895 | | zero repeat, we have to back off. Hence the definition of zeroreqchar and |
7896 | | zerofirstchar outside the main loop so that they can be accessed for the |
7897 | | back off. */ |
7898 | | |
7899 | 0 | zeroreqchar = reqchar; |
7900 | 0 | zeroreqcharflags = reqcharflags; |
7901 | 0 | zerofirstchar = firstchar; |
7902 | 0 | zerofirstcharflags = firstcharflags; |
7903 | 0 | groupsetfirstchar = FALSE; |
7904 | |
|
7905 | 0 | if (bravalue >= OP_ONCE) |
7906 | 0 | { |
7907 | | /* If we have not yet set a firstchar in this branch, take it from the |
7908 | | subpattern, remembering that it was set here so that a repeat of more |
7909 | | than one can replicate it as reqchar if necessary. If the subpattern has |
7910 | | no firstchar, set "none" for the whole branch. In both cases, a zero |
7911 | | repeat forces firstchar to "none". */ |
7912 | |
|
7913 | 0 | if (firstcharflags == REQ_UNSET) |
7914 | 0 | { |
7915 | 0 | if (subfirstcharflags >= 0) |
7916 | 0 | { |
7917 | 0 | firstchar = subfirstchar; |
7918 | 0 | firstcharflags = subfirstcharflags; |
7919 | 0 | groupsetfirstchar = TRUE; |
7920 | 0 | } |
7921 | 0 | else firstcharflags = REQ_NONE; |
7922 | 0 | zerofirstcharflags = REQ_NONE; |
7923 | 0 | } |
7924 | | |
7925 | | /* If firstchar was previously set, convert the subpattern's firstchar |
7926 | | into reqchar if there wasn't one, using the vary flag that was in |
7927 | | existence beforehand. */ |
7928 | | |
7929 | 0 | else if (subfirstcharflags >= 0 && subreqcharflags < 0) |
7930 | 0 | { |
7931 | 0 | subreqchar = subfirstchar; |
7932 | 0 | subreqcharflags = subfirstcharflags | tempreqvary; |
7933 | 0 | } |
7934 | | |
7935 | | /* If the subpattern set a required byte (or set a first byte that isn't |
7936 | | really the first byte - see above), set it. */ |
7937 | |
|
7938 | 0 | if (subreqcharflags >= 0) |
7939 | 0 | { |
7940 | 0 | reqchar = subreqchar; |
7941 | 0 | reqcharflags = subreqcharflags; |
7942 | 0 | } |
7943 | 0 | } |
7944 | | |
7945 | | /* For a forward assertion, we take the reqchar, if set, provided that the |
7946 | | group has also set a first char. This can be helpful if the pattern that |
7947 | | follows the assertion doesn't set a different char. For example, it's |
7948 | | useful for /(?=abcde).+/. We can't set firstchar for an assertion, however |
7949 | | because it leads to incorrect effect for patterns such as /(?=a)a.+/ when |
7950 | | the "real" "a" would then become a reqchar instead of a firstchar. This is |
7951 | | overcome by a scan at the end if there's no firstchar, looking for an |
7952 | | asserted first char. */ |
7953 | | |
7954 | 0 | else if (bravalue == OP_ASSERT && subreqcharflags >= 0 && |
7955 | 0 | subfirstcharflags >= 0) |
7956 | 0 | { |
7957 | 0 | reqchar = subreqchar; |
7958 | 0 | reqcharflags = subreqcharflags; |
7959 | 0 | } |
7960 | 0 | break; /* End of processing '(' */ |
7961 | | |
7962 | | |
7963 | | /* ===================================================================*/ |
7964 | | /* Handle metasequences introduced by \. For ones like \d, the ESC_ values |
7965 | | are arranged to be the negation of the corresponding OP_values in the |
7966 | | default case when PCRE_UCP is not set. For the back references, the values |
7967 | | are negative the reference number. Only back references and those types |
7968 | | that consume a character may be repeated. We can test for values between |
7969 | | ESC_b and ESC_Z for the latter; this may have to change if any new ones are |
7970 | | ever created. */ |
7971 | | |
7972 | 0 | case CHAR_BACKSLASH: |
7973 | 0 | tempptr = ptr; |
7974 | 0 | escape = check_escape(&ptr, &ec, errorcodeptr, cd->bracount, options, FALSE); |
7975 | 0 | if (*errorcodeptr != 0) goto FAILED; |
7976 | | |
7977 | 0 | if (escape == 0) /* The escape coded a single character */ |
7978 | 0 | c = ec; |
7979 | 0 | else |
7980 | 0 | { |
7981 | | /* For metasequences that actually match a character, we disable the |
7982 | | setting of a first character if it hasn't already been set. */ |
7983 | |
|
7984 | 0 | if (firstcharflags == REQ_UNSET && escape > ESC_b && escape < ESC_Z) |
7985 | 0 | firstcharflags = REQ_NONE; |
7986 | | |
7987 | | /* Set values to reset to if this is followed by a zero repeat. */ |
7988 | |
|
7989 | 0 | zerofirstchar = firstchar; |
7990 | 0 | zerofirstcharflags = firstcharflags; |
7991 | 0 | zeroreqchar = reqchar; |
7992 | 0 | zeroreqcharflags = reqcharflags; |
7993 | | |
7994 | | /* \g<name> or \g'name' is a subroutine call by name and \g<n> or \g'n' |
7995 | | is a subroutine call by number (Oniguruma syntax). In fact, the value |
7996 | | ESC_g is returned only for these cases. So we don't need to check for < |
7997 | | or ' if the value is ESC_g. For the Perl syntax \g{n} the value is |
7998 | | -n, and for the Perl syntax \g{name} the result is ESC_k (as |
7999 | | that is a synonym for a named back reference). */ |
8000 | |
|
8001 | 0 | if (escape == ESC_g) |
8002 | 0 | { |
8003 | 0 | const pcre_uchar *p; |
8004 | 0 | pcre_uint32 cf; |
8005 | |
|
8006 | 0 | item_hwm_offset = cd->hwm - cd->start_workspace; /* Normally this is set when '(' is read */ |
8007 | 0 | terminator = (*(++ptr) == CHAR_LESS_THAN_SIGN)? |
8008 | 0 | CHAR_GREATER_THAN_SIGN : CHAR_APOSTROPHE; |
8009 | | |
8010 | | /* These two statements stop the compiler for warning about possibly |
8011 | | unset variables caused by the jump to HANDLE_NUMERICAL_RECURSION. In |
8012 | | fact, because we do the check for a number below, the paths that |
8013 | | would actually be in error are never taken. */ |
8014 | |
|
8015 | 0 | skipbytes = 0; |
8016 | 0 | reset_bracount = FALSE; |
8017 | | |
8018 | | /* If it's not a signed or unsigned number, treat it as a name. */ |
8019 | |
|
8020 | 0 | cf = ptr[1]; |
8021 | 0 | if (cf != CHAR_PLUS && cf != CHAR_MINUS && !IS_DIGIT(cf)) |
8022 | 0 | { |
8023 | 0 | is_recurse = TRUE; |
8024 | 0 | goto NAMED_REF_OR_RECURSE; |
8025 | 0 | } |
8026 | | |
8027 | | /* Signed or unsigned number (cf = ptr[1]) is known to be plus or minus |
8028 | | or a digit. */ |
8029 | | |
8030 | 0 | p = ptr + 2; |
8031 | 0 | while (IS_DIGIT(*p)) p++; |
8032 | 0 | if (*p != (pcre_uchar)terminator) |
8033 | 0 | { |
8034 | 0 | *errorcodeptr = ERR57; |
8035 | 0 | goto FAILED; |
8036 | 0 | } |
8037 | 0 | ptr++; |
8038 | 0 | goto HANDLE_NUMERICAL_RECURSION; |
8039 | 0 | } |
8040 | | |
8041 | | /* \k<name> or \k'name' is a back reference by name (Perl syntax). |
8042 | | We also support \k{name} (.NET syntax). */ |
8043 | | |
8044 | 0 | if (escape == ESC_k) |
8045 | 0 | { |
8046 | 0 | if ((ptr[1] != CHAR_LESS_THAN_SIGN && |
8047 | 0 | ptr[1] != CHAR_APOSTROPHE && ptr[1] != CHAR_LEFT_CURLY_BRACKET)) |
8048 | 0 | { |
8049 | 0 | *errorcodeptr = ERR69; |
8050 | 0 | goto FAILED; |
8051 | 0 | } |
8052 | 0 | is_recurse = FALSE; |
8053 | 0 | terminator = (*(++ptr) == CHAR_LESS_THAN_SIGN)? |
8054 | 0 | CHAR_GREATER_THAN_SIGN : (*ptr == CHAR_APOSTROPHE)? |
8055 | 0 | CHAR_APOSTROPHE : CHAR_RIGHT_CURLY_BRACKET; |
8056 | 0 | goto NAMED_REF_OR_RECURSE; |
8057 | 0 | } |
8058 | | |
8059 | | /* Back references are handled specially; must disable firstchar if |
8060 | | not set to cope with cases like (?=(\w+))\1: which would otherwise set |
8061 | | ':' later. */ |
8062 | | |
8063 | 0 | if (escape < 0) |
8064 | 0 | { |
8065 | 0 | open_capitem *oc; |
8066 | 0 | recno = -escape; |
8067 | | |
8068 | | /* Come here from named backref handling when the reference is to a |
8069 | | single group (i.e. not to a duplicated name. */ |
8070 | |
|
8071 | 0 | HANDLE_REFERENCE: |
8072 | 0 | if (firstcharflags == REQ_UNSET) zerofirstcharflags = firstcharflags = REQ_NONE; |
8073 | 0 | previous = code; |
8074 | 0 | item_hwm_offset = cd->hwm - cd->start_workspace; |
8075 | 0 | *code++ = ((options & PCRE_CASELESS) != 0)? OP_REFI : OP_REF; |
8076 | 0 | PUT2INC(code, 0, recno); |
8077 | 0 | cd->backref_map |= (recno < 32)? (1U << recno) : 1; |
8078 | 0 | if (recno > cd->top_backref) cd->top_backref = recno; |
8079 | | |
8080 | | /* Check to see if this back reference is recursive, that it, it |
8081 | | is inside the group that it references. A flag is set so that the |
8082 | | group can be made atomic. */ |
8083 | |
|
8084 | 0 | for (oc = cd->open_caps; oc != NULL; oc = oc->next) |
8085 | 0 | { |
8086 | 0 | if (oc->number == recno) |
8087 | 0 | { |
8088 | 0 | oc->flag = TRUE; |
8089 | 0 | break; |
8090 | 0 | } |
8091 | 0 | } |
8092 | 0 | } |
8093 | | |
8094 | | /* So are Unicode property matches, if supported. */ |
8095 | | |
8096 | | #ifdef SUPPORT_UCP |
8097 | | else if (escape == ESC_P || escape == ESC_p) |
8098 | | { |
8099 | | BOOL negated; |
8100 | | unsigned int ptype = 0, pdata = 0; |
8101 | | if (!get_ucp(&ptr, &negated, &ptype, &pdata, errorcodeptr)) |
8102 | | goto FAILED; |
8103 | | previous = code; |
8104 | | item_hwm_offset = cd->hwm - cd->start_workspace; |
8105 | | *code++ = ((escape == ESC_p) != negated)? OP_PROP : OP_NOTPROP; |
8106 | | *code++ = ptype; |
8107 | | *code++ = pdata; |
8108 | | } |
8109 | | #else |
8110 | | |
8111 | | /* If Unicode properties are not supported, \X, \P, and \p are not |
8112 | | allowed. */ |
8113 | | |
8114 | 0 | else if (escape == ESC_X || escape == ESC_P || escape == ESC_p) |
8115 | 0 | { |
8116 | 0 | *errorcodeptr = ERR45; |
8117 | 0 | goto FAILED; |
8118 | 0 | } |
8119 | 0 | #endif |
8120 | | |
8121 | | /* For the rest (including \X when Unicode properties are supported), we |
8122 | | can obtain the OP value by negating the escape value in the default |
8123 | | situation when PCRE_UCP is not set. When it *is* set, we substitute |
8124 | | Unicode property tests. Note that \b and \B do a one-character |
8125 | | lookbehind, and \A also behaves as if it does. */ |
8126 | | |
8127 | 0 | else |
8128 | 0 | { |
8129 | 0 | if ((escape == ESC_b || escape == ESC_B || escape == ESC_A) && |
8130 | 0 | cd->max_lookbehind == 0) |
8131 | 0 | cd->max_lookbehind = 1; |
8132 | | #ifdef SUPPORT_UCP |
8133 | | if (escape >= ESC_DU && escape <= ESC_wu) |
8134 | | { |
8135 | | nestptr = ptr + 1; /* Where to resume */ |
8136 | | ptr = substitutes[escape - ESC_DU] - 1; /* Just before substitute */ |
8137 | | } |
8138 | | else |
8139 | | #endif |
8140 | | /* In non-UTF-8 mode, we turn \C into OP_ALLANY instead of OP_ANYBYTE |
8141 | | so that it works in DFA mode and in lookbehinds. */ |
8142 | |
|
8143 | 0 | { |
8144 | 0 | previous = (escape > ESC_b && escape < ESC_Z)? code : NULL; |
8145 | 0 | item_hwm_offset = cd->hwm - cd->start_workspace; |
8146 | 0 | *code++ = (!utf && escape == ESC_C)? OP_ALLANY : escape; |
8147 | 0 | } |
8148 | 0 | } |
8149 | 0 | continue; |
8150 | 0 | } |
8151 | | |
8152 | | /* We have a data character whose value is in c. In UTF-8 mode it may have |
8153 | | a value > 127. We set its representation in the length/buffer, and then |
8154 | | handle it as a data character. */ |
8155 | | |
8156 | | #if defined SUPPORT_UTF && !defined COMPILE_PCRE32 |
8157 | | if (utf && c > MAX_VALUE_FOR_SINGLE_CHAR) |
8158 | | mclength = PRIV(ord2utf)(c, mcbuffer); |
8159 | | else |
8160 | | #endif |
8161 | | |
8162 | 0 | { |
8163 | 0 | mcbuffer[0] = c; |
8164 | 0 | mclength = 1; |
8165 | 0 | } |
8166 | 0 | goto ONE_CHAR; |
8167 | | |
8168 | | |
8169 | | /* ===================================================================*/ |
8170 | | /* Handle a literal character. It is guaranteed not to be whitespace or # |
8171 | | when the extended flag is set. If we are in a UTF mode, it may be a |
8172 | | multi-unit literal character. */ |
8173 | | |
8174 | 0 | default: |
8175 | 0 | NORMAL_CHAR: |
8176 | 0 | mclength = 1; |
8177 | 0 | mcbuffer[0] = c; |
8178 | |
|
8179 | | #ifdef SUPPORT_UTF |
8180 | | if (utf && HAS_EXTRALEN(c)) |
8181 | | ACROSSCHAR(TRUE, ptr[1], mcbuffer[mclength++] = *(++ptr)); |
8182 | | #endif |
8183 | | |
8184 | | /* At this point we have the character's bytes in mcbuffer, and the length |
8185 | | in mclength. When not in UTF-8 mode, the length is always 1. */ |
8186 | |
|
8187 | 0 | ONE_CHAR: |
8188 | 0 | previous = code; |
8189 | 0 | item_hwm_offset = cd->hwm - cd->start_workspace; |
8190 | | |
8191 | | /* For caseless UTF-8 mode when UCP support is available, check whether |
8192 | | this character has more than one other case. If so, generate a special |
8193 | | OP_PROP item instead of OP_CHARI. */ |
8194 | |
|
8195 | | #ifdef SUPPORT_UCP |
8196 | | if (utf && (options & PCRE_CASELESS) != 0) |
8197 | | { |
8198 | | GETCHAR(c, mcbuffer); |
8199 | | if ((c = UCD_CASESET(c)) != 0) |
8200 | | { |
8201 | | *code++ = OP_PROP; |
8202 | | *code++ = PT_CLIST; |
8203 | | *code++ = c; |
8204 | | if (firstcharflags == REQ_UNSET) |
8205 | | firstcharflags = zerofirstcharflags = REQ_NONE; |
8206 | | break; |
8207 | | } |
8208 | | } |
8209 | | #endif |
8210 | | |
8211 | | /* Caseful matches, or not one of the multicase characters. */ |
8212 | |
|
8213 | 0 | *code++ = ((options & PCRE_CASELESS) != 0)? OP_CHARI : OP_CHAR; |
8214 | 0 | for (c = 0; c < mclength; c++) *code++ = mcbuffer[c]; |
8215 | | |
8216 | | /* Remember if \r or \n were seen */ |
8217 | |
|
8218 | 0 | if (mcbuffer[0] == CHAR_CR || mcbuffer[0] == CHAR_NL) |
8219 | 0 | cd->external_flags |= PCRE_HASCRORLF; |
8220 | | |
8221 | | /* Set the first and required bytes appropriately. If no previous first |
8222 | | byte, set it from this character, but revert to none on a zero repeat. |
8223 | | Otherwise, leave the firstchar value alone, and don't change it on a zero |
8224 | | repeat. */ |
8225 | |
|
8226 | 0 | if (firstcharflags == REQ_UNSET) |
8227 | 0 | { |
8228 | 0 | zerofirstcharflags = REQ_NONE; |
8229 | 0 | zeroreqchar = reqchar; |
8230 | 0 | zeroreqcharflags = reqcharflags; |
8231 | | |
8232 | | /* If the character is more than one byte long, we can set firstchar |
8233 | | only if it is not to be matched caselessly. */ |
8234 | |
|
8235 | 0 | if (mclength == 1 || req_caseopt == 0) |
8236 | 0 | { |
8237 | 0 | firstchar = mcbuffer[0]; |
8238 | 0 | firstcharflags = req_caseopt; |
8239 | |
|
8240 | 0 | if (mclength != 1) |
8241 | 0 | { |
8242 | 0 | reqchar = code[-1]; |
8243 | 0 | reqcharflags = cd->req_varyopt; |
8244 | 0 | } |
8245 | 0 | } |
8246 | 0 | else firstcharflags = reqcharflags = REQ_NONE; |
8247 | 0 | } |
8248 | | |
8249 | | /* firstchar was previously set; we can set reqchar only if the length is |
8250 | | 1 or the matching is caseful. */ |
8251 | | |
8252 | 0 | else |
8253 | 0 | { |
8254 | 0 | zerofirstchar = firstchar; |
8255 | 0 | zerofirstcharflags = firstcharflags; |
8256 | 0 | zeroreqchar = reqchar; |
8257 | 0 | zeroreqcharflags = reqcharflags; |
8258 | 0 | if (mclength == 1 || req_caseopt == 0) |
8259 | 0 | { |
8260 | 0 | reqchar = code[-1]; |
8261 | 0 | reqcharflags = req_caseopt | cd->req_varyopt; |
8262 | 0 | } |
8263 | 0 | } |
8264 | |
|
8265 | 0 | break; /* End of literal character handling */ |
8266 | 0 | } |
8267 | 0 | } /* end of big loop */ |
8268 | | |
8269 | | |
8270 | | /* Control never reaches here by falling through, only by a goto for all the |
8271 | | error states. Pass back the position in the pattern so that it can be displayed |
8272 | | to the user for diagnosing the error. */ |
8273 | | |
8274 | 0 | FAILED: |
8275 | 0 | *ptrptr = ptr; |
8276 | 0 | return FALSE; |
8277 | 0 | } |
8278 | | |
8279 | | |
8280 | | |
8281 | | /************************************************* |
8282 | | * Compile sequence of alternatives * |
8283 | | *************************************************/ |
8284 | | |
8285 | | /* On entry, ptr is pointing past the bracket character, but on return it |
8286 | | points to the closing bracket, or vertical bar, or end of string. The code |
8287 | | variable is pointing at the byte into which the BRA operator has been stored. |
8288 | | This function is used during the pre-compile phase when we are trying to find |
8289 | | out the amount of memory needed, as well as during the real compile phase. The |
8290 | | value of lengthptr distinguishes the two phases. |
8291 | | |
8292 | | Arguments: |
8293 | | options option bits, including any changes for this subpattern |
8294 | | codeptr -> the address of the current code pointer |
8295 | | ptrptr -> the address of the current pattern pointer |
8296 | | errorcodeptr -> pointer to error code variable |
8297 | | lookbehind TRUE if this is a lookbehind assertion |
8298 | | reset_bracount TRUE to reset the count for each branch |
8299 | | skipbytes skip this many bytes at start (for brackets and OP_COND) |
8300 | | cond_depth depth of nesting for conditional subpatterns |
8301 | | firstcharptr place to put the first required character |
8302 | | firstcharflagsptr place to put the first character flags, or a negative number |
8303 | | reqcharptr place to put the last required character |
8304 | | reqcharflagsptr place to put the last required character flags, or a negative number |
8305 | | bcptr pointer to the chain of currently open branches |
8306 | | cd points to the data block with tables pointers etc. |
8307 | | lengthptr NULL during the real compile phase |
8308 | | points to length accumulator during pre-compile phase |
8309 | | |
8310 | | Returns: TRUE on success |
8311 | | */ |
8312 | | |
8313 | | static BOOL |
8314 | | compile_regex(int options, pcre_uchar **codeptr, const pcre_uchar **ptrptr, |
8315 | | int *errorcodeptr, BOOL lookbehind, BOOL reset_bracount, int skipbytes, |
8316 | | int cond_depth, |
8317 | | pcre_uint32 *firstcharptr, pcre_int32 *firstcharflagsptr, |
8318 | | pcre_uint32 *reqcharptr, pcre_int32 *reqcharflagsptr, |
8319 | | branch_chain *bcptr, compile_data *cd, int *lengthptr) |
8320 | 0 | { |
8321 | 0 | const pcre_uchar *ptr = *ptrptr; |
8322 | 0 | pcre_uchar *code = *codeptr; |
8323 | 0 | pcre_uchar *last_branch = code; |
8324 | 0 | pcre_uchar *start_bracket = code; |
8325 | 0 | pcre_uchar *reverse_count = NULL; |
8326 | 0 | open_capitem capitem; |
8327 | 0 | int capnumber = 0; |
8328 | 0 | pcre_uint32 firstchar, reqchar; |
8329 | 0 | pcre_int32 firstcharflags, reqcharflags; |
8330 | 0 | pcre_uint32 branchfirstchar, branchreqchar; |
8331 | 0 | pcre_int32 branchfirstcharflags, branchreqcharflags; |
8332 | 0 | int length; |
8333 | 0 | unsigned int orig_bracount; |
8334 | 0 | unsigned int max_bracount; |
8335 | 0 | branch_chain bc; |
8336 | 0 | size_t save_hwm_offset; |
8337 | | |
8338 | | /* If set, call the external function that checks for stack availability. */ |
8339 | |
|
8340 | 0 | if (PUBL(stack_guard) != NULL && PUBL(stack_guard)()) |
8341 | 0 | { |
8342 | 0 | *errorcodeptr= ERR85; |
8343 | 0 | return FALSE; |
8344 | 0 | } |
8345 | | |
8346 | | /* Miscellaneous initialization */ |
8347 | | |
8348 | 0 | bc.outer = bcptr; |
8349 | 0 | bc.current_branch = code; |
8350 | |
|
8351 | 0 | firstchar = reqchar = 0; |
8352 | 0 | firstcharflags = reqcharflags = REQ_UNSET; |
8353 | |
|
8354 | 0 | save_hwm_offset = cd->hwm - cd->start_workspace; |
8355 | | |
8356 | | /* Accumulate the length for use in the pre-compile phase. Start with the |
8357 | | length of the BRA and KET and any extra bytes that are required at the |
8358 | | beginning. We accumulate in a local variable to save frequent testing of |
8359 | | lenthptr for NULL. We cannot do this by looking at the value of code at the |
8360 | | start and end of each alternative, because compiled items are discarded during |
8361 | | the pre-compile phase so that the work space is not exceeded. */ |
8362 | |
|
8363 | 0 | length = 2 + 2*LINK_SIZE + skipbytes; |
8364 | | |
8365 | | /* WARNING: If the above line is changed for any reason, you must also change |
8366 | | the code that abstracts option settings at the start of the pattern and makes |
8367 | | them global. It tests the value of length for (2 + 2*LINK_SIZE) in the |
8368 | | pre-compile phase to find out whether anything has yet been compiled or not. */ |
8369 | | |
8370 | | /* If this is a capturing subpattern, add to the chain of open capturing items |
8371 | | so that we can detect them if (*ACCEPT) is encountered. This is also used to |
8372 | | detect groups that contain recursive back references to themselves. Note that |
8373 | | only OP_CBRA need be tested here; changing this opcode to one of its variants, |
8374 | | e.g. OP_SCBRAPOS, happens later, after the group has been compiled. */ |
8375 | |
|
8376 | 0 | if (*code == OP_CBRA) |
8377 | 0 | { |
8378 | 0 | capnumber = GET2(code, 1 + LINK_SIZE); |
8379 | 0 | capitem.number = capnumber; |
8380 | 0 | capitem.next = cd->open_caps; |
8381 | 0 | capitem.flag = FALSE; |
8382 | 0 | cd->open_caps = &capitem; |
8383 | 0 | } |
8384 | | |
8385 | | /* Offset is set zero to mark that this bracket is still open */ |
8386 | |
|
8387 | 0 | PUT(code, 1, 0); |
8388 | 0 | code += 1 + LINK_SIZE + skipbytes; |
8389 | | |
8390 | | /* Loop for each alternative branch */ |
8391 | |
|
8392 | 0 | orig_bracount = max_bracount = cd->bracount; |
8393 | 0 | for (;;) |
8394 | 0 | { |
8395 | | /* For a (?| group, reset the capturing bracket count so that each branch |
8396 | | uses the same numbers. */ |
8397 | |
|
8398 | 0 | if (reset_bracount) cd->bracount = orig_bracount; |
8399 | | |
8400 | | /* Set up dummy OP_REVERSE if lookbehind assertion */ |
8401 | |
|
8402 | 0 | if (lookbehind) |
8403 | 0 | { |
8404 | 0 | *code++ = OP_REVERSE; |
8405 | 0 | reverse_count = code; |
8406 | 0 | PUTINC(code, 0, 0); |
8407 | 0 | length += 1 + LINK_SIZE; |
8408 | 0 | } |
8409 | | |
8410 | | /* Now compile the branch; in the pre-compile phase its length gets added |
8411 | | into the length. */ |
8412 | |
|
8413 | 0 | if (!compile_branch(&options, &code, &ptr, errorcodeptr, &branchfirstchar, |
8414 | 0 | &branchfirstcharflags, &branchreqchar, &branchreqcharflags, &bc, |
8415 | 0 | cond_depth, cd, (lengthptr == NULL)? NULL : &length)) |
8416 | 0 | { |
8417 | 0 | *ptrptr = ptr; |
8418 | 0 | return FALSE; |
8419 | 0 | } |
8420 | | |
8421 | | /* Keep the highest bracket count in case (?| was used and some branch |
8422 | | has fewer than the rest. */ |
8423 | | |
8424 | 0 | if (cd->bracount > max_bracount) max_bracount = cd->bracount; |
8425 | | |
8426 | | /* In the real compile phase, there is some post-processing to be done. */ |
8427 | |
|
8428 | 0 | if (lengthptr == NULL) |
8429 | 0 | { |
8430 | | /* If this is the first branch, the firstchar and reqchar values for the |
8431 | | branch become the values for the regex. */ |
8432 | |
|
8433 | 0 | if (*last_branch != OP_ALT) |
8434 | 0 | { |
8435 | 0 | firstchar = branchfirstchar; |
8436 | 0 | firstcharflags = branchfirstcharflags; |
8437 | 0 | reqchar = branchreqchar; |
8438 | 0 | reqcharflags = branchreqcharflags; |
8439 | 0 | } |
8440 | | |
8441 | | /* If this is not the first branch, the first char and reqchar have to |
8442 | | match the values from all the previous branches, except that if the |
8443 | | previous value for reqchar didn't have REQ_VARY set, it can still match, |
8444 | | and we set REQ_VARY for the regex. */ |
8445 | | |
8446 | 0 | else |
8447 | 0 | { |
8448 | | /* If we previously had a firstchar, but it doesn't match the new branch, |
8449 | | we have to abandon the firstchar for the regex, but if there was |
8450 | | previously no reqchar, it takes on the value of the old firstchar. */ |
8451 | |
|
8452 | 0 | if (firstcharflags >= 0 && |
8453 | 0 | (firstcharflags != branchfirstcharflags || firstchar != branchfirstchar)) |
8454 | 0 | { |
8455 | 0 | if (reqcharflags < 0) |
8456 | 0 | { |
8457 | 0 | reqchar = firstchar; |
8458 | 0 | reqcharflags = firstcharflags; |
8459 | 0 | } |
8460 | 0 | firstcharflags = REQ_NONE; |
8461 | 0 | } |
8462 | | |
8463 | | /* If we (now or from before) have no firstchar, a firstchar from the |
8464 | | branch becomes a reqchar if there isn't a branch reqchar. */ |
8465 | |
|
8466 | 0 | if (firstcharflags < 0 && branchfirstcharflags >= 0 && branchreqcharflags < 0) |
8467 | 0 | { |
8468 | 0 | branchreqchar = branchfirstchar; |
8469 | 0 | branchreqcharflags = branchfirstcharflags; |
8470 | 0 | } |
8471 | | |
8472 | | /* Now ensure that the reqchars match */ |
8473 | |
|
8474 | 0 | if (((reqcharflags & ~REQ_VARY) != (branchreqcharflags & ~REQ_VARY)) || |
8475 | 0 | reqchar != branchreqchar) |
8476 | 0 | reqcharflags = REQ_NONE; |
8477 | 0 | else |
8478 | 0 | { |
8479 | 0 | reqchar = branchreqchar; |
8480 | 0 | reqcharflags |= branchreqcharflags; /* To "or" REQ_VARY */ |
8481 | 0 | } |
8482 | 0 | } |
8483 | | |
8484 | | /* If lookbehind, check that this branch matches a fixed-length string, and |
8485 | | put the length into the OP_REVERSE item. Temporarily mark the end of the |
8486 | | branch with OP_END. If the branch contains OP_RECURSE, the result is -3 |
8487 | | because there may be forward references that we can't check here. Set a |
8488 | | flag to cause another lookbehind check at the end. Why not do it all at the |
8489 | | end? Because common, erroneous checks are picked up here and the offset of |
8490 | | the problem can be shown. */ |
8491 | |
|
8492 | 0 | if (lookbehind) |
8493 | 0 | { |
8494 | 0 | int fixed_length; |
8495 | 0 | *code = OP_END; |
8496 | 0 | fixed_length = find_fixedlength(last_branch, (options & PCRE_UTF8) != 0, |
8497 | 0 | FALSE, cd, NULL); |
8498 | 0 | DPRINTF(("fixed length = %d\n", fixed_length)); |
8499 | 0 | if (fixed_length == -3) |
8500 | 0 | { |
8501 | 0 | cd->check_lookbehind = TRUE; |
8502 | 0 | } |
8503 | 0 | else if (fixed_length < 0) |
8504 | 0 | { |
8505 | 0 | *errorcodeptr = (fixed_length == -2)? ERR36 : |
8506 | 0 | (fixed_length == -4)? ERR70: ERR25; |
8507 | 0 | *ptrptr = ptr; |
8508 | 0 | return FALSE; |
8509 | 0 | } |
8510 | 0 | else |
8511 | 0 | { |
8512 | 0 | if (fixed_length > cd->max_lookbehind) |
8513 | 0 | cd->max_lookbehind = fixed_length; |
8514 | 0 | PUT(reverse_count, 0, fixed_length); |
8515 | 0 | } |
8516 | 0 | } |
8517 | 0 | } |
8518 | | |
8519 | | /* Reached end of expression, either ')' or end of pattern. In the real |
8520 | | compile phase, go back through the alternative branches and reverse the chain |
8521 | | of offsets, with the field in the BRA item now becoming an offset to the |
8522 | | first alternative. If there are no alternatives, it points to the end of the |
8523 | | group. The length in the terminating ket is always the length of the whole |
8524 | | bracketed item. Return leaving the pointer at the terminating char. */ |
8525 | | |
8526 | 0 | if (*ptr != CHAR_VERTICAL_LINE) |
8527 | 0 | { |
8528 | 0 | if (lengthptr == NULL) |
8529 | 0 | { |
8530 | 0 | int branch_length = (int)(code - last_branch); |
8531 | 0 | do |
8532 | 0 | { |
8533 | 0 | int prev_length = GET(last_branch, 1); |
8534 | 0 | PUT(last_branch, 1, branch_length); |
8535 | 0 | branch_length = prev_length; |
8536 | 0 | last_branch -= branch_length; |
8537 | 0 | } |
8538 | 0 | while (branch_length > 0); |
8539 | 0 | } |
8540 | | |
8541 | | /* Fill in the ket */ |
8542 | |
|
8543 | 0 | *code = OP_KET; |
8544 | 0 | PUT(code, 1, (int)(code - start_bracket)); |
8545 | 0 | code += 1 + LINK_SIZE; |
8546 | | |
8547 | | /* If it was a capturing subpattern, check to see if it contained any |
8548 | | recursive back references. If so, we must wrap it in atomic brackets. |
8549 | | Because we are moving code along, we must ensure that any pending recursive |
8550 | | references are updated. In any event, remove the block from the chain. */ |
8551 | |
|
8552 | 0 | if (capnumber > 0) |
8553 | 0 | { |
8554 | 0 | if (cd->open_caps->flag) |
8555 | 0 | { |
8556 | 0 | *code = OP_END; |
8557 | 0 | adjust_recurse(start_bracket, 1 + LINK_SIZE, |
8558 | 0 | (options & PCRE_UTF8) != 0, cd, save_hwm_offset); |
8559 | 0 | memmove(start_bracket + 1 + LINK_SIZE, start_bracket, |
8560 | 0 | IN_UCHARS(code - start_bracket)); |
8561 | 0 | *start_bracket = OP_ONCE; |
8562 | 0 | code += 1 + LINK_SIZE; |
8563 | 0 | PUT(start_bracket, 1, (int)(code - start_bracket)); |
8564 | 0 | *code = OP_KET; |
8565 | 0 | PUT(code, 1, (int)(code - start_bracket)); |
8566 | 0 | code += 1 + LINK_SIZE; |
8567 | 0 | length += 2 + 2*LINK_SIZE; |
8568 | 0 | } |
8569 | 0 | cd->open_caps = cd->open_caps->next; |
8570 | 0 | } |
8571 | | |
8572 | | /* Retain the highest bracket number, in case resetting was used. */ |
8573 | |
|
8574 | 0 | cd->bracount = max_bracount; |
8575 | | |
8576 | | /* Set values to pass back */ |
8577 | |
|
8578 | 0 | *codeptr = code; |
8579 | 0 | *ptrptr = ptr; |
8580 | 0 | *firstcharptr = firstchar; |
8581 | 0 | *firstcharflagsptr = firstcharflags; |
8582 | 0 | *reqcharptr = reqchar; |
8583 | 0 | *reqcharflagsptr = reqcharflags; |
8584 | 0 | if (lengthptr != NULL) |
8585 | 0 | { |
8586 | 0 | if (OFLOW_MAX - *lengthptr < length) |
8587 | 0 | { |
8588 | 0 | *errorcodeptr = ERR20; |
8589 | 0 | return FALSE; |
8590 | 0 | } |
8591 | 0 | *lengthptr += length; |
8592 | 0 | } |
8593 | 0 | return TRUE; |
8594 | 0 | } |
8595 | | |
8596 | | /* Another branch follows. In the pre-compile phase, we can move the code |
8597 | | pointer back to where it was for the start of the first branch. (That is, |
8598 | | pretend that each branch is the only one.) |
8599 | | |
8600 | | In the real compile phase, insert an ALT node. Its length field points back |
8601 | | to the previous branch while the bracket remains open. At the end the chain |
8602 | | is reversed. It's done like this so that the start of the bracket has a |
8603 | | zero offset until it is closed, making it possible to detect recursion. */ |
8604 | | |
8605 | 0 | if (lengthptr != NULL) |
8606 | 0 | { |
8607 | 0 | code = *codeptr + 1 + LINK_SIZE + skipbytes; |
8608 | 0 | length += 1 + LINK_SIZE; |
8609 | 0 | } |
8610 | 0 | else |
8611 | 0 | { |
8612 | 0 | *code = OP_ALT; |
8613 | 0 | PUT(code, 1, (int)(code - last_branch)); |
8614 | 0 | bc.current_branch = last_branch = code; |
8615 | 0 | code += 1 + LINK_SIZE; |
8616 | 0 | } |
8617 | |
|
8618 | 0 | ptr++; |
8619 | 0 | } |
8620 | | /* Control never reaches here */ |
8621 | 0 | } |
8622 | | |
8623 | | |
8624 | | |
8625 | | |
8626 | | /************************************************* |
8627 | | * Check for anchored expression * |
8628 | | *************************************************/ |
8629 | | |
8630 | | /* Try to find out if this is an anchored regular expression. Consider each |
8631 | | alternative branch. If they all start with OP_SOD or OP_CIRC, or with a bracket |
8632 | | all of whose alternatives start with OP_SOD or OP_CIRC (recurse ad lib), then |
8633 | | it's anchored. However, if this is a multiline pattern, then only OP_SOD will |
8634 | | be found, because ^ generates OP_CIRCM in that mode. |
8635 | | |
8636 | | We can also consider a regex to be anchored if OP_SOM starts all its branches. |
8637 | | This is the code for \G, which means "match at start of match position, taking |
8638 | | into account the match offset". |
8639 | | |
8640 | | A branch is also implicitly anchored if it starts with .* and DOTALL is set, |
8641 | | because that will try the rest of the pattern at all possible matching points, |
8642 | | so there is no point trying again.... er .... |
8643 | | |
8644 | | .... except when the .* appears inside capturing parentheses, and there is a |
8645 | | subsequent back reference to those parentheses. We haven't enough information |
8646 | | to catch that case precisely. |
8647 | | |
8648 | | At first, the best we could do was to detect when .* was in capturing brackets |
8649 | | and the highest back reference was greater than or equal to that level. |
8650 | | However, by keeping a bitmap of the first 31 back references, we can catch some |
8651 | | of the more common cases more precisely. |
8652 | | |
8653 | | ... A second exception is when the .* appears inside an atomic group, because |
8654 | | this prevents the number of characters it matches from being adjusted. |
8655 | | |
8656 | | Arguments: |
8657 | | code points to start of expression (the bracket) |
8658 | | bracket_map a bitmap of which brackets we are inside while testing; this |
8659 | | handles up to substring 31; after that we just have to take |
8660 | | the less precise approach |
8661 | | cd points to the compile data block |
8662 | | atomcount atomic group level |
8663 | | |
8664 | | Returns: TRUE or FALSE |
8665 | | */ |
8666 | | |
8667 | | static BOOL |
8668 | | is_anchored(register const pcre_uchar *code, unsigned int bracket_map, |
8669 | | compile_data *cd, int atomcount) |
8670 | 0 | { |
8671 | 0 | do { |
8672 | 0 | const pcre_uchar *scode = first_significant_code( |
8673 | 0 | code + PRIV(OP_lengths)[*code], FALSE); |
8674 | 0 | register int op = *scode; |
8675 | | |
8676 | | /* Non-capturing brackets */ |
8677 | |
|
8678 | 0 | if (op == OP_BRA || op == OP_BRAPOS || |
8679 | 0 | op == OP_SBRA || op == OP_SBRAPOS) |
8680 | 0 | { |
8681 | 0 | if (!is_anchored(scode, bracket_map, cd, atomcount)) return FALSE; |
8682 | 0 | } |
8683 | | |
8684 | | /* Capturing brackets */ |
8685 | | |
8686 | 0 | else if (op == OP_CBRA || op == OP_CBRAPOS || |
8687 | 0 | op == OP_SCBRA || op == OP_SCBRAPOS) |
8688 | 0 | { |
8689 | 0 | int n = GET2(scode, 1+LINK_SIZE); |
8690 | 0 | int new_map = bracket_map | ((n < 32)? (1U << n) : 1); |
8691 | 0 | if (!is_anchored(scode, new_map, cd, atomcount)) return FALSE; |
8692 | 0 | } |
8693 | | |
8694 | | /* Positive forward assertion */ |
8695 | | |
8696 | 0 | else if (op == OP_ASSERT) |
8697 | 0 | { |
8698 | 0 | if (!is_anchored(scode, bracket_map, cd, atomcount)) return FALSE; |
8699 | 0 | } |
8700 | | |
8701 | | /* Condition; not anchored if no second branch */ |
8702 | | |
8703 | 0 | else if (op == OP_COND) |
8704 | 0 | { |
8705 | 0 | if (scode[GET(scode,1)] != OP_ALT) return FALSE; |
8706 | 0 | if (!is_anchored(scode, bracket_map, cd, atomcount)) return FALSE; |
8707 | 0 | } |
8708 | | |
8709 | | /* Atomic groups */ |
8710 | | |
8711 | 0 | else if (op == OP_ONCE || op == OP_ONCE_NC) |
8712 | 0 | { |
8713 | 0 | if (!is_anchored(scode, bracket_map, cd, atomcount + 1)) |
8714 | 0 | return FALSE; |
8715 | 0 | } |
8716 | | |
8717 | | /* .* is not anchored unless DOTALL is set (which generates OP_ALLANY) and |
8718 | | it isn't in brackets that are or may be referenced or inside an atomic |
8719 | | group. */ |
8720 | | |
8721 | 0 | else if ((op == OP_TYPESTAR || op == OP_TYPEMINSTAR || |
8722 | 0 | op == OP_TYPEPOSSTAR)) |
8723 | 0 | { |
8724 | 0 | if (scode[1] != OP_ALLANY || (bracket_map & cd->backref_map) != 0 || |
8725 | 0 | atomcount > 0 || cd->had_pruneorskip) |
8726 | 0 | return FALSE; |
8727 | 0 | } |
8728 | | |
8729 | | /* Check for explicit anchoring */ |
8730 | | |
8731 | 0 | else if (op != OP_SOD && op != OP_SOM && op != OP_CIRC) return FALSE; |
8732 | | |
8733 | 0 | code += GET(code, 1); |
8734 | 0 | } |
8735 | 0 | while (*code == OP_ALT); /* Loop for each alternative */ |
8736 | 0 | return TRUE; |
8737 | 0 | } |
8738 | | |
8739 | | |
8740 | | |
8741 | | /************************************************* |
8742 | | * Check for starting with ^ or .* * |
8743 | | *************************************************/ |
8744 | | |
8745 | | /* This is called to find out if every branch starts with ^ or .* so that |
8746 | | "first char" processing can be done to speed things up in multiline |
8747 | | matching and for non-DOTALL patterns that start with .* (which must start at |
8748 | | the beginning or after \n). As in the case of is_anchored() (see above), we |
8749 | | have to take account of back references to capturing brackets that contain .* |
8750 | | because in that case we can't make the assumption. Also, the appearance of .* |
8751 | | inside atomic brackets or in an assertion, or in a pattern that contains *PRUNE |
8752 | | or *SKIP does not count, because once again the assumption no longer holds. |
8753 | | |
8754 | | Arguments: |
8755 | | code points to start of expression (the bracket) |
8756 | | bracket_map a bitmap of which brackets we are inside while testing; this |
8757 | | handles up to substring 31; after that we just have to take |
8758 | | the less precise approach |
8759 | | cd points to the compile data |
8760 | | atomcount atomic group level |
8761 | | inassert TRUE if in an assertion |
8762 | | |
8763 | | Returns: TRUE or FALSE |
8764 | | */ |
8765 | | |
8766 | | static BOOL |
8767 | | is_startline(const pcre_uchar *code, unsigned int bracket_map, |
8768 | | compile_data *cd, int atomcount, BOOL inassert) |
8769 | 0 | { |
8770 | 0 | do { |
8771 | 0 | const pcre_uchar *scode = first_significant_code( |
8772 | 0 | code + PRIV(OP_lengths)[*code], FALSE); |
8773 | 0 | register int op = *scode; |
8774 | | |
8775 | | /* If we are at the start of a conditional assertion group, *both* the |
8776 | | conditional assertion *and* what follows the condition must satisfy the test |
8777 | | for start of line. Other kinds of condition fail. Note that there may be an |
8778 | | auto-callout at the start of a condition. */ |
8779 | |
|
8780 | 0 | if (op == OP_COND) |
8781 | 0 | { |
8782 | 0 | scode += 1 + LINK_SIZE; |
8783 | 0 | if (*scode == OP_CALLOUT) scode += PRIV(OP_lengths)[OP_CALLOUT]; |
8784 | 0 | switch (*scode) |
8785 | 0 | { |
8786 | 0 | case OP_CREF: |
8787 | 0 | case OP_DNCREF: |
8788 | 0 | case OP_RREF: |
8789 | 0 | case OP_DNRREF: |
8790 | 0 | case OP_DEF: |
8791 | 0 | case OP_FAIL: |
8792 | 0 | return FALSE; |
8793 | | |
8794 | 0 | default: /* Assertion */ |
8795 | 0 | if (!is_startline(scode, bracket_map, cd, atomcount, TRUE)) return FALSE; |
8796 | 0 | do scode += GET(scode, 1); while (*scode == OP_ALT); |
8797 | 0 | scode += 1 + LINK_SIZE; |
8798 | 0 | break; |
8799 | 0 | } |
8800 | 0 | scode = first_significant_code(scode, FALSE); |
8801 | 0 | op = *scode; |
8802 | 0 | } |
8803 | | |
8804 | | /* Non-capturing brackets */ |
8805 | | |
8806 | 0 | if (op == OP_BRA || op == OP_BRAPOS || |
8807 | 0 | op == OP_SBRA || op == OP_SBRAPOS) |
8808 | 0 | { |
8809 | 0 | if (!is_startline(scode, bracket_map, cd, atomcount, inassert)) return FALSE; |
8810 | 0 | } |
8811 | | |
8812 | | /* Capturing brackets */ |
8813 | | |
8814 | 0 | else if (op == OP_CBRA || op == OP_CBRAPOS || |
8815 | 0 | op == OP_SCBRA || op == OP_SCBRAPOS) |
8816 | 0 | { |
8817 | 0 | int n = GET2(scode, 1+LINK_SIZE); |
8818 | 0 | int new_map = bracket_map | ((n < 32)? (1U << n) : 1); |
8819 | 0 | if (!is_startline(scode, new_map, cd, atomcount, inassert)) return FALSE; |
8820 | 0 | } |
8821 | | |
8822 | | /* Positive forward assertions */ |
8823 | | |
8824 | 0 | else if (op == OP_ASSERT) |
8825 | 0 | { |
8826 | 0 | if (!is_startline(scode, bracket_map, cd, atomcount, TRUE)) return FALSE; |
8827 | 0 | } |
8828 | | |
8829 | | /* Atomic brackets */ |
8830 | | |
8831 | 0 | else if (op == OP_ONCE || op == OP_ONCE_NC) |
8832 | 0 | { |
8833 | 0 | if (!is_startline(scode, bracket_map, cd, atomcount + 1, inassert)) return FALSE; |
8834 | 0 | } |
8835 | | |
8836 | | /* .* means "start at start or after \n" if it isn't in atomic brackets or |
8837 | | brackets that may be referenced or an assertion, as long as the pattern does |
8838 | | not contain *PRUNE or *SKIP, because these break the feature. Consider, for |
8839 | | example, /.*?a(*PRUNE)b/ with the subject "aab", which matches "ab", i.e. |
8840 | | not at the start of a line. */ |
8841 | | |
8842 | 0 | else if (op == OP_TYPESTAR || op == OP_TYPEMINSTAR || op == OP_TYPEPOSSTAR) |
8843 | 0 | { |
8844 | 0 | if (scode[1] != OP_ANY || (bracket_map & cd->backref_map) != 0 || |
8845 | 0 | atomcount > 0 || cd->had_pruneorskip || inassert) |
8846 | 0 | return FALSE; |
8847 | 0 | } |
8848 | | |
8849 | | /* Check for explicit circumflex; anything else gives a FALSE result. Note |
8850 | | in particular that this includes atomic brackets OP_ONCE and OP_ONCE_NC |
8851 | | because the number of characters matched by .* cannot be adjusted inside |
8852 | | them. */ |
8853 | | |
8854 | 0 | else if (op != OP_CIRC && op != OP_CIRCM) return FALSE; |
8855 | | |
8856 | | /* Move on to the next alternative */ |
8857 | | |
8858 | 0 | code += GET(code, 1); |
8859 | 0 | } |
8860 | 0 | while (*code == OP_ALT); /* Loop for each alternative */ |
8861 | 0 | return TRUE; |
8862 | 0 | } |
8863 | | |
8864 | | |
8865 | | |
8866 | | /************************************************* |
8867 | | * Check for asserted fixed first char * |
8868 | | *************************************************/ |
8869 | | |
8870 | | /* During compilation, the "first char" settings from forward assertions are |
8871 | | discarded, because they can cause conflicts with actual literals that follow. |
8872 | | However, if we end up without a first char setting for an unanchored pattern, |
8873 | | it is worth scanning the regex to see if there is an initial asserted first |
8874 | | char. If all branches start with the same asserted char, or with a |
8875 | | non-conditional bracket all of whose alternatives start with the same asserted |
8876 | | char (recurse ad lib), then we return that char, with the flags set to zero or |
8877 | | REQ_CASELESS; otherwise return zero with REQ_NONE in the flags. |
8878 | | |
8879 | | Arguments: |
8880 | | code points to start of expression (the bracket) |
8881 | | flags points to the first char flags, or to REQ_NONE |
8882 | | inassert TRUE if in an assertion |
8883 | | |
8884 | | Returns: the fixed first char, or 0 with REQ_NONE in flags |
8885 | | */ |
8886 | | |
8887 | | static pcre_uint32 |
8888 | | find_firstassertedchar(const pcre_uchar *code, pcre_int32 *flags, |
8889 | | BOOL inassert) |
8890 | 0 | { |
8891 | 0 | register pcre_uint32 c = 0; |
8892 | 0 | int cflags = REQ_NONE; |
8893 | |
|
8894 | 0 | *flags = REQ_NONE; |
8895 | 0 | do { |
8896 | 0 | pcre_uint32 d; |
8897 | 0 | int dflags; |
8898 | 0 | int xl = (*code == OP_CBRA || *code == OP_SCBRA || |
8899 | 0 | *code == OP_CBRAPOS || *code == OP_SCBRAPOS)? IMM2_SIZE:0; |
8900 | 0 | const pcre_uchar *scode = first_significant_code(code + 1+LINK_SIZE + xl, |
8901 | 0 | TRUE); |
8902 | 0 | register pcre_uchar op = *scode; |
8903 | |
|
8904 | 0 | switch(op) |
8905 | 0 | { |
8906 | 0 | default: |
8907 | 0 | return 0; |
8908 | | |
8909 | 0 | case OP_BRA: |
8910 | 0 | case OP_BRAPOS: |
8911 | 0 | case OP_CBRA: |
8912 | 0 | case OP_SCBRA: |
8913 | 0 | case OP_CBRAPOS: |
8914 | 0 | case OP_SCBRAPOS: |
8915 | 0 | case OP_ASSERT: |
8916 | 0 | case OP_ONCE: |
8917 | 0 | case OP_ONCE_NC: |
8918 | 0 | d = find_firstassertedchar(scode, &dflags, op == OP_ASSERT); |
8919 | 0 | if (dflags < 0) |
8920 | 0 | return 0; |
8921 | 0 | if (cflags < 0) { c = d; cflags = dflags; } else if (c != d || cflags != dflags) return 0; |
8922 | 0 | break; |
8923 | | |
8924 | 0 | case OP_EXACT: |
8925 | 0 | scode += IMM2_SIZE; |
8926 | | /* Fall through */ |
8927 | |
|
8928 | 0 | case OP_CHAR: |
8929 | 0 | case OP_PLUS: |
8930 | 0 | case OP_MINPLUS: |
8931 | 0 | case OP_POSPLUS: |
8932 | 0 | if (!inassert) return 0; |
8933 | 0 | if (cflags < 0) { c = scode[1]; cflags = 0; } |
8934 | 0 | else if (c != scode[1]) return 0; |
8935 | 0 | break; |
8936 | | |
8937 | 0 | case OP_EXACTI: |
8938 | 0 | scode += IMM2_SIZE; |
8939 | | /* Fall through */ |
8940 | |
|
8941 | 0 | case OP_CHARI: |
8942 | 0 | case OP_PLUSI: |
8943 | 0 | case OP_MINPLUSI: |
8944 | 0 | case OP_POSPLUSI: |
8945 | 0 | if (!inassert) return 0; |
8946 | 0 | if (cflags < 0) { c = scode[1]; cflags = REQ_CASELESS; } |
8947 | 0 | else if (c != scode[1]) return 0; |
8948 | 0 | break; |
8949 | 0 | } |
8950 | | |
8951 | 0 | code += GET(code, 1); |
8952 | 0 | } |
8953 | 0 | while (*code == OP_ALT); |
8954 | | |
8955 | 0 | *flags = cflags; |
8956 | 0 | return c; |
8957 | 0 | } |
8958 | | |
8959 | | |
8960 | | |
8961 | | /************************************************* |
8962 | | * Add an entry to the name/number table * |
8963 | | *************************************************/ |
8964 | | |
8965 | | /* This function is called between compiling passes to add an entry to the |
8966 | | name/number table, maintaining alphabetical order. Checking for permitted |
8967 | | and forbidden duplicates has already been done. |
8968 | | |
8969 | | Arguments: |
8970 | | cd the compile data block |
8971 | | name the name to add |
8972 | | length the length of the name |
8973 | | groupno the group number |
8974 | | |
8975 | | Returns: nothing |
8976 | | */ |
8977 | | |
8978 | | static void |
8979 | | add_name(compile_data *cd, const pcre_uchar *name, int length, |
8980 | | unsigned int groupno) |
8981 | 0 | { |
8982 | 0 | int i; |
8983 | 0 | pcre_uchar *slot = cd->name_table; |
8984 | |
|
8985 | 0 | for (i = 0; i < cd->names_found; i++) |
8986 | 0 | { |
8987 | 0 | int crc = memcmp(name, slot+IMM2_SIZE, IN_UCHARS(length)); |
8988 | 0 | if (crc == 0 && slot[IMM2_SIZE+length] != 0) |
8989 | 0 | crc = -1; /* Current name is a substring */ |
8990 | | |
8991 | | /* Make space in the table and break the loop for an earlier name. For a |
8992 | | duplicate or later name, carry on. We do this for duplicates so that in the |
8993 | | simple case (when ?(| is not used) they are in order of their numbers. In all |
8994 | | cases they are in the order in which they appear in the pattern. */ |
8995 | |
|
8996 | 0 | if (crc < 0) |
8997 | 0 | { |
8998 | 0 | memmove(slot + cd->name_entry_size, slot, |
8999 | 0 | IN_UCHARS((cd->names_found - i) * cd->name_entry_size)); |
9000 | 0 | break; |
9001 | 0 | } |
9002 | | |
9003 | | /* Continue the loop for a later or duplicate name */ |
9004 | | |
9005 | 0 | slot += cd->name_entry_size; |
9006 | 0 | } |
9007 | |
|
9008 | 0 | PUT2(slot, 0, groupno); |
9009 | 0 | memcpy(slot + IMM2_SIZE, name, IN_UCHARS(length)); |
9010 | 0 | slot[IMM2_SIZE + length] = 0; |
9011 | 0 | cd->names_found++; |
9012 | 0 | } |
9013 | | |
9014 | | |
9015 | | |
9016 | | /************************************************* |
9017 | | * Compile a Regular Expression * |
9018 | | *************************************************/ |
9019 | | |
9020 | | /* This function takes a string and returns a pointer to a block of store |
9021 | | holding a compiled version of the expression. The original API for this |
9022 | | function had no error code return variable; it is retained for backwards |
9023 | | compatibility. The new function is given a new name. |
9024 | | |
9025 | | Arguments: |
9026 | | pattern the regular expression |
9027 | | options various option bits |
9028 | | errorcodeptr pointer to error code variable (pcre_compile2() only) |
9029 | | can be NULL if you don't want a code value |
9030 | | errorptr pointer to pointer to error text |
9031 | | erroroffset ptr offset in pattern where error was detected |
9032 | | tables pointer to character tables or NULL |
9033 | | |
9034 | | Returns: pointer to compiled data block, or NULL on error, |
9035 | | with errorptr and erroroffset set |
9036 | | */ |
9037 | | |
9038 | | #if defined COMPILE_PCRE8 |
9039 | | PCRE_EXP_DEFN pcre * PCRE_CALL_CONVENTION |
9040 | | pcre_compile(const char *pattern, int options, const char **errorptr, |
9041 | | int *erroroffset, const unsigned char *tables) |
9042 | | #elif defined COMPILE_PCRE16 |
9043 | | PCRE_EXP_DEFN pcre16 * PCRE_CALL_CONVENTION |
9044 | | pcre16_compile(PCRE_SPTR16 pattern, int options, const char **errorptr, |
9045 | | int *erroroffset, const unsigned char *tables) |
9046 | | #elif defined COMPILE_PCRE32 |
9047 | | PCRE_EXP_DEFN pcre32 * PCRE_CALL_CONVENTION |
9048 | | pcre32_compile(PCRE_SPTR32 pattern, int options, const char **errorptr, |
9049 | | int *erroroffset, const unsigned char *tables) |
9050 | | #endif |
9051 | 0 | { |
9052 | 0 | #if defined COMPILE_PCRE8 |
9053 | 0 | return pcre_compile2(pattern, options, NULL, errorptr, erroroffset, tables); |
9054 | | #elif defined COMPILE_PCRE16 |
9055 | | return pcre16_compile2(pattern, options, NULL, errorptr, erroroffset, tables); |
9056 | | #elif defined COMPILE_PCRE32 |
9057 | | return pcre32_compile2(pattern, options, NULL, errorptr, erroroffset, tables); |
9058 | | #endif |
9059 | 0 | } |
9060 | | |
9061 | | |
9062 | | #if defined COMPILE_PCRE8 |
9063 | | PCRE_EXP_DEFN pcre * PCRE_CALL_CONVENTION |
9064 | | pcre_compile2(const char *pattern, int options, int *errorcodeptr, |
9065 | | const char **errorptr, int *erroroffset, const unsigned char *tables) |
9066 | | #elif defined COMPILE_PCRE16 |
9067 | | PCRE_EXP_DEFN pcre16 * PCRE_CALL_CONVENTION |
9068 | | pcre16_compile2(PCRE_SPTR16 pattern, int options, int *errorcodeptr, |
9069 | | const char **errorptr, int *erroroffset, const unsigned char *tables) |
9070 | | #elif defined COMPILE_PCRE32 |
9071 | | PCRE_EXP_DEFN pcre32 * PCRE_CALL_CONVENTION |
9072 | | pcre32_compile2(PCRE_SPTR32 pattern, int options, int *errorcodeptr, |
9073 | | const char **errorptr, int *erroroffset, const unsigned char *tables) |
9074 | | #endif |
9075 | 0 | { |
9076 | 0 | REAL_PCRE *re; |
9077 | 0 | int length = 1; /* For final END opcode */ |
9078 | 0 | pcre_int32 firstcharflags, reqcharflags; |
9079 | 0 | pcre_uint32 firstchar, reqchar; |
9080 | 0 | pcre_uint32 limit_match = PCRE_UINT32_MAX; |
9081 | 0 | pcre_uint32 limit_recursion = PCRE_UINT32_MAX; |
9082 | 0 | int newline; |
9083 | 0 | int errorcode = 0; |
9084 | 0 | int skipatstart = 0; |
9085 | 0 | BOOL utf; |
9086 | 0 | BOOL never_utf = FALSE; |
9087 | 0 | size_t size; |
9088 | 0 | pcre_uchar *code; |
9089 | 0 | const pcre_uchar *codestart; |
9090 | 0 | const pcre_uchar *ptr; |
9091 | 0 | compile_data compile_block; |
9092 | 0 | compile_data *cd = &compile_block; |
9093 | | |
9094 | | /* This space is used for "compiling" into during the first phase, when we are |
9095 | | computing the amount of memory that is needed. Compiled items are thrown away |
9096 | | as soon as possible, so that a fairly large buffer should be sufficient for |
9097 | | this purpose. The same space is used in the second phase for remembering where |
9098 | | to fill in forward references to subpatterns. That may overflow, in which case |
9099 | | new memory is obtained from malloc(). */ |
9100 | |
|
9101 | 0 | pcre_uchar cworkspace[COMPILE_WORK_SIZE]; |
9102 | | |
9103 | | /* This vector is used for remembering name groups during the pre-compile. In a |
9104 | | similar way to cworkspace, it can be expanded using malloc() if necessary. */ |
9105 | |
|
9106 | 0 | named_group named_groups[NAMED_GROUP_LIST_SIZE]; |
9107 | 0 | cd->named_groups = named_groups; |
9108 | 0 | cd->named_group_list_size = NAMED_GROUP_LIST_SIZE; |
9109 | | |
9110 | | /* Set this early so that early errors get offset 0. */ |
9111 | |
|
9112 | 0 | ptr = (const pcre_uchar *)pattern; |
9113 | | |
9114 | | /* We can't pass back an error message if errorptr is NULL; I guess the best we |
9115 | | can do is just return NULL, but we can set a code value if there is a code |
9116 | | pointer. */ |
9117 | |
|
9118 | 0 | if (errorptr == NULL) |
9119 | 0 | { |
9120 | 0 | if (errorcodeptr != NULL) *errorcodeptr = 99; |
9121 | 0 | return NULL; |
9122 | 0 | } |
9123 | | |
9124 | 0 | *errorptr = NULL; |
9125 | 0 | if (errorcodeptr != NULL) *errorcodeptr = ERR0; |
9126 | | |
9127 | | /* However, we can give a message for this error */ |
9128 | |
|
9129 | 0 | if (erroroffset == NULL) |
9130 | 0 | { |
9131 | 0 | errorcode = ERR16; |
9132 | 0 | goto PCRE_EARLY_ERROR_RETURN2; |
9133 | 0 | } |
9134 | | |
9135 | 0 | *erroroffset = 0; |
9136 | | |
9137 | | /* Set up pointers to the individual character tables */ |
9138 | |
|
9139 | 0 | if (tables == NULL) tables = PRIV(default_tables); |
9140 | 0 | cd->lcc = tables + lcc_offset; |
9141 | 0 | cd->fcc = tables + fcc_offset; |
9142 | 0 | cd->cbits = tables + cbits_offset; |
9143 | 0 | cd->ctypes = tables + ctypes_offset; |
9144 | | |
9145 | | /* Check that all undefined public option bits are zero */ |
9146 | |
|
9147 | 0 | if ((options & ~PUBLIC_COMPILE_OPTIONS) != 0) |
9148 | 0 | { |
9149 | 0 | errorcode = ERR17; |
9150 | 0 | goto PCRE_EARLY_ERROR_RETURN; |
9151 | 0 | } |
9152 | | |
9153 | | /* If PCRE_NEVER_UTF is set, remember it. */ |
9154 | | |
9155 | 0 | if ((options & PCRE_NEVER_UTF) != 0) never_utf = TRUE; |
9156 | | |
9157 | | /* Check for global one-time settings at the start of the pattern, and remember |
9158 | | the offset for later. */ |
9159 | |
|
9160 | 0 | cd->external_flags = 0; /* Initialize here for LIMIT_MATCH/RECURSION */ |
9161 | |
|
9162 | 0 | while (ptr[skipatstart] == CHAR_LEFT_PARENTHESIS && |
9163 | 0 | ptr[skipatstart+1] == CHAR_ASTERISK) |
9164 | 0 | { |
9165 | 0 | int newnl = 0; |
9166 | 0 | int newbsr = 0; |
9167 | | |
9168 | | /* For completeness and backward compatibility, (*UTFn) is supported in the |
9169 | | relevant libraries, but (*UTF) is generic and always supported. Note that |
9170 | | PCRE_UTF8 == PCRE_UTF16 == PCRE_UTF32. */ |
9171 | |
|
9172 | 0 | #ifdef COMPILE_PCRE8 |
9173 | 0 | if (STRNCMP_UC_C8(ptr+skipatstart+2, STRING_UTF8_RIGHTPAR, 5) == 0) |
9174 | 0 | { skipatstart += 7; options |= PCRE_UTF8; continue; } |
9175 | 0 | #endif |
9176 | | #ifdef COMPILE_PCRE16 |
9177 | | if (STRNCMP_UC_C8(ptr+skipatstart+2, STRING_UTF16_RIGHTPAR, 6) == 0) |
9178 | | { skipatstart += 8; options |= PCRE_UTF16; continue; } |
9179 | | #endif |
9180 | | #ifdef COMPILE_PCRE32 |
9181 | | if (STRNCMP_UC_C8(ptr+skipatstart+2, STRING_UTF32_RIGHTPAR, 6) == 0) |
9182 | | { skipatstart += 8; options |= PCRE_UTF32; continue; } |
9183 | | #endif |
9184 | | |
9185 | 0 | else if (STRNCMP_UC_C8(ptr+skipatstart+2, STRING_UTF_RIGHTPAR, 4) == 0) |
9186 | 0 | { skipatstart += 6; options |= PCRE_UTF8; continue; } |
9187 | 0 | else if (STRNCMP_UC_C8(ptr+skipatstart+2, STRING_UCP_RIGHTPAR, 4) == 0) |
9188 | 0 | { skipatstart += 6; options |= PCRE_UCP; continue; } |
9189 | 0 | else if (STRNCMP_UC_C8(ptr+skipatstart+2, STRING_NO_AUTO_POSSESS_RIGHTPAR, 16) == 0) |
9190 | 0 | { skipatstart += 18; options |= PCRE_NO_AUTO_POSSESS; continue; } |
9191 | 0 | else if (STRNCMP_UC_C8(ptr+skipatstart+2, STRING_NO_START_OPT_RIGHTPAR, 13) == 0) |
9192 | 0 | { skipatstart += 15; options |= PCRE_NO_START_OPTIMIZE; continue; } |
9193 | | |
9194 | 0 | else if (STRNCMP_UC_C8(ptr+skipatstart+2, STRING_LIMIT_MATCH_EQ, 12) == 0) |
9195 | 0 | { |
9196 | 0 | pcre_uint32 c = 0; |
9197 | 0 | int p = skipatstart + 14; |
9198 | 0 | while (isdigit(ptr[p])) |
9199 | 0 | { |
9200 | 0 | if (c > PCRE_UINT32_MAX / 10 - 1) break; /* Integer overflow */ |
9201 | 0 | c = c*10 + ptr[p++] - CHAR_0; |
9202 | 0 | } |
9203 | 0 | if (ptr[p++] != CHAR_RIGHT_PARENTHESIS) break; |
9204 | 0 | if (c < limit_match) |
9205 | 0 | { |
9206 | 0 | limit_match = c; |
9207 | 0 | cd->external_flags |= PCRE_MLSET; |
9208 | 0 | } |
9209 | 0 | skipatstart = p; |
9210 | 0 | continue; |
9211 | 0 | } |
9212 | | |
9213 | 0 | else if (STRNCMP_UC_C8(ptr+skipatstart+2, STRING_LIMIT_RECURSION_EQ, 16) == 0) |
9214 | 0 | { |
9215 | 0 | pcre_uint32 c = 0; |
9216 | 0 | int p = skipatstart + 18; |
9217 | 0 | while (isdigit(ptr[p])) |
9218 | 0 | { |
9219 | 0 | if (c > PCRE_UINT32_MAX / 10 - 1) break; /* Integer overflow check */ |
9220 | 0 | c = c*10 + ptr[p++] - CHAR_0; |
9221 | 0 | } |
9222 | 0 | if (ptr[p++] != CHAR_RIGHT_PARENTHESIS) break; |
9223 | 0 | if (c < limit_recursion) |
9224 | 0 | { |
9225 | 0 | limit_recursion = c; |
9226 | 0 | cd->external_flags |= PCRE_RLSET; |
9227 | 0 | } |
9228 | 0 | skipatstart = p; |
9229 | 0 | continue; |
9230 | 0 | } |
9231 | | |
9232 | 0 | if (STRNCMP_UC_C8(ptr+skipatstart+2, STRING_CR_RIGHTPAR, 3) == 0) |
9233 | 0 | { skipatstart += 5; newnl = PCRE_NEWLINE_CR; } |
9234 | 0 | else if (STRNCMP_UC_C8(ptr+skipatstart+2, STRING_LF_RIGHTPAR, 3) == 0) |
9235 | 0 | { skipatstart += 5; newnl = PCRE_NEWLINE_LF; } |
9236 | 0 | else if (STRNCMP_UC_C8(ptr+skipatstart+2, STRING_CRLF_RIGHTPAR, 5) == 0) |
9237 | 0 | { skipatstart += 7; newnl = PCRE_NEWLINE_CR + PCRE_NEWLINE_LF; } |
9238 | 0 | else if (STRNCMP_UC_C8(ptr+skipatstart+2, STRING_ANY_RIGHTPAR, 4) == 0) |
9239 | 0 | { skipatstart += 6; newnl = PCRE_NEWLINE_ANY; } |
9240 | 0 | else if (STRNCMP_UC_C8(ptr+skipatstart+2, STRING_ANYCRLF_RIGHTPAR, 8) == 0) |
9241 | 0 | { skipatstart += 10; newnl = PCRE_NEWLINE_ANYCRLF; } |
9242 | | |
9243 | 0 | else if (STRNCMP_UC_C8(ptr+skipatstart+2, STRING_BSR_ANYCRLF_RIGHTPAR, 12) == 0) |
9244 | 0 | { skipatstart += 14; newbsr = PCRE_BSR_ANYCRLF; } |
9245 | 0 | else if (STRNCMP_UC_C8(ptr+skipatstart+2, STRING_BSR_UNICODE_RIGHTPAR, 12) == 0) |
9246 | 0 | { skipatstart += 14; newbsr = PCRE_BSR_UNICODE; } |
9247 | |
|
9248 | 0 | if (newnl != 0) |
9249 | 0 | options = (options & ~PCRE_NEWLINE_BITS) | newnl; |
9250 | 0 | else if (newbsr != 0) |
9251 | 0 | options = (options & ~(PCRE_BSR_ANYCRLF|PCRE_BSR_UNICODE)) | newbsr; |
9252 | 0 | else break; |
9253 | 0 | } |
9254 | | |
9255 | | /* PCRE_UTF(16|32) have the same value as PCRE_UTF8. */ |
9256 | 0 | utf = (options & PCRE_UTF8) != 0; |
9257 | 0 | if (utf && never_utf) |
9258 | 0 | { |
9259 | 0 | errorcode = ERR78; |
9260 | 0 | goto PCRE_EARLY_ERROR_RETURN2; |
9261 | 0 | } |
9262 | | |
9263 | | /* Can't support UTF unless PCRE has been compiled to include the code. The |
9264 | | return of an error code from PRIV(valid_utf)() is a new feature, introduced in |
9265 | | release 8.13. It is passed back from pcre_[dfa_]exec(), but at the moment is |
9266 | | not used here. */ |
9267 | | |
9268 | | #ifdef SUPPORT_UTF |
9269 | | if (utf && (options & PCRE_NO_UTF8_CHECK) == 0 && |
9270 | | (errorcode = PRIV(valid_utf)((PCRE_PUCHAR)pattern, -1, erroroffset)) != 0) |
9271 | | { |
9272 | | #if defined COMPILE_PCRE8 |
9273 | | errorcode = ERR44; |
9274 | | #elif defined COMPILE_PCRE16 |
9275 | | errorcode = ERR74; |
9276 | | #elif defined COMPILE_PCRE32 |
9277 | | errorcode = ERR77; |
9278 | | #endif |
9279 | | goto PCRE_EARLY_ERROR_RETURN2; |
9280 | | } |
9281 | | #else |
9282 | 0 | if (utf) |
9283 | 0 | { |
9284 | 0 | errorcode = ERR32; |
9285 | 0 | goto PCRE_EARLY_ERROR_RETURN; |
9286 | 0 | } |
9287 | 0 | #endif |
9288 | | |
9289 | | /* Can't support UCP unless PCRE has been compiled to include the code. */ |
9290 | | |
9291 | 0 | #ifndef SUPPORT_UCP |
9292 | 0 | if ((options & PCRE_UCP) != 0) |
9293 | 0 | { |
9294 | 0 | errorcode = ERR67; |
9295 | 0 | goto PCRE_EARLY_ERROR_RETURN; |
9296 | 0 | } |
9297 | 0 | #endif |
9298 | | |
9299 | | /* Check validity of \R options. */ |
9300 | | |
9301 | 0 | if ((options & (PCRE_BSR_ANYCRLF|PCRE_BSR_UNICODE)) == |
9302 | 0 | (PCRE_BSR_ANYCRLF|PCRE_BSR_UNICODE)) |
9303 | 0 | { |
9304 | 0 | errorcode = ERR56; |
9305 | 0 | goto PCRE_EARLY_ERROR_RETURN; |
9306 | 0 | } |
9307 | | |
9308 | | /* Handle different types of newline. The three bits give seven cases. The |
9309 | | current code allows for fixed one- or two-byte sequences, plus "any" and |
9310 | | "anycrlf". */ |
9311 | | |
9312 | 0 | switch (options & PCRE_NEWLINE_BITS) |
9313 | 0 | { |
9314 | 0 | case 0: newline = NEWLINE; break; /* Build-time default */ |
9315 | 0 | case PCRE_NEWLINE_CR: newline = CHAR_CR; break; |
9316 | 0 | case PCRE_NEWLINE_LF: newline = CHAR_NL; break; |
9317 | 0 | case PCRE_NEWLINE_CR+ |
9318 | 0 | PCRE_NEWLINE_LF: newline = (CHAR_CR << 8) | CHAR_NL; break; |
9319 | 0 | case PCRE_NEWLINE_ANY: newline = -1; break; |
9320 | 0 | case PCRE_NEWLINE_ANYCRLF: newline = -2; break; |
9321 | 0 | default: errorcode = ERR56; goto PCRE_EARLY_ERROR_RETURN; |
9322 | 0 | } |
9323 | | |
9324 | 0 | if (newline == -2) |
9325 | 0 | { |
9326 | 0 | cd->nltype = NLTYPE_ANYCRLF; |
9327 | 0 | } |
9328 | 0 | else if (newline < 0) |
9329 | 0 | { |
9330 | 0 | cd->nltype = NLTYPE_ANY; |
9331 | 0 | } |
9332 | 0 | else |
9333 | 0 | { |
9334 | 0 | cd->nltype = NLTYPE_FIXED; |
9335 | 0 | if (newline > 255) |
9336 | 0 | { |
9337 | 0 | cd->nllen = 2; |
9338 | 0 | cd->nl[0] = (newline >> 8) & 255; |
9339 | 0 | cd->nl[1] = newline & 255; |
9340 | 0 | } |
9341 | 0 | else |
9342 | 0 | { |
9343 | 0 | cd->nllen = 1; |
9344 | 0 | cd->nl[0] = newline; |
9345 | 0 | } |
9346 | 0 | } |
9347 | | |
9348 | | /* Maximum back reference and backref bitmap. The bitmap records up to 31 back |
9349 | | references to help in deciding whether (.*) can be treated as anchored or not. |
9350 | | */ |
9351 | |
|
9352 | 0 | cd->top_backref = 0; |
9353 | 0 | cd->backref_map = 0; |
9354 | | |
9355 | | /* Reflect pattern for debugging output */ |
9356 | |
|
9357 | 0 | DPRINTF(("------------------------------------------------------------------\n")); |
9358 | | #ifdef PCRE_DEBUG |
9359 | | print_puchar(stdout, (PCRE_PUCHAR)pattern); |
9360 | | #endif |
9361 | 0 | DPRINTF(("\n")); |
9362 | | |
9363 | | /* Pretend to compile the pattern while actually just accumulating the length |
9364 | | of memory required. This behaviour is triggered by passing a non-NULL final |
9365 | | argument to compile_regex(). We pass a block of workspace (cworkspace) for it |
9366 | | to compile parts of the pattern into; the compiled code is discarded when it is |
9367 | | no longer needed, so hopefully this workspace will never overflow, though there |
9368 | | is a test for its doing so. */ |
9369 | |
|
9370 | 0 | cd->bracount = cd->final_bracount = 0; |
9371 | 0 | cd->names_found = 0; |
9372 | 0 | cd->name_entry_size = 0; |
9373 | 0 | cd->name_table = NULL; |
9374 | 0 | cd->dupnames = FALSE; |
9375 | 0 | cd->dupgroups = FALSE; |
9376 | 0 | cd->namedrefcount = 0; |
9377 | 0 | cd->start_code = cworkspace; |
9378 | 0 | cd->hwm = cworkspace; |
9379 | 0 | cd->iscondassert = FALSE; |
9380 | 0 | cd->start_workspace = cworkspace; |
9381 | 0 | cd->workspace_size = COMPILE_WORK_SIZE; |
9382 | 0 | cd->start_pattern = (const pcre_uchar *)pattern; |
9383 | 0 | cd->end_pattern = (const pcre_uchar *)(pattern + STRLEN_UC((const pcre_uchar *)pattern)); |
9384 | 0 | cd->req_varyopt = 0; |
9385 | 0 | cd->parens_depth = 0; |
9386 | 0 | cd->assert_depth = 0; |
9387 | 0 | cd->max_lookbehind = 0; |
9388 | 0 | cd->external_options = options; |
9389 | 0 | cd->open_caps = NULL; |
9390 | | |
9391 | | /* Now do the pre-compile. On error, errorcode will be set non-zero, so we |
9392 | | don't need to look at the result of the function here. The initial options have |
9393 | | been put into the cd block so that they can be changed if an option setting is |
9394 | | found within the regex right at the beginning. Bringing initial option settings |
9395 | | outside can help speed up starting point checks. */ |
9396 | |
|
9397 | 0 | ptr += skipatstart; |
9398 | 0 | code = cworkspace; |
9399 | 0 | *code = OP_BRA; |
9400 | |
|
9401 | 0 | (void)compile_regex(cd->external_options, &code, &ptr, &errorcode, FALSE, |
9402 | 0 | FALSE, 0, 0, &firstchar, &firstcharflags, &reqchar, &reqcharflags, NULL, |
9403 | 0 | cd, &length); |
9404 | 0 | if (errorcode != 0) goto PCRE_EARLY_ERROR_RETURN; |
9405 | | |
9406 | 0 | DPRINTF(("end pre-compile: length=%d workspace=%d\n", length, |
9407 | 0 | (int)(cd->hwm - cworkspace))); |
9408 | |
|
9409 | 0 | if (length > MAX_PATTERN_SIZE) |
9410 | 0 | { |
9411 | 0 | errorcode = ERR20; |
9412 | 0 | goto PCRE_EARLY_ERROR_RETURN; |
9413 | 0 | } |
9414 | | |
9415 | | /* Compute the size of the data block for storing the compiled pattern. Integer |
9416 | | overflow should no longer be possible because nowadays we limit the maximum |
9417 | | value of cd->names_found and cd->name_entry_size. */ |
9418 | | |
9419 | 0 | size = sizeof(REAL_PCRE) + |
9420 | 0 | (length + cd->names_found * cd->name_entry_size) * sizeof(pcre_uchar); |
9421 | | |
9422 | | /* Get the memory. */ |
9423 | |
|
9424 | 0 | re = (REAL_PCRE *)(PUBL(malloc))(size); |
9425 | 0 | if (re == NULL) |
9426 | 0 | { |
9427 | 0 | errorcode = ERR21; |
9428 | 0 | goto PCRE_EARLY_ERROR_RETURN; |
9429 | 0 | } |
9430 | | |
9431 | | /* Put in the magic number, and save the sizes, initial options, internal |
9432 | | flags, and character table pointer. NULL is used for the default character |
9433 | | tables. The nullpad field is at the end; it's there to help in the case when a |
9434 | | regex compiled on a system with 4-byte pointers is run on another with 8-byte |
9435 | | pointers. */ |
9436 | | |
9437 | 0 | re->magic_number = MAGIC_NUMBER; |
9438 | 0 | re->size = (int)size; |
9439 | 0 | re->options = cd->external_options; |
9440 | 0 | re->flags = cd->external_flags; |
9441 | 0 | re->limit_match = limit_match; |
9442 | 0 | re->limit_recursion = limit_recursion; |
9443 | 0 | re->first_char = 0; |
9444 | 0 | re->req_char = 0; |
9445 | 0 | re->name_table_offset = sizeof(REAL_PCRE) / sizeof(pcre_uchar); |
9446 | 0 | re->name_entry_size = cd->name_entry_size; |
9447 | 0 | re->name_count = cd->names_found; |
9448 | 0 | re->ref_count = 0; |
9449 | 0 | re->tables = (tables == PRIV(default_tables))? NULL : tables; |
9450 | 0 | re->nullpad = NULL; |
9451 | | #ifdef COMPILE_PCRE32 |
9452 | | re->dummy = 0; |
9453 | | #else |
9454 | 0 | re->dummy1 = re->dummy2 = re->dummy3 = 0; |
9455 | 0 | #endif |
9456 | | |
9457 | | /* The starting points of the name/number translation table and of the code are |
9458 | | passed around in the compile data block. The start/end pattern and initial |
9459 | | options are already set from the pre-compile phase, as is the name_entry_size |
9460 | | field. Reset the bracket count and the names_found field. Also reset the hwm |
9461 | | field; this time it's used for remembering forward references to subpatterns. |
9462 | | */ |
9463 | |
|
9464 | 0 | cd->final_bracount = cd->bracount; /* Save for checking forward references */ |
9465 | 0 | cd->parens_depth = 0; |
9466 | 0 | cd->assert_depth = 0; |
9467 | 0 | cd->bracount = 0; |
9468 | 0 | cd->max_lookbehind = 0; |
9469 | 0 | cd->name_table = (pcre_uchar *)re + re->name_table_offset; |
9470 | 0 | codestart = cd->name_table + re->name_entry_size * re->name_count; |
9471 | 0 | cd->start_code = codestart; |
9472 | 0 | cd->hwm = (pcre_uchar *)(cd->start_workspace); |
9473 | 0 | cd->iscondassert = FALSE; |
9474 | 0 | cd->req_varyopt = 0; |
9475 | 0 | cd->had_accept = FALSE; |
9476 | 0 | cd->had_pruneorskip = FALSE; |
9477 | 0 | cd->check_lookbehind = FALSE; |
9478 | 0 | cd->open_caps = NULL; |
9479 | | |
9480 | | /* If any named groups were found, create the name/number table from the list |
9481 | | created in the first pass. */ |
9482 | |
|
9483 | 0 | if (cd->names_found > 0) |
9484 | 0 | { |
9485 | 0 | int i = cd->names_found; |
9486 | 0 | named_group *ng = cd->named_groups; |
9487 | 0 | cd->names_found = 0; |
9488 | 0 | for (; i > 0; i--, ng++) |
9489 | 0 | add_name(cd, ng->name, ng->length, ng->number); |
9490 | 0 | if (cd->named_group_list_size > NAMED_GROUP_LIST_SIZE) |
9491 | 0 | (PUBL(free))((void *)cd->named_groups); |
9492 | 0 | cd->named_group_list_size = 0; /* So we don't free it twice */ |
9493 | 0 | } |
9494 | | |
9495 | | /* Set up a starting, non-extracting bracket, then compile the expression. On |
9496 | | error, errorcode will be set non-zero, so we don't need to look at the result |
9497 | | of the function here. */ |
9498 | |
|
9499 | 0 | ptr = (const pcre_uchar *)pattern + skipatstart; |
9500 | 0 | code = (pcre_uchar *)codestart; |
9501 | 0 | *code = OP_BRA; |
9502 | 0 | (void)compile_regex(re->options, &code, &ptr, &errorcode, FALSE, FALSE, 0, 0, |
9503 | 0 | &firstchar, &firstcharflags, &reqchar, &reqcharflags, NULL, cd, NULL); |
9504 | 0 | re->top_bracket = cd->bracount; |
9505 | 0 | re->top_backref = cd->top_backref; |
9506 | 0 | re->max_lookbehind = cd->max_lookbehind; |
9507 | 0 | re->flags = cd->external_flags | PCRE_MODE; |
9508 | |
|
9509 | 0 | if (cd->had_accept) |
9510 | 0 | { |
9511 | 0 | reqchar = 0; /* Must disable after (*ACCEPT) */ |
9512 | 0 | reqcharflags = REQ_NONE; |
9513 | 0 | } |
9514 | | |
9515 | | /* If not reached end of pattern on success, there's an excess bracket. */ |
9516 | |
|
9517 | 0 | if (errorcode == 0 && *ptr != CHAR_NULL) errorcode = ERR22; |
9518 | | |
9519 | | /* Fill in the terminating state and check for disastrous overflow, but |
9520 | | if debugging, leave the test till after things are printed out. */ |
9521 | |
|
9522 | 0 | *code++ = OP_END; |
9523 | |
|
9524 | 0 | #ifndef PCRE_DEBUG |
9525 | 0 | if (code - codestart > length) errorcode = ERR23; |
9526 | 0 | #endif |
9527 | |
|
9528 | | #ifdef SUPPORT_VALGRIND |
9529 | | /* If the estimated length exceeds the really used length, mark the extra |
9530 | | allocated memory as unaddressable, so that any out-of-bound reads can be |
9531 | | detected. */ |
9532 | | VALGRIND_MAKE_MEM_NOACCESS(code, (length - (code - codestart)) * sizeof(pcre_uchar)); |
9533 | | #endif |
9534 | | |
9535 | | /* Fill in any forward references that are required. There may be repeated |
9536 | | references; optimize for them, as searching a large regex takes time. */ |
9537 | |
|
9538 | 0 | if (cd->hwm > cd->start_workspace) |
9539 | 0 | { |
9540 | 0 | int prev_recno = -1; |
9541 | 0 | const pcre_uchar *groupptr = NULL; |
9542 | 0 | while (errorcode == 0 && cd->hwm > cd->start_workspace) |
9543 | 0 | { |
9544 | 0 | int offset, recno; |
9545 | 0 | cd->hwm -= LINK_SIZE; |
9546 | 0 | offset = GET(cd->hwm, 0); |
9547 | | |
9548 | | /* Check that the hwm handling hasn't gone wrong. This whole area is |
9549 | | rewritten in PCRE2 because there are some obscure cases. */ |
9550 | |
|
9551 | 0 | if (offset == 0 || codestart[offset-1] != OP_RECURSE) |
9552 | 0 | { |
9553 | 0 | errorcode = ERR10; |
9554 | 0 | break; |
9555 | 0 | } |
9556 | | |
9557 | 0 | recno = GET(codestart, offset); |
9558 | 0 | if (recno != prev_recno) |
9559 | 0 | { |
9560 | 0 | groupptr = PRIV(find_bracket)(codestart, utf, recno); |
9561 | 0 | prev_recno = recno; |
9562 | 0 | } |
9563 | 0 | if (groupptr == NULL) errorcode = ERR53; |
9564 | 0 | else PUT(((pcre_uchar *)codestart), offset, (int)(groupptr - codestart)); |
9565 | 0 | } |
9566 | 0 | } |
9567 | | |
9568 | | /* If the workspace had to be expanded, free the new memory. Set the pointer to |
9569 | | NULL to indicate that forward references have been filled in. */ |
9570 | |
|
9571 | 0 | if (cd->workspace_size > COMPILE_WORK_SIZE) |
9572 | 0 | (PUBL(free))((void *)cd->start_workspace); |
9573 | 0 | cd->start_workspace = NULL; |
9574 | | |
9575 | | /* Give an error if there's back reference to a non-existent capturing |
9576 | | subpattern. */ |
9577 | |
|
9578 | 0 | if (errorcode == 0 && re->top_backref > re->top_bracket) errorcode = ERR15; |
9579 | | |
9580 | | /* Unless disabled, check whether any single character iterators can be |
9581 | | auto-possessified. The function overwrites the appropriate opcode values, so |
9582 | | the type of the pointer must be cast. NOTE: the intermediate variable "temp" is |
9583 | | used in this code because at least one compiler gives a warning about loss of |
9584 | | "const" attribute if the cast (pcre_uchar *)codestart is used directly in the |
9585 | | function call. */ |
9586 | |
|
9587 | 0 | if (errorcode == 0 && (options & PCRE_NO_AUTO_POSSESS) == 0) |
9588 | 0 | { |
9589 | 0 | pcre_uchar *temp = (pcre_uchar *)codestart; |
9590 | 0 | auto_possessify(temp, utf, cd); |
9591 | 0 | } |
9592 | | |
9593 | | /* If there were any lookbehind assertions that contained OP_RECURSE |
9594 | | (recursions or subroutine calls), a flag is set for them to be checked here, |
9595 | | because they may contain forward references. Actual recursions cannot be fixed |
9596 | | length, but subroutine calls can. It is done like this so that those without |
9597 | | OP_RECURSE that are not fixed length get a diagnosic with a useful offset. The |
9598 | | exceptional ones forgo this. We scan the pattern to check that they are fixed |
9599 | | length, and set their lengths. */ |
9600 | |
|
9601 | 0 | if (errorcode == 0 && cd->check_lookbehind) |
9602 | 0 | { |
9603 | 0 | pcre_uchar *cc = (pcre_uchar *)codestart; |
9604 | | |
9605 | | /* Loop, searching for OP_REVERSE items, and process those that do not have |
9606 | | their length set. (Actually, it will also re-process any that have a length |
9607 | | of zero, but that is a pathological case, and it does no harm.) When we find |
9608 | | one, we temporarily terminate the branch it is in while we scan it. */ |
9609 | |
|
9610 | 0 | for (cc = (pcre_uchar *)PRIV(find_bracket)(codestart, utf, -1); |
9611 | 0 | cc != NULL; |
9612 | 0 | cc = (pcre_uchar *)PRIV(find_bracket)(cc, utf, -1)) |
9613 | 0 | { |
9614 | 0 | if (GET(cc, 1) == 0) |
9615 | 0 | { |
9616 | 0 | int fixed_length; |
9617 | 0 | pcre_uchar *be = cc - 1 - LINK_SIZE + GET(cc, -LINK_SIZE); |
9618 | 0 | int end_op = *be; |
9619 | 0 | *be = OP_END; |
9620 | 0 | fixed_length = find_fixedlength(cc, (re->options & PCRE_UTF8) != 0, TRUE, |
9621 | 0 | cd, NULL); |
9622 | 0 | *be = end_op; |
9623 | 0 | DPRINTF(("fixed length = %d\n", fixed_length)); |
9624 | 0 | if (fixed_length < 0) |
9625 | 0 | { |
9626 | 0 | errorcode = (fixed_length == -2)? ERR36 : |
9627 | 0 | (fixed_length == -4)? ERR70 : ERR25; |
9628 | 0 | break; |
9629 | 0 | } |
9630 | 0 | if (fixed_length > cd->max_lookbehind) cd->max_lookbehind = fixed_length; |
9631 | 0 | PUT(cc, 1, fixed_length); |
9632 | 0 | } |
9633 | 0 | cc += 1 + LINK_SIZE; |
9634 | 0 | } |
9635 | 0 | } |
9636 | | |
9637 | | /* Failed to compile, or error while post-processing */ |
9638 | |
|
9639 | 0 | if (errorcode != 0) |
9640 | 0 | { |
9641 | 0 | (PUBL(free))(re); |
9642 | 0 | PCRE_EARLY_ERROR_RETURN: |
9643 | 0 | if (cd->named_group_list_size > NAMED_GROUP_LIST_SIZE) |
9644 | 0 | (PUBL(free))((void *)cd->named_groups); |
9645 | 0 | *erroroffset = (int)(ptr - (const pcre_uchar *)pattern); |
9646 | 0 | PCRE_EARLY_ERROR_RETURN2: |
9647 | 0 | *errorptr = find_error_text(errorcode); |
9648 | 0 | if (errorcodeptr != NULL) *errorcodeptr = errorcode; |
9649 | 0 | return NULL; |
9650 | 0 | } |
9651 | | |
9652 | | /* If the anchored option was not passed, set the flag if we can determine that |
9653 | | the pattern is anchored by virtue of ^ characters or \A or anything else, such |
9654 | | as starting with non-atomic .* when DOTALL is set and there are no occurrences |
9655 | | of *PRUNE or *SKIP. |
9656 | | |
9657 | | Otherwise, if we know what the first byte has to be, save it, because that |
9658 | | speeds up unanchored matches no end. If not, see if we can set the |
9659 | | PCRE_STARTLINE flag. This is helpful for multiline matches when all branches |
9660 | | start with ^. and also when all branches start with non-atomic .* for |
9661 | | non-DOTALL matches when *PRUNE and SKIP are not present. */ |
9662 | | |
9663 | 0 | if ((re->options & PCRE_ANCHORED) == 0) |
9664 | 0 | { |
9665 | 0 | if (is_anchored(codestart, 0, cd, 0)) re->options |= PCRE_ANCHORED; |
9666 | 0 | else |
9667 | 0 | { |
9668 | 0 | if (firstcharflags < 0) |
9669 | 0 | firstchar = find_firstassertedchar(codestart, &firstcharflags, FALSE); |
9670 | 0 | if (firstcharflags >= 0) /* Remove caseless flag for non-caseable chars */ |
9671 | 0 | { |
9672 | 0 | #if defined COMPILE_PCRE8 |
9673 | 0 | re->first_char = firstchar & 0xff; |
9674 | | #elif defined COMPILE_PCRE16 |
9675 | | re->first_char = firstchar & 0xffff; |
9676 | | #elif defined COMPILE_PCRE32 |
9677 | | re->first_char = firstchar; |
9678 | | #endif |
9679 | 0 | if ((firstcharflags & REQ_CASELESS) != 0) |
9680 | 0 | { |
9681 | | #if defined SUPPORT_UCP && !(defined COMPILE_PCRE8) |
9682 | | /* We ignore non-ASCII first chars in 8 bit mode. */ |
9683 | | if (utf) |
9684 | | { |
9685 | | if (re->first_char < 128) |
9686 | | { |
9687 | | if (cd->fcc[re->first_char] != re->first_char) |
9688 | | re->flags |= PCRE_FCH_CASELESS; |
9689 | | } |
9690 | | else if (UCD_OTHERCASE(re->first_char) != re->first_char) |
9691 | | re->flags |= PCRE_FCH_CASELESS; |
9692 | | } |
9693 | | else |
9694 | | #endif |
9695 | 0 | if (MAX_255(re->first_char) |
9696 | 0 | && cd->fcc[re->first_char] != re->first_char) |
9697 | 0 | re->flags |= PCRE_FCH_CASELESS; |
9698 | 0 | } |
9699 | |
|
9700 | 0 | re->flags |= PCRE_FIRSTSET; |
9701 | 0 | } |
9702 | | |
9703 | 0 | else if (is_startline(codestart, 0, cd, 0, FALSE)) re->flags |= PCRE_STARTLINE; |
9704 | 0 | } |
9705 | 0 | } |
9706 | | |
9707 | | /* For an anchored pattern, we use the "required byte" only if it follows a |
9708 | | variable length item in the regex. Remove the caseless flag for non-caseable |
9709 | | bytes. */ |
9710 | |
|
9711 | 0 | if (reqcharflags >= 0 && |
9712 | 0 | ((re->options & PCRE_ANCHORED) == 0 || (reqcharflags & REQ_VARY) != 0)) |
9713 | 0 | { |
9714 | 0 | #if defined COMPILE_PCRE8 |
9715 | 0 | re->req_char = reqchar & 0xff; |
9716 | | #elif defined COMPILE_PCRE16 |
9717 | | re->req_char = reqchar & 0xffff; |
9718 | | #elif defined COMPILE_PCRE32 |
9719 | | re->req_char = reqchar; |
9720 | | #endif |
9721 | 0 | if ((reqcharflags & REQ_CASELESS) != 0) |
9722 | 0 | { |
9723 | | #if defined SUPPORT_UCP && !(defined COMPILE_PCRE8) |
9724 | | /* We ignore non-ASCII first chars in 8 bit mode. */ |
9725 | | if (utf) |
9726 | | { |
9727 | | if (re->req_char < 128) |
9728 | | { |
9729 | | if (cd->fcc[re->req_char] != re->req_char) |
9730 | | re->flags |= PCRE_RCH_CASELESS; |
9731 | | } |
9732 | | else if (UCD_OTHERCASE(re->req_char) != re->req_char) |
9733 | | re->flags |= PCRE_RCH_CASELESS; |
9734 | | } |
9735 | | else |
9736 | | #endif |
9737 | 0 | if (MAX_255(re->req_char) && cd->fcc[re->req_char] != re->req_char) |
9738 | 0 | re->flags |= PCRE_RCH_CASELESS; |
9739 | 0 | } |
9740 | |
|
9741 | 0 | re->flags |= PCRE_REQCHSET; |
9742 | 0 | } |
9743 | | |
9744 | | /* Print out the compiled data if debugging is enabled. This is never the |
9745 | | case when building a production library. */ |
9746 | |
|
9747 | | #ifdef PCRE_DEBUG |
9748 | | printf("Length = %d top_bracket = %d top_backref = %d\n", |
9749 | | length, re->top_bracket, re->top_backref); |
9750 | | |
9751 | | printf("Options=%08x\n", re->options); |
9752 | | |
9753 | | if ((re->flags & PCRE_FIRSTSET) != 0) |
9754 | | { |
9755 | | pcre_uchar ch = re->first_char; |
9756 | | const char *caseless = |
9757 | | ((re->flags & PCRE_FCH_CASELESS) == 0)? "" : " (caseless)"; |
9758 | | if (PRINTABLE(ch)) printf("First char = %c%s\n", ch, caseless); |
9759 | | else printf("First char = \\x%02x%s\n", ch, caseless); |
9760 | | } |
9761 | | |
9762 | | if ((re->flags & PCRE_REQCHSET) != 0) |
9763 | | { |
9764 | | pcre_uchar ch = re->req_char; |
9765 | | const char *caseless = |
9766 | | ((re->flags & PCRE_RCH_CASELESS) == 0)? "" : " (caseless)"; |
9767 | | if (PRINTABLE(ch)) printf("Req char = %c%s\n", ch, caseless); |
9768 | | else printf("Req char = \\x%02x%s\n", ch, caseless); |
9769 | | } |
9770 | | |
9771 | | #if defined COMPILE_PCRE8 |
9772 | | pcre_printint((pcre *)re, stdout, TRUE); |
9773 | | #elif defined COMPILE_PCRE16 |
9774 | | pcre16_printint((pcre *)re, stdout, TRUE); |
9775 | | #elif defined COMPILE_PCRE32 |
9776 | | pcre32_printint((pcre *)re, stdout, TRUE); |
9777 | | #endif |
9778 | | |
9779 | | /* This check is done here in the debugging case so that the code that |
9780 | | was compiled can be seen. */ |
9781 | | |
9782 | | if (code - codestart > length) |
9783 | | { |
9784 | | (PUBL(free))(re); |
9785 | | *errorptr = find_error_text(ERR23); |
9786 | | *erroroffset = ptr - (pcre_uchar *)pattern; |
9787 | | if (errorcodeptr != NULL) *errorcodeptr = ERR23; |
9788 | | return NULL; |
9789 | | } |
9790 | | #endif /* PCRE_DEBUG */ |
9791 | | |
9792 | | /* Check for a pattern than can match an empty string, so that this information |
9793 | | can be provided to applications. */ |
9794 | |
|
9795 | 0 | do |
9796 | 0 | { |
9797 | 0 | if (could_be_empty_branch(codestart, code, utf, cd, NULL)) |
9798 | 0 | { |
9799 | 0 | re->flags |= PCRE_MATCH_EMPTY; |
9800 | 0 | break; |
9801 | 0 | } |
9802 | 0 | codestart += GET(codestart, 1); |
9803 | 0 | } |
9804 | 0 | while (*codestart == OP_ALT); |
9805 | | |
9806 | 0 | #if defined COMPILE_PCRE8 |
9807 | 0 | return (pcre *)re; |
9808 | | #elif defined COMPILE_PCRE16 |
9809 | | return (pcre16 *)re; |
9810 | | #elif defined COMPILE_PCRE32 |
9811 | | return (pcre32 *)re; |
9812 | | #endif |
9813 | 0 | } |
9814 | | |
9815 | | /* End of pcre_compile.c */ |